Irc3380 2880-sm PDF
Irc3380 2880-sm PDF
Irc3380 2880-sm PDF
iR C3380/3380F/3380i
iR C2880/2880F/2880i
Aug 29 2006
Application
This manual has been issued by Canon Inc. for qualified persons to learn technical theory, installation, maintenance, and repair
of products. This manual covers all localities where the products are sold. For this reason, there may be information in this
manual that does not apply to your locality.
Corrections
This manual may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors due to improvements or changes in products. When
changes occur in applicable products or in the contents of this manual, Canon will release technical information as the need
arises. In the event of major changes in the contents of this manual over a long or short period, Canon will issue a new edition
of this manual.
The following paragraph does not apply to any countries where such provisions are inconsistent with local law.
Trademarks
The product names and company names used in this manual are the registered trademarks of the individual companies.
Copyright
This manual is copyrighted with all rights reserved. Under the copyright laws, this manual may not be copied, reproduced or
translated into another language, in whole or in part, without the written consent of Canon Inc.
Caution
Use of this manual should be strictly supervised to avoid disclosure of confidential information.
Introduction
Symbols Used
This documentation uses the following symbols to indicate special information:
Symbol Description
Indicates an item requiring disconnection of the power plug from the electric outlet.
Indicates an item intended to provide notes assisting the understanding of the topic in question.
Memo
The descriptions in this Service Manual are subject to change without notice for product improvement or other purposes, and major changes will be com-
municated in the form of Service Information bulletins.
All service persons are expected to have a good understanding of the contents of this Service Manual and all relevant Service Information bulletins and be
able to identify and isolate faults in the machine."
Contents
Contents
Chapter 1 Introduction
1.1 System Construction ..................................................................................................................................1- 1
1.1.1 System Configuration Overview (Delivery Accessories) ......................................................................................... 1- 1
1.1.2 System Configuration 1 (Delivery Accessories) ...................................................................................................... 1- 1
1.1.3 System Configuration 2 (Delivery Accessories) ...................................................................................................... 1- 2
1.1.4 System Configuration 3 (Delivery Accessories) ...................................................................................................... 1- 3
1.1.5 System Configuration (Pickup/Original Processing Accessories) ........................................................................... 1- 4
1.1.6 Reader Heater System Configuration...................................................................................................................... 1- 5
1.1.7 Cassette Heater System Configuration 1 ................................................................................................................ 1- 5
1.1.8 Cassette Heater System Configuration 2 ................................................................................................................ 1- 5
1.1.9 Side Deck Heater System Configuration ................................................................................................................. 1- 6
1.1.10 System Configuration (Printing/Transmission Accessories) (EUR) ....................................................................... 1- 6
1.1.11 Functions of Printing/Transmission Accessories (EUR) ........................................................................................ 1- 7
1.2 Product Specifications ................................................................................................................................1- 8
1.2.1 Names of Parts........................................................................................................................................................ 1- 8
1.2.1.1 External View ........................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 8
1.2.1.2 Cross Section........................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 9
1.2.2 User Mode Items ................................................................................................................................................... 1- 10
1.2.2.1 Common Settings .................................................................................................................................................................. 1- 10
1.2.2.2 Timer Settings........................................................................................................................................................................ 1- 12
1.2.2.3 Adjustment/Cleaning.............................................................................................................................................................. 1- 12
1.2.2.4 Report Settings ...................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 12
1.2.2.5 System Settings ..................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 13
1.2.2.6 Copy Settings......................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 15
1.2.2.7 Communications Settings ...................................................................................................................................................... 1- 15
1.2.2.8 Mail Box Settings ................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 16
1.2.2.9 Address Book Settings........................................................................................................................................................... 1- 16
1.2.3 User Maintenance ................................................................................................................................................. 1- 17
1.2.3.1 Cleaning................................................................................................................................................................................. 1- 17
1.2.3.2 Inspection............................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 20
1.2.4 Safety .................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 21
1.2.4.1 Laser safety ........................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 21
1.2.4.2 CDRH Act .............................................................................................................................................................................. 1- 21
1.2.4.3 Handling of laser system........................................................................................................................................................ 1- 21
1.2.4.4 Safety of Toner ...................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 22
1.2.4.5 Notes when handling a lithium battery ................................................................................................................................... 1- 22
1.2.5 Product Specifications ........................................................................................................................................... 1- 22
1.2.5.1 Type and function .................................................................................................................................................................. 1- 22
1.2.5.2 Others .................................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 23
1.2.6 Function List .......................................................................................................................................................... 1- 23
1.2.6.1 Print speed............................................................................................................................................................................. 1- 23
1.2.6.2 Type of paper......................................................................................................................................................................... 1- 24
Chapter 2 Installation
2.1 Making Pre-Checks ....................................................................................................................................2- 1
2.1.1 Selecting the Site of Installation .............................................................................................................................. 2- 1
2.1.2 Check to Make Before Installation........................................................................................................................... 2- 2
2.1.3 Combination Table of Accessories .......................................................................................................................... 2- 2
2.1.4 Checking the Contents ............................................................................................................................................ 2- 3
2.2 Unpacking and Installation .........................................................................................................................2- 4
2.2.1 Points to Note When Turning Off the Main Power................................................................................................... 2- 4
2.2.2 Unpacking................................................................................................................................................................ 2- 4
Contents
Chapter 11 MEAP
11.1 MEAP ..................................................................................................................................................... 11- 1
11.1.1 Checking the Operating Environment. .................................................................................................................11- 1
11.1.2 Setting Up the Network ........................................................................................................................................11- 2
11.1.3 Setting the method to login to SMS......................................................................................................................11- 3
11.1.4 Login to SMS........................................................................................................................................................11- 7
11.1.5 Checking Application List .....................................................................................................................................11- 8
11.1.6 Starting and Stopping a MEAP Application..........................................................................................................11- 9
11.1.7 Checking the Platform Information.....................................................................................................................11- 10
11.1.8 MEAP Specifications..........................................................................................................................................11- 11
11.1.9 Checking the System Information of a MEAP Application with SMS .................................................................11- 12
11.1.10 Printing the System Information of a MEAP Application ..................................................................................11- 13
11.1.11 Reference (Application System Information)....................................................................................................11- 13
11.1.12 Installing an Application....................................................................................................................................11- 14
11.1.13 MEAP Enterprise Service Manager..................................................................................................................11- 16
11.1.14 Adding a License File .......................................................................................................................................11- 16
11.1.15 Disabling a License File (suspending a license) ..............................................................................................11- 18
11.1.16 Downloading/Removing an Invalidated License File........................................................................................11- 20
11.1.17 Reusable license ..............................................................................................................................................11- 22
11.1.18 License for forwarding ......................................................................................................................................11- 23
11.1.19 Uninstalling an Application ...............................................................................................................................11- 25
11.1.20 Changing Login Services .................................................................................................................................11- 26
11.1.21 Initializing the Password...................................................................................................................................11- 30
11.1.22 Creating a Backup for MEAP Application Area, Formatting the Hard Disk, Restoring the MEAP Application Area
with the Backup, Using the SST (Service Support Tool)..........................................................................................11- 30
11.1.23 Replacing the Hard Disk Drive .........................................................................................................................11- 32
11.1.24 MEAP Safe Mode.............................................................................................................................................11- 32
11.1.25 Setting HTTP port for MEAP application (level 2) ............................................................................................11- 33
Contents
Chapter 12 RDS
12.1 RDS ........................................................................................................................................................12- 1
12.1.1 Application operation mode ................................................................................................................................. 12- 1
12.1.2 Service Center URL and Port Specification......................................................................................................... 12- 1
12.1.3 Communication test ............................................................................................................................................. 12- 1
12.1.4 Communication log .............................................................................................................................................. 12- 1
12.1.5 Detailed Communication log................................................................................................................................ 12- 1
12.1.6 SOAP communication function ............................................................................................................................ 12- 1
12.1.7 Resend at SOAP transmission error.................................................................................................................... 12- 2
12.1.8 e-RDS setting screen........................................................................................................................................... 12- 2
12.1.9 Sleep operation.................................................................................................................................................... 12- 4
12.1.10 Network Setting (Maintenance).......................................................................................................................... 12- 4
12.1.11 e-RDS Setting (Maintenance) ............................................................................................................................ 12- 4
12.1.12 Trouble shoot ..................................................................................................................................................... 12- 5
12.1.13 Error message ................................................................................................................................................... 12- 5
Chapter 18 Upgrading
18.1 Outline ....................................................................................................................................................18- 1
18.1.1 System Software Type......................................................................................................................................... 18- 1
18.1.2 Upgrading Overview ............................................................................................................................................ 18- 2
18.1.3 Function/Operation Overview ............................................................................................................................. 18- 3
18.1.4 Points to Note at Time of Downloading ............................................................................................................... 18- 5
18.2 Making Preparations ...............................................................................................................................18- 5
18.2.1 Installing the System Software (System CD -> SST)........................................................................................... 18- 5
18.2.2 Installing the System Software (SST -> USB) ..................................................................................................... 18- 7
18.2.3 Making Connections (SST in use) ....................................................................................................................... 18- 9
18.2.4 Making Connections (USB device in use) ......................................................................................................... 18- 10
18.3 Formatting the HDD ..............................................................................................................................18- 10
Contents
Contents
The delivery accessories for the machine can be divided into three patterns in accordance with the available functions.
- In case a large amount of delivery processing or a several types of delivery processing (e.g., staple, punch) are necessary: system configuration 1 for the delivery
accessories.
- In case some delivery processing (e.g., staple) is necessary: system configuration 2 for the delivery accessories.
- In case some delivery processing (e.g., three-system sorting) is necessary: system configuration 3 for the delivery accessories.
The configuration is shown in the next section.
[5]
[1] [3a]
[1a]
[4a]
[4]
[3]
[2a]
[2]
F-1-1
1-1
Chapter 1
The available functions and the accessories needed are shown below.
T-1-1
[3] [2]
[1a]
[1]
F-1-2
The available functions and the accessories needed are shown below.
T-1-4
1-2
Chapter 1
[1a]
F-1-3
1-3
Chapter 1
[2] [10]
[1]
[10a]
[11]
[5]
[3]
[9a]
[9] [4]
[4a]
[8]
[8a]
[6a]
[7]
[6]
F-1-4
1-4
Chapter 1
[1]
[2]
F-1-5
T-1-6
[2]
[1]
F-1-6
T-1-7
1-5
Chapter 1
[2]
[1]
[3] [4]
F-1-7
T-1-8
[1]
[2]
F-1-8
T-1-9
1-6
Chapter 1
[1] [8]
[2] [9]
[3] [10]
[4] [11]
[5] [12]
[6] [13]
[7] [14]
[15]
[20]
[19] [16]
[17]
[18]
F-1-9
1-7
Chapter 1
[4]
[25]
[5]
[14]
[6]
[24] [17]
[7]
[13]
[8] [18]
[23]
[12]
[9]
[19]
[22]
[10]
[11] [21]
[20]
F-1-10
1-8
Chapter 1
[5]
[46] [6]
[45]
[44]
[7]
[43] [8]
[9]
[42] [10]
[11]
[12]
[41] [13]
[14]
[15]
[40]
[16]
[39] [17]
[18]
[38] [19]
[20]
[37] [21]
[22]
[36] [23]
[24]
[25]
[26]
[27]
[28]
[29]
[30]
[31]
[32]
[33]
[34]
[35]
F-1-11
1-9
Chapter 1
[1]
1-10
Chapter 1
1-11
Chapter 1
1-12
Chapter 1
1-13
Chapter 1
1-14
Chapter 1
1-15
Chapter 1
T-1-19
- When authentication is enabled for an SDL or SSO login service, the system administrator setup mode cannot be used if the user type is a general user.
- When authentication is enabled for an SDL or SSO login service, the system administrator setup mode may be used if the user type is an administrator. (If a dialog
box appears, asking you to type in the appropriate administrative group ID and system administration ID No., do so.)
1-16
Chapter 1
1.2.3.1 Cleaning
0013-9655
The machine has some components that must be cleaned by the user on a periodical basis (about once a month); advise the user on how to clean such components:
[2]
[1]
F-1-13
2. Feeder
1) Open the feeder cover.
F-1-14
2) Clean the 3 rollers [1] on the underside of the feeder cover with a cloth moistened with water (well-wrung); then, dry wipe them with a soft, dry cloth.
[1]
F-1-15
3) Hold the knob at the front side, and open the middle cover [1].
[1]
F-1-16
1-17
Chapter 1
4) Clean the 3 rollers [1] with a cloth moistened with water (well-wrung); then, dry wipe them with a soft, dry cloth.
[1]
F-1-17
5) Clean the clear plastic part [1] on the upper side of the middle cover with a cloth moistened with water (well-wrung); then, dry wipe them with a soft, dry cloth.
[1]
F-1-18
6) Close the middle cover and the feeder cover.
3. Original Reading Block
1) Open the feeder.
[1]
F-1-19
2) Clean the original reading block [1] with a cloth moistened with water (well-wrung); then, dry wipe them with a soft, dry cloth.
[1]
F-1-20
3) Clean the side part of the rubber roller [1] with a cloth moistened with water (well-wrung); then, dry wipe them with a soft, dry cloth.
1-18
Chapter 1
[1]
F-1-21
4) Close the feeder.
4. Dustproof Glass
1) Open the front cover [1] of the host machine.
[1]
F-1-22
2) Take out the cleaning tool [1] from the backside of the front cover.
[1]
F-1-23
3) Hold the knob of the cleaning tool [1], and slowly move it back and forth to clean the 4 internal points [2] of the host machine with the pad at the tip of the
cleaning tool.
[1]
[2]
F-1-24
4) Return the cleaning tool to the underside of the front cover, and close the front cover.
1-19
Chapter 1
1.2.3.2 Inspection
0013-9705
The machine is equipped with a breaker for detection of over-current and leakage current for enhanced safety, and it is important to check and see that the breaker
operates properly.
Advise the user to check the breaker on a periodical basis (about once a month), and keep a record of inspection.
Go through the following:
[1]
F-1-25
3) Check to see that the breaker switch [1] shifts to the OFF side.
[1]
F-1-26
4) Shift the breaker switch [1] back to the ON side.
[1]
F-1-27
Check to be sure that the breaker switch is on the ON side. If it has stopped between the ON and OFF sides, push it back to the OFF side and then to the ON side.
1-20
Chapter 1
1.2.4 Safety
Laser beam radiation may pose a danger to the human body. A laser scanner mounted on the machine is sealed with the protection housing and external cover to
prevent the laser beam from leaking to the outside. The laser beam never leaks out of the scanner as far as users operate the machine normally
The following warnings are given to comply with Safety Principles (EN60950).
Laserstrahlen können für den menschlichen Körper gefährlich sein. Aus diesem Grund ist das optische Lasersystem mit einem Schutzgehäuse und einer Außenab-
deckung dicht verschlossen und hat eine Struktur, die keine Laserstrahlen nach außen dringen lässt. Unter der Voraussetzung, dass der Benutzer dieses Gerät normal
bedient, ist ein Austritt von Laserstrahlen daher ausgeschlossen.
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health of the US Food and Drum Administration put into force regulations concerning laser products on August 2, 1976.
These regulations apply to laser products manufactured on and after August 1, 1976, and the sale of laser products not certified under the regulations is banned
within the Untied States. The label shown here indicates compliance with the CDRH regulations, and its attachment is required on all laser products that are soled
in the United States.
F-1-28
F-1-29
1-21
Chapter 1
[2]
[1]
[3]
[4]
F-1-30
1. About Toner
The machine's toner is a non-toxic material made of plastic, iron, and small amounts of dye.
The following warnings are given to comply with Safety Principles (EN60950).
Body Console
Photosensitive medium OPC drum (30-mm dia) X 4
Exposure method Laser exposure
Charging method Roller charge
Development method (mono) Dry two components
Development method (color) Dry two components
Cassette pickup method Separation retard (guide center)
Multifeeder pickup method Separation duplo (guide center)
Transfer method belt transfer
Transfer method (primary Transfer roller
transfer)
Transfer method (secondary belt + transfer roller
transfer)
1-22
Chapter 1
1.2.5.2 Others
0013-8343
T-1-20
1-23
Chapter 1
iR C3380 Series
Type of paper First/second delivery third delivery
Cassette Manual Both Cassette Manual Both
feeding sides feeding sides
Standard paper A4, LTR 33/30 25 33/30 30* 25 30*
A4R, LTRR 17 17 17 17 17 17
B4, LGL 17 17 17 17 17 17
A3 15 15 15 15 15 10
LDR 14 14 14 14 14 10
A5R, STMTR 13 13 13 13 13 13
12"X18" 12 12 12 - - -
SRA3 - 7 7 - - -
Heavy paper 1 (105 to 163g/m2) A4, LTR 16.5/15 12.5 - - - -
A4R, LTRR 8.5 8.5 - - - -
B4, LGL 8.5 8.5 - - - -
A3 7.5 7.5 - - - -
LDR 7.0 7.0 - - - -
SRA3 - 7.0 - - - -
12"X18" 7.0 6.5 - - - -
A5R, STMTR 6.5 12.0 - - - -
Card - - - - - -
Heavy paper 2 (up to 164g/m2) A4, LTR, B5 - 12.5 - - - -
A4R, LTRR - 8.5 - - - -
B4, LGL - 8.5 - - - -
A3 - 7.5 - - - -
LDR - 7.0 - - - -
SRA3 - 7.0 - - - -
12"X18" - 7.0 - - - -
A5R, B5R, - 6 to 2 - - - -
STMTR
A5, LTR - 12.5 - - - -
OHP Color 5 5 - - - -
BK 20 20 - - - -
1200dpi A4, LTR 16.5/15 12.5 16.5/15 16.5/15 12.5 16.5/15
A4R, LTRR 8.5 8.5 8.5 8.5 8.5 8.5
B4, LGL 8.5 8.5 8.5 8.5 8.5 8.5
A3 7.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 5.0**
LDR 7.0 7.0 7.0 7.0 7.0 5.0**
SRA3 - 7.0 - - - -
12"X18" 7.0 7.0 7.0 - - -
A5R, STMTR 6.5 6.5 6.5 6.5 6.5 6.5
Card - 12.0 - - - -
T-1-22
1-24
Chapter 1
1-25
Chapter 2 Installation
Contents
Contents
Select the site of installation against the following requirements; if possible, visit the user's before delivery of the machine:
1) There must be a power outlet properly grounded and rated as indicated (+, -10%) for exclusive use by the machine.
2) The environment of the room must be as indicated in the following diagram, and the machine must not be installed near a water faucet, water boiler, humidifier,
or refrigerator:
(%RH)
100
[C]
90
85
[B]
75
70 [A]
50
25
20
15
10
5
0 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 (degC)
7.5 23 27.5 32.5
F-2-1
<Assured environmental zone>
[A]: A zone. All quality standard items are satisfied.
[B]: B zone. Some quality standard items are inferior to those in A zone or not satisfied.
[C]: C zone. Copying operation is performed normally without any safety issues, malfunction, and errors in display.
3) The machine must not be installed near a source of fire or in an area subject to dust or ammonium gas.
If the area is exposed to direct rays of the sun, provide curtains to the window.
4) The room must be well ventilated. (The level of ozone generated by the machine in use will not affect the individuals around it. However, some may find its odor
to be unpleasant, as when working in a poorly ventilated room.)
5) The floor of the machine must be level so that the feet of the machine will remain in contact and the machine will remain level.
6) The machine must be at least 100 mm away from any wall, permitting unobstructed use.
Without accessory
4" (100 mm) or more
49" (1,243 mm )
2-1
Chapter 2
/ / iR C3380 / iR C2880
The following table shows the combination of accessories that are set at the right side of the host machine.
When setting the accessories indicated in the table, refer to the table below and check the combination before the setup.
T-2-1
Document Tray-J1 Voice Guidance Kit-B1 Voice Operation Kit-A1 Card Reader-C1
Document Tray-J1 - no no yes
Voice Guidance Kit-B1 no - no yes
Voice Operation Kit-A1 no no - yes
Card Reader-C1 yes yes yes -
yes: Available no: Unavailable
2-2
Chapter 2
MEMO:
Remove all bundled parts in the cassette.
The following may Immigration papers, Badges Also, all literary, musical, artistic YOU MAY BE COMMITTING
or insignia and typographical works are A CRIMINAL OFFENCE
not be copied: Bonds or other certificates copyrighted. Whilst certain FOR WHICH YOU MAY
Paper money, vouchers of indebteness reproduction of copyright work BE PROSECUTED.
Instruments mayInternalImmigration
The following
Negotiable Revenue
papers, Badges Also, all literary,
may be permitted for `fairmusical,
dealing´ artistic YOU MAY BE COMMITTING
or insigniaStamps and typographical
eg., for research, private study works or are This list is A aCRIMINAL
guide onlyOFFENCE
not be
Certificates of copied:
Deposit, (cancelled
Bondsor uncancelled)
or other certificates copyrighted.
for the purpose Whilst certain
of criticism or
Passports
Paper money, vouchers reproduction of literary,
copyright and is notFOR WHICH YOU MAY
a complete
Cheques or drafts drawn bypapers, review, generally reproduction a work
ofmusical,
Government The following
Service or mayof indebteness
Immigration Badges mayitem
Also,
be and
all
permitted for `fair dealing´
BEshould
artistic
listing. You PROSECUTED.
YOUtakeMAY BE COMMITTING
Legal Limitations of Negotiable Governmental
Instruments Internalor insignia Stampscopyrighted
agencies
Revenue
is not permitted
typographical works
legalare
or advice if in A
any doubt. OFFENCE
CRIMINAL
Colour Copier Usage drafts drawn not
by beofcopied:
Certificates Licences
Deposit, and Registrations
Bonds
(cancelled or or other certificates
uncancelled)
eg.,permission
without the for copyrighted.
research, of private
theWhilst study
certain This list FOR
is a guide
WHICH onlyYOU MAY
Governmental agencies
Paper money, vouchers
documents forof
motor vehicles
Immigration copyright for the reproduction
owner. purpose of all
criticism ormusical,
drawn papers, Badges
Passports The following may indebteness Also, ofliterary,
copyright workand artistic
is not aPROSECUTED.
complete
BEFU5-8208
YOU MAY BE COMMITTING
Cheques or drafts by review, may
generally
beand reproduction
typographical
permitted ofworks
for `fair a
dealing´are You should
Negotiable oragencies
insignia Stamps copyrighted listing. take
Legal Limitations of Government not beInstruments
Service or
copied: Internal
Governmental Revenue item
eg., for is not permitted
copyrighted.
research, Whilststudy
private certain
or advice
legal
A CRIMINAL OFFENCE
Certificates
drafts drawn by of Deposit, andBonds oror other certificates
withoutforthethe
permission This if in
FOR
list any
is doubt.only
aWHICH
guide YOU MAY
Colour Copier Usage Paper money, Licences
vouchers (cancelled
of motor
uncancelled)
Registrations
indebteness purpose of
reproduction ofthe
of copyright
criticism or work and is not BE PROSECUTED.
a complete
Passports
Governmental agencies Instruments
Negotiable documents for
Cheques drawn copyright
vehicles
or drafts by owner.
review, may be permitted
generally for `fairofdealing´
reproduction a FU5-8208
listing. You should take
Legal Limitations of Government Service or Internal Revenue
Governmental agencies Stamps eg.,
copyrighted for research,
item is not private
permitted study or
draftsCertificates
drawn by of Deposit,Licences (cancelled or uncancelled)withoutforthe This list
legal advice isany
if in a guide only
doubt.
Colour Copier Usage and Registrations the purpose of
permission of criticism
the or and is not a complete
Passports
Governmental agencies Cheques or drafts drawn by copyrightreview,
owner.generally reproduction of a
Legal Limitations of Government Service ordocuments for motor vehicles
Governmental agencies copyrighted item is not permitted
FU5-8208
listing. You should take
legal advice if in any doubt.
Colour Copier Usage drafts drawn by Licences and Registrations without the permission of the
Governmental agencies documents for motor vehicles copyright owner. FU5-8208
[1] Developing assembly (Bk/Y/M/C) 1 pc. each [8] Cassette size label 2 pc.
[2]* Lower right cover (Lower) 1 pc. [9] Shut-Down label 1 pc.
[3] Reader communication cable 1 pc. [10] Document Size Label (models with DADF only) 1 pc.
[4] Touch pen 1 pc. [11] Reversing end plate guide 1 pc.
[5] Power cable 1 pc. [12] MP Side Guide Plate Stopper 1 pc.
[6] Service book container 1 pc. [13] Stamp (models with DADF only, for attaching the ADF) 1 pc.
[7] Copy Inhibit Label 4 pc. [14] Toner protect sheet (Keep it in Service book container) 1 pc.
* Use only in the case that the cassette pedestal is not installed.
iR C2280i/C3380i iR C2280/C3380
Manual CD ROM yes yes
User's Guide yes yes
Sending and Facsimile Guide yes -
Tutorial CD (UKE) yes yes
Tutorial CD (FRE) yes yes
Tutorial CD (ITA) yes yes
Tutorial CD (GER) yes yes
Universal Send Trial Kit-B1 yes yes
MEAP Administration Software CD yes yes
UFR II/PCL/PS Driver/Utility CD yes -
iW MC CD yes -
Release Note yes yes
Network Quick Start Guide yes -
PS/PCL/UFR II Printer Guide yes -
EULA yes yes
2-3
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-8
2) Press the claw down [1], and detach the handle cover [2].
[1]
[2]
[2] F-2-9
[1] [1] 3) Press the release lever [1] to open the lower right cover [2] of the host
F-2-6
machine.
4) Remove 4 tapes and the protection sheet [3] attached to the duplexing unit.
3) Remove all the tapes from the main body.
2-4
Chapter 2
[1]
[2]
[3] [1]
F-2-12
7) Press the push-button [1], and hold the grip [2] to open the ITB unit [3]
upward.
[1]
Do not touch the ITB. If the ITB is scratched, it may cause the pickup fault
[1] or degradation of the print quality.
F-2-11 In case the print quality is degraded due to touching the ITB, clean the ITB
6) Turn the handle [1] by 180 degrees, and hold the handle [1] and the grip with soft and dry cloth.
[2] to slide the process unit [3] until it stops. If the print quality is not improved, execute the following:
[Additional Functions] > [Adjustment/Cleaning] > [Cleaning inside Main
Unit] > [Start]
Make sure to pull out the process unit until it stops. If closing the lower right
cover while the process unit is pulled out in a halfway, the high voltage point
of the secondary transfer roller contacts to the ITB belt, so it may scratch the
ITB belt.
2-5
Chapter 2
[1]
[1]
[2]
F-2-17
10) Hold the drum cartridge with both hands as shown in the figure, and
shake it up and down 5 times to ensure the developer inside spread
evenly.
F-2-14
9) Take care of the following items to unpack the entire drum cartridge
package.
Make sure to remove the drying agent [1] and the antifriction sheet [2] first.
F-2-18
11) Hold down the drum cartridge as shown in the figure, and draw the
sealing tape [1] in the direction shown by the arrow.
[2] [1]
[1]
F-2-15
- Do not remove the sealing tape [1] and the drum protection cover [2].
- Do not press the drum area [3] over the drum protection cover [2]. It may
cause the damage of the drum area.
- Do not touch the waste toner shutter [4]. It may loosen the stopper [4].
F-2-19
12) Hold the drum cartridge as shown in the figure below to set to the
specified position of the ITB unit.
- Do not press the drum area over the drum protection cover. It may cause
the damage of the drum area.
[4] - Check to see if the waste toner shutter label [1] is visible when setting. If
the drum cartridge is set with the waste toner shutter [2] loosen, the waste
toner shutter label [1] cannot be seen and the parts may be broken at
rotating the handle in the step 17).
- Check to see if the drum cartridge is inserted to the specified position.
[1]
[3]
[2]
F-2-16
- Make sure to execute in the order of Y/M/C/Bk for step 10) through 12).
2-6
Chapter 2
[1]
[2]
F-2-20
Lock
Unlock
[1]
F-2-23
- Make sure to release the tip-resistant arm [1] first, and then, close the ITB
- Do not close the ITB cover with the drum protection cover fixed. unit. If you try to close the ITB unit while the tip-resistant arm is fixed, it
- Make sure not to put light to the drum for 5 min or more after detaching the may cause damage of the tip-resistant arm.
drum protection cover. - If you press the areas other than the sealing areas to close the ITB unit, the
ITB cover may make contact with the ITB.
[2]
[1]
[1]
F-2-22
14) Lock the shutter levers [1] of each drum cartridge in the direction of the
arrow.
[2]
F-2-24
16) Press down the process unit onto the main body.
17) Turn the handle of the process unit by 180 degrees counterclockwise.
18) Press the lever [1] and set back the release lever.
2-7
Chapter 2
[1] [1]
[2]
F-2-25
19) Fix the process unit in place with 2 screws that were removed in the step
5) to attach the handle cover.
Close the lower right cover of the main body after fixing surely the process
unit. The position of the process unit may be displaced in closing the lower
right cover of the main body first.
[1] [2]
F-2-26
2) Set the toner retainer Bk [1] to the host machine, and turn the lever [2] in
the direction of the arrow to lock.
[1]
F-2-28
2) Connect the power cable (for outlet) of the main body.
3) Turn on the main power switch.
2-8
Chapter 2
[1] [2]
F-2-29 F-2-32
2) Using tweezers, fix the stamp in place, making sure that the print face of
the stamp faces upward.
Do not attach the service container:
- Inside the machine
- in the position onto which attachment of the service book container may
block off the louver area Be sure to push in the stamp until a click is felt. The presence of a gap can
- in the position onto which attachment of the service book container may cause paper to jam.
block off the grip area
MEMO:
In case there is no pedestal, attach the service book container on the left cover
of the main body.
<Touch Pen>
1) Place the touch pen [1] in the control panel.
F-2-33
<Size Label (only if w/ DADF)>
1) Match the side guide (rear) [1] against the index A4/A3 or LTR/11X17
indicated by a marking [2].
2) Attach the size label [3] of the correct paper configuration to the feeder
cover.
MEMO:
This label is designed to help individuals needing different angles of view.
[1] Move the label back and forth (in the direction of the arrow [5]) so that the
F-2-30 index [4] of the side guide (front) will match the appropriate index of the size
label.
<Lower Right Cover (Lower)>
1) Hook the claws in the order of [A] and [B], and attach the Lower right
cover (Lower) [1].
(Go through this procedure when double-deck pedestal is not installed.) [1]
[2]
[3]
[B]
[A]
[1]
7
1x1
R/1
F-2-31 /A3
AT
A4
[4]
F-2-34
2-9
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-35
<Shut-Down Label>
1) Attach the Shut-Down warning label [1] of the appropriate language to the
right rear cover of the machine (i.e.,. on the left inside [2] of the main
power supply.). F-2-39
F-2-36
<Reversing End Plate Guide>
1) Attach the reversing trailing edge guide [1] to the delivery assembly.
[1]
[1] [1]
F-2-40
MEMO:
No need for adjustment in the case of no cassette pedestal.
MEMO:
MP side guide plate stopper is the part to attach in the case of not using the
paper in the size of A4 width or more when making prints from the manual
feeder tray.
Ask user whether to attach this part, and do the attaching work if there is a
request from the user.
1) Open the manual feeder tray [1] to attach the MP side guide plate stopper
[2].
- 2 claws [3]
[2]
[1]
F-2-41
4) Pick the lever [1] of the side guide plate, and move the side guide plate to
the desired position.
5) Shift down the rear guide plate [2] to the right to detach. Adjust the rear
guide plate to suit the appropriate size indicated on the base of the
[3] cassette.
[1]
F-2-38
2-10
Chapter 2
(–) (+)
0
2
4
F-2-42
6
6) Attach the cassette size label [1] that matches the selected size of paper to
the front of the cassette.
8
10
2.5±1.5mm
F-2-44
<In the case that the cassette 1, or the cassette 2 is out of specification>
1) In the case of the device with the 2-cassette pedestal, detach the cassette
lower right cover [1].
2) Open the cassette upper right cover [2].
[1]
F-2-43
7) Deposit paper in the cassette; then, slide in the cassette.
8) Perform the same for the other cassette.
9) If a cassette pedestal is used, set it by referring to its Installation
Procedure. [2]
2-11
Chapter 2
F-2-47
F-2-50
A. Making Adjustments for the Cassette 1
A-1) Free the 2 claws [1], and pull the grip (right front) [2] in the direction B-3) Tighten the fixing screw.
of the arrow to detach. B-4) Slide back the cassette 2.
B-5) Make a copy using the cassette 2 as the source of paper; then, check
to see that the margin in the image front direction is 2.5 +/-1.5 mm.
(–) (+)
0
F-2-48 2
A-2) Loosen the fixing screw [2] of the adjusting plate [1].
A-3) By referring to the index you took note of in step 5), move the 4
adjusting plate back and forth. Moving it toward the rear of the machine
will increase the margin on the image front. 6
8
10
2.5±2.0mm
F-2-51
2) If the margin is as indicated, change the adjustment value of the horizontal
registration for the 2nd side for the cassette 1.
- COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C1RE
An increase by '1' will decrease the margin on the front side by 0.1 mm.
3) Enter the adjustment value for the horizontal registration of the 2nd side
for the cassette 1 as the adjustment value for the horizontal registration of
the 2nd side of the cassette 2.
- COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C2RE
4) Make a copy using the cassette 2 as the source of paper; then, check to
make sure that the margin on the front side is 2.5 +/-2.0 mm.
5) If the value is not as indicated, change the adjustment value of the 2nd side
F-2-49 for the cassette 2.
- COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C2RE
A-4) Tighten the fixing screw. An increase by '1' (for DJ-C2RE) will decrease the horizontal registration
A-5) Slide in the cassette 1. on the front side by 0.1 mm.
A-6) Make a copy using the cassette 1 as the source of paper; then, check 6) Record the new values on the service label.
to see that the margin in the image front direction is 2.5 +/-1.5 mm. - ADJ-C1RE
A-7) Mount back the grip (front right). - ADJ-C2RE
7) Press the Reset key twice to end service mode.
B. Making Adjustments to the Cassette 2
B-1) Loosen the fixing screw [2] of the adjusting plate [1]. 3. Adjusting the Margin for the Manual Feed Tray (1st side; mechanical
B-2) By referring to the index you took note of in step 5), move the adjustment)
adjusting plate back and forth. Moving it toward the rear of the machine 1) Place paper in the manual feed tray. For instructions, see the label attached
will increase the margin on the image front side. to the manual feed tray.
2) Make a copy using the manual feed tray as the source of paper; then, check
to make sure that the margin on the front side is 2.5 +/-1.5 mm.
2-12
Chapter 2
0 0
2 2
4 4
6 6
8 8
10 10
2.5±1.5mm 2.5±2.0mm
F-2-52 F-2-55
- If the value is not as indicated, make the following adjustments: 2) If the value is not as indicated, change the horizontal registration
3) Remove the paper from the manual feed tray. adjustment value for the 2nd side for the manual feed tray.
4) In case the MP side guide plate stopper [1] is attached, slide the knob [2] - COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-MFRE
in the direction of the arrow and unlock the stopper. An increase by '1'(ADJ-MFRE) will decrease the margin on the front side
by 0.1 mm.
3) Record the new adjustment value on the service label.
- ADJ-MFRE
4) Press the Reset key twice to end service mode.
L1
[2]
F-2-53
5) Loosen the 2 fixing screws [1] on the manual feed tray upper cover.
6) With reference to the value you took note of in step 2), move the manual
feed upper cover [2] back and forth. Moving it toward the rear of the image
machine will increase the margin on the front side.
[2]
F-2-56
An increase in REGIST will shift the image toward the leading edge of
the paper.
F-2-57
An increase in RG-REFE will shift the image toward the leading edge of
paper (toward the trailing edge of feed).
2-13
Chapter 2
Perform the following work only if the machine is equipped with printer functions:
1) Hold down the control panel power switch for 3 sec or more.
2) Operate on the touch panel according to the shut-down sequence indicated so that the main power switch may be turned off.
3) Turn off the main power switch.
4) Connect the network cable to the machine, and turn on its main power switch.
5) Inform the system administrator of the site that the installation work is complete, and ask him/her to make network settings.
You must select 'On' for the following mode item before making network settings:
[Additional Fanction] > [System Settings] > [Network Settings] > [Change Settings/Display Connection Confirm].
6) When network settings have appropriately been made, turn off and then back on the main power as described in steps 1) through 3) above so that the new settings
are valid.
1) Make the following selections in service mode: COPIER > TEST > NETWORK > PING.
2) Enter the IP address using the keypad on the control panel, and press the OK key.
3) Press the Start key.
- If the PING check is successful, the machine will indicate 'OK'; otherwise, it will indicate 'NG'.
IP address input
Result(OK/NG)
+/- OK
F-2-58
The term "remote address" refers to the IP address of a PC terminal connected to and operating in a TCP/IP network environment to which the machine belongs.
1) Inform the system administrator that you will be checking the connection to the network using PING.
2) Check with the system administrator to find out the remote host address.
3) Enter the remote host address you obtained in PING.
4) If the indication is 'OK', the machine is correctly connected to the network.
5) If the indication is 'NG', the machine is not correctly connected to the network. Go through the following troubleshooting steps:
Go through the following steps only if the machine is connected to the network:
If the connection to the network is not correct, you may suspect the following:
a. poor connection between the network and the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C)
b. wrong TCP/IP setting on the machine
c. faulty main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C) or poorly mounted PCB
2-14
Chapter 2
A loopback address returns before it reaches the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C); therefore, executing PING using a loopback address will enable you to
find out whether the TCP/IP settings of the machine are correct.
1) Enter the loopback address (127.0.0.1) to PING.
- if the machine indicates 'NG', check the TCP/IP settings of the machine once again, and then execute PING once again.
- if the machine indicates 'OK', check the local host address.
The local host address is the IP address of the machine; therefore, executing PING using the local host address, which returns after it has reached the main controller
PCB (sub LANBAR-C), enables you to find out if the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C) is good or not.
1) Enter the IP address of the machine to PING.
- if the machine indicates 'NG', make the following checks/corrections, and execute PING once again.
a. faulty IP address of the machine: check with the system administrator to find out if the IP address (and its settings) assigned to the machine is correct.
b. poor connection of the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C): check the connectors associated with the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C).
c. faulty main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C): replace the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C).
- if the machine indicates 'OK', suspect a fault in the user's network environment. Report to the system administrator, ask for corrective action.
1) Place the test chart on the copyboard glass, and make copies using the individual cassettes as the source of paper. then, check the images.
- check to see that the machine does not produce any abnormal noise.
- check to see that the images are produced correctly at different magnifications.
- check to see that the machine produces as many copies as specified normally.
2) Make settings (Additional Function ; e.g., date, time) to suit the needs of the user.
3) Start service mode.
4) Make the user-related settings to suit the needs of the user (COPIER > OPTION > USER).
5) Print out test prints in service mode (COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > P-PRINT).
6) Put away the printed test print [1] in the service book case.
F-2-59
7) Press the Reset key twice to end service mode.
8) Clean up the area around the machine, and fill out the service book.
2-15
Chapter 2
If you need to relocate the machine after installation by truck or other means of transportation, be sure to perform the following work in advance:
If you want to move the machine intact with its cassette pedestal, be sure not to use the machine's grips; otherwise, the machine will come off the cassette pedestal
as when it is moved over a step. Be sure to lift the cassette pedestal.
1) Fix the scanner in place using the scanner fixing screw [1] that has been set aside from the time of installation.
[1]
F-2-60
2) Put paper on the copyboard glass.
3) Remove all toner cartridges and developing assembly so that the developing rotary will not rotate in response to vibration occurring in transit.
[1]
F-2-61
2-16
Chapter 2
1) Using a flat-blade screwdriver, free the 2 claws [2] of the delivery cover [1] to remove.
[1]
[2]
F-2-62
2) Fitting the 2 protrusions [1] at the both edges of the tray to the holes, attach the tray [2].
[1]
[2]
[1]
F-2-63
3) Connect the power cable to the outlet.
4) Turn on the main power switch.
5) Login to the service mode.
6) Select the followings to register '1': COPIER > OPTION > ACC >OUT-TRAY
7) Check to see the following menu items are added: [Initial Setting/Register] > [Common Specification Setting] > [Delivery Tray Setting]
8) Select the copy at the tray B, and execute test print.
9) Check to see that the copy is delivered to the copy tray.
10) According to user's request, reset the tray.
2-17
Chapter 2
To install the card reader-C1, the card reader mounting kit-B1 is necessary.
<Card Reader-C1>
F-2-64
[1]
2-18
Chapter 2
- After installing the card reader-C1, enter the card number to use in the service mode of this machine by selecting the following: COPIER > FUNCTION >
INSTALL > CARD. Unless entering the card number, the card fails to be recognized when inserting the card.
- When installing the machine, see the Combination Table for Accessory Installation.
1) Open the cassette right upper cover [1]. If the cassette pedestal was installed, open also the cassette right lower cover [2].
[1]
[2]
F-2-66
2) Pull out the reader power supply cable [1].
3) Detach the right rear cover [2].
- 4 screws [3]
[2] [1]
[3]
F-2-67
4) Using nippers cut off the face plate [2] of the rear right cover [1].
2-19
Chapter 2
[2]
[1]
F-2-68
5) Connect the relay cable [1] to the connector area [2] of the host machine.
[1] [2]
F-2-69
6) Pass the relay cable [2] from the cut off [1], and attach the rear right cover [3].
- 4 screws [4] (removed in the step 3))
[2]
[3] [1]
[4]
F-2-70
7) Close the cassette upper right cover and the cassette lower right cover.
2-20
Chapter 2
8) Attach the card reader [1] and the card reader base plate [2].
- 1 toothed washer [3]
- 1 screw (TP; M4X8) [4]
F-2-71
9) 9) Fix the relay cable [1] of the card reader in place.
- 1 edge saddle [2]
- 1 wire saddle [3]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-72
10) Connect the relay cable [1] that is connected in the step 5) with the relay cable [2] of the card reader.
[1] [2]
F-2-73
11) Fit the 2 bosses [1] to attach the card reader [2].
- 1 toothed washer [3]
- 1 screw (TP; M4X25) [4]
2-21
Chapter 2
[1] [2]
[3] [4]
F-2-74
12) Plug the power cable (for outlet) into the outlet.
13) Turn ON the switch of the main power.
14) Enter the card number (1 through 2001) to use by selecting the following in service mode of host machine:
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > CARD
- Enter the smallest number among the cards used by user
- 1000 cards from the input number are usable
15) Turn OFF the power supply following the shutdown sequence.
16) Insert the usable card (that is registered to use) to check that it is standby state.
2.8.4 Installation Procedure in the imageWARE Accounting Manager (hereinafter referred to iWAM) Environment
0013-8497
1) Check to see that 'ID00000001 to ID00001000' have been created in '[Initial Settings / Registration] > [System Administration Settings] > [Department ID
management] > [Count Management]' (In the case of entering '1' as the first number in 'Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > CARD')
2) Press [Reset] to exit from [Initial Settings / Registration].
3) Select: [Initial Settings / Registration] > [System Administration Settings] > [Network Settings] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IP Address], and make settings of [IP
Address], [Gateway Address], and [Subnet Mask] suitable for the user's environment.
4) Press [Reset] to exit from [Initial Settings / Registration].
5)
Be sure that without selecting: [Initial Settings / Registration] > [System Administration Settings] > [System Administrator Information Settings] and then regis-
tering [System Administration Department ID] and [System Administration Password], 'Card Registration to the Device' cannot be executed in the iWAM settings.
Select: [Initial Settings / Registration] > [System Administration Settings] > [System Administrator Information Settings], and then enter given numbers for
[System Administration Department ID] and [System Administration Password].
6) Press [Reset] to exit from [Initial Settings / Registration].
7) Turn OFF the power supply following the shutdown sequence.
2-22
Chapter 2
<Document Tray-J1>
[1]
When installing the machine, see the Combination Table for Accessory Installation.
[1]
F-2-76
2) Tighten 2 stepped screws (RS tightening) [1] to the upper right cover of the host machine.
A: In the case that the card reader is not attached to the host machine
2-23
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-77
B: In the case that the card reader is attached to the host machine
[1]
F-2-78
3) Set the cut-offs [2] of the support plate on the Document Tray [1] with the stepped screws [3].
[3] [1]
[2] [2]
F-2-79
2-24
Chapter 2
[1]
[2]
[3]
F-2-80
1) Release five wire saddles [1] on the rear upper cover to free two cables [2] upward.
[2]
[1]
F-2-81
2) Detach the rear upper cover [1].
- 4 screws [2] (Remove)
- 3 screws [3] (Loosen)
2-25
Chapter 2
[2]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-82
3) Open the cassette right upper cover [1]. If the cassette pedestal was installed, open also the cassette right lower cover [2].
[1]
[2]
F-2-83
4) Pull out the reader power supply cable [1].
5) Detach the right rear cover [2].
- 4 screws [3]
[2] [1]
[3]
F-2-84
6) Remove the key switch bracket [1].
- 1 screw [2]
2-26
Chapter 2
[1]
[2]
F-2-85
7) Fix the key switch unit [2] to the key switch bracket [1].
- 1 screw (binding; M4X6) [3]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-86
8) Disconnect the connector [1] on the main body from the wire saddle [2] to get it out to the rear side of the main body.
9) Close the wire saddle.
[2]
[1]
F-2-87
10) Fix the key switch bracket [1].
- 1 screw [2] (Screw removed in the step 6))
[1]
[2]
F-2-88
11) Connect the connector of the key switch unit to the connector [1] of the main unit.
2-27
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-89
12) Remove the blanking area [2] of the right rear cover [1] with nipper, etc.
[1]
[2]
F-2-90
13) Attach the right rear cover.
14) Close the cassette right upper cover and the cassette right lower cover.
15) Connect the reader power supply cable.
16) Attach the rear upper cover.
17) Fix the cable removed in the step 1) to the wire saddle.
18) Connect the power supply cable to the power plug.
19) Turn ON the main power switch.
2-28
Chapter 2
iR C3380
- In the case of mounting the cassette heater unit to the cassette of the host machine, the heater PCB needs to be mounted.
- In the case of mounting the cassette heater unit to the cassette pedestal, the heater PCB and the cassette heater attachment need to be mounted.
Prepare the following parts because each part of the heater PCB is assigned as service part.
[1] [2]
[3]
F-2-91
T-2-2
[1] [2]
F-2-92
T-2-3
2-29
Chapter 2
To operate the Cassette Heater Unit, the Heater PCB needs to be mounted.
F-2-93
3) Fit the 3 hooks [2] of the heater unit [1] to the slit of the base plate to match the hole positions.
In the case of mounting the heater unit, make sure to check that the 3 hooks [2] are tightly fitted and there is no jiggle.
F-2-94
4) Mount the heater unit [1] with the screw (binding; M4X6) [2], and connect the connector [3].
F-2-95
5) Attach the connector cover [1].
6) Attach the plastic film [2] (for protecting the AC cable) over the cable [3] to fit the end of the connector cover [A] and the end of the rear side of the host machine
[B].
2-30
Chapter 2
F-2-96
7) Put back the cassette 1 and 2.
To operate the Cassette Heater Unit, the Heater PCB and Cassette Heater Attachment needs to be mounted.
F-2-97
3) Fit the 3 hooks [2] of the heater unit [1] to the slit of the base plate to match the hole positions.
In the case of mounting the heater unit, make sure to check that the 3 hooks [2] are tightly fitted and there is no jiggle.
F-2-98
4) Mount the heater unit [1] with the screw (binding; M4X6) [2], and connect the connector [3].
2-31
Chapter 2
F-2-99
5) Attach the connector cover [1].
6) Attach the plastic film [2] (for protecting the AC cable) over the cable [3] to fit the end of the connector cover [A] and the end of the rear side of the host machine
[B].
F-2-100
7) Put back the cassette 3 and 4.
1) Open the cassette upper right cover [1]. In the case that the cassette pedestal is mounted, also open the cassette lower right cover [2].
[1]
[2]
F-2-101
2) Disconnect the reader power cable [1].
3) Detach the rear right cover [2].
- 4 screws [3]
2-32
Chapter 2
[2] [1]
[3]
F-2-102
4) Using nippers, cut off the face plate [2] of the detached rear right cover.
[1]
[2]
F-2-103
5) Detach the lower rear cover [1].
- lattice connector [2] (in the case that the cassette pedestal is mounted)
- 3 screws [3] (to loosen)
- 6 screws [4] (to remove)
[3]
[4] [4]
[1] [2]
[4]
F-2-104
6) Pull out the 3 harnesses of the AC connector [1] from the cable guides [2] to remove them from the 2 wire saddles [3].
7) Remove the harness of the DC connector [5] from the edge saddle [4].
2-33
Chapter 2
[1]
[3]
[1]
F-2-105
8) Fit the 2 claws [1] to mount the heater PCB [2].
- 2 screws (TP; M3X6) [3]
[3]
[1]
[2] [3]
[1]
F-2-106
9) Connect the AC connector [1] to the heater PCB, and pass it through the edge saddle [2].
[1]
[2]
F-2-107
10) Connect the 2 AC connectors [1] to the heater PCB, and pass them through the edge saddle [2].
2-34
Chapter 2
[1]
[2]
F-2-108
11) Connect the DC connector [1] to the heater PCB, and pass it through the edge saddle [2].
[1] [2]
F-2-109
12) By reversing the steps used to remove covers, attach the followings:
- lower rear cover
- lattice connector (in the case that the cassette pedestal is mounted)
- rear right cover
- reader power cable
13) In the case that the cassette pedestal is mounted, close the cassette lower right cover. Close the upper right cover.
14) Turn ON the heater switch.
Prepare the following parts because each part of the Cassette Heater Attachment is assigned as service part.
2-35
Chapter 2
1) Detach the small cover [2] of the lower rear cover [1] (the detached small cover is not used).
- 1 screw [3]
2) Detach the lower rear cover [1].
- lattice connector [4]
- 3 screws [5] (to loosen)
- 6 screws [6] (to remove)
2-36
Chapter 2
[5]
[6]
[3]
[6]
[2]
[6]
[1] [4]
[6]
F-2-111
3) Connect the connector [3] of the environment heater outlet [2] to the heater PCB [1], and fix it in place with the edge saddle [4].
4) Attach the heater outlet [2] with the screw (TP; M3X6) [5].
[3] [1]
[4]
[2]
[5]
F-2-112
5) Attach the lower rear cover.
6) Detach the rear cover [1] of the cassette pedestal.
- 4 screws [2]
[1]
[2] [2]
F-2-113
7) Using nippers, cut off the face plate [2] of the rear cover [1] of the cassette pedestal.
2-37
Chapter 2
[1]
[2]
F-2-114
8) Connect the connector [1] of the power code unit, and while fitting the hooks [2] to the holes [3] found at the bottom of the cassette pedestal, attach it with 2
screws (TP; M3X6) [4].
[1] [3]
[2]
F-2-115
[4]
F-2-116
9) Attach the rear cover of the cassette pedestal.
10) Connect the lattice connector to the host machine.
11) Connect the power code [1] to the power code unit [2] and the environment heater outlet [3] of the host machine.
12) Attach the outlet label [4].
2-38
Chapter 2
[4]
[3]
[1] [2]
F-2-117
13) Attach the plug cover [1] on the power code [2].
- 1 screw [3] (use the screw that was removed in the step 1)
- 1 screw (TP; M3X6) [4]
[2]
2-39
Chapter 2
[1] Speaker Unit (Upper) 1pc. [10] Screw (binding; M4X6) 1pc.
[2] Speaker Unit (Lower) 1pc. [11]* Screw (binding; M4X40) 2pc.
[3] Cable (1300 mm) 1pc. [12] Screw (binding; M3X16) 1pc.
[4]* Cable (1850 mm) 1pc. [13] Screw (binding; M4X16) 1pc.
[5] Cord Guide 7pc. [14] Ferrite Core 1pc.
(Use 2pc in this machine) [15]* Wire Saddle 1pc.
[6] Voice Board 1pc. [16] Voice Guidance Kit Users Guide 1pc.
[7]* Voice Board Face Plate 1pc. [17] Voice Guidance Kit Users Guide CD 1pc.
[8] Voice Board Face Plate 1pc. [18] FCC/IC Sheet (Except Japan) 1pc.
[9] Screw (binding; M3X6) 2pc.
2-40
Chapter 2
When installing the machine, see the Combination Table for Accessory Installation.
1. Installation Procedure
1) Release five wire saddles [1] on the rear upper cover, make two cables [2] coming off upward.
[2]
[1]
F-2-120
2) Detach the rear upper cover [1].
- 3 screws [2] (to remove)
- 6 screws [3] (to loosen)
[2]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-121
3) Detach the controller box cover [1].
- 14 screws [2]
[2]
[2] [2]
[1] [2]
F-2-122
4) Detach the blanking plate [1] (Do not use the detached blanking plate).
2-41
Chapter 2
- 2 screws [2]
[1]
[2]
F-2-123
5) Attach the voice board face plate [2] to the voice board [1].
- 2 screws (binding; M3X6) [3]
[3]
[1] [2]
F-2-124
6) Slide the slide switch SW1 on the voice board to 66MHz from 33MHz of the factory setting.
66MHz
F-2-125
The slide switch SW1 on the voice operation board is mounted to switch between in accordance with the transfer speed of PCI bus.
If the position of the switch does not match the transfer speed, the voice is not correctly played such as the interruption.
If you move the switch by mistake, be sure to return it to the correct position. In this machine, the switch should be positioned at 66MHz.
2-42
Chapter 2
33MHz
66MHz
F-2-126
7) Connect the voice board [1] into the connector [2] of the main controller PCB.
When inserting the voice board into the connector, be sure that the voice board is vertical against the connector.
[2]
[1]
F-2-127
8) Fix the voice board [1] in place with two screws [2] removed in the step 4).
[1]
[2]
F-2-128
9) Attach the cover in the opposite step from the one for detaching.
- controller box cover
- rear upper cover
10) Fix two cables removed in the step 1) in place with wire saddle.
11) Remove the screw [1] and the blanking seal [2] fixed to the right upper cover (Do not use the removed screw and blanking seal).
2-43
Chapter 2
F-2-129
12) Mount the speaker unit (lower) [1].
- 1 screw (binding; M4X16) [2]
- 1 screw (binding; M3X16) [3]
[1]
[3]
[2]
F-2-130
13) Mount the speaker unit (upper) [1] on the speaker unit (lower), fix them with a screw (binding; M4X6) [2] from beneath.
[1]
[2]
F-2-131
14) Detach the cover [1] on the cord guide.
[1]
F-2-132
15) Peel off two released papers on the cord guide [1], affix them to the position on the right side as in the chart.
2-44
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-133
16) Connect the cable [2] into the speaker unit [1].
[2]
[1]
F-2-134
17) Attach the ferrite core [1] to the cable. Be sure that the length [2] is 50 mm or shorter.
[1]
[2]
F-2-135
18) Connect the cable [1] to the terminal [2] of the voice board.
2-45
Chapter 2
[2]
[1]
F-2-136
19) Route the cable [1] through the cord guide [2], attach two cord guide covers [3] and fix them with three wire saddles [4].
[3] [5]
F-2-137
20) Connect the power cable to the power plug.
21) Turn ON the main power switch.
22) Check if the voice board is recognized.
Service mode
Select COPIER > DISPLAY > ACC-STS > PCI.
If "Voice Board" is displayed, that means that the voice board is correctly recognized.
3. Operation Check
<When Using the Voice Guidance>
1) Press the reset key for 3 sec or longer.
2) When the display of the number of copy is enclosed with red lines on the screen, "Voice Guidance" becomes enabled.
2-46
Chapter 2
F-2-138
[1] Speaker Unit (Upper) 1pc. [12] Screw (binding; M4X20) 1pc.
[2] Speaker Unit (Lower) 1pc. [13]* Screw (binding; M4X40) 1pc.
[3] Cable 1pc. [14] Hex Screw 2pc.
[4] Cable Guide 3pc. [15] Washer 2pc.
(Use 1pc in this machine) [16]* Wire Saddle 1pc.
[5] Voice Operation Board 1pc. [17] Voice Guidance Kit Users Guide 1pc.
[6]* Board Support Plate 1pc. [18] Voice Guidance Kit Users Guide CD 1pc.
[7] Board Support Plate 1pc. [19] Voice Operation Kit Users Guide 1pc.
[8] Ferrite Core 2pc. [20] Voice Operation Kit Users Guide CD 1pc.
[9] Screw (TP; M3X6) 2pc. [21] Voice Operation Quick Guide 1pc.
[10] Screw (binding; M4X6) 2pc. [22] FCC/IC Sheet 1pc.
[11] Screw (binding; M3X20) 1pc.
2-47
Chapter 2
When installing the machine, see the Combination Table for Accessory Installation.
1. Installation Procedure
1) Release five wire saddles [1] on the rear upper cover, make two cables [2] coming off upward.
[2]
[1]
F-2-139
2) Detach the rear upper cover [1].
- 3 screws [2] (to remove)
- 6 screws [3] (to loosen)
[2]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-140
3) Detach the controller box cover [1].
- 14 screws [2]
2-48
Chapter 2
[2]
[2] [2]
[1] [2]
F-2-141
4) Detach the blanking plate [1] (Do not use the detached blanking plate).
- 2 screws [2]
[1]
[2]
F-2-142
5) Attach the board support plate [2] to the voice operation board [1].
- 2 screws (TP; M3X6) [3]
- 2 washers [4]
- 2 hex screws [5]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[1]
[2]
[4]
[5]
F-2-143
2-49
Chapter 2
If the position of the switch does not match the transfer speed, the voice is not correctly played such as the interruption.
If you move the switch by mistake, be sure to return it to the correct position. In this machine, the switch should be positioned at 66MHz.
33MHz
66MHz
F-2-144
6) Connect the voice operation board [1] to the connector of the main controller PCB.
When inserting the board into the connector, be sure that the board is vertical against the connector.
[2]
[1]
F-2-145
7) Fix the voice operation board [1] with two screws [2] removed in the step 4).
[2]
[1]
F-2-146
8) Attach the cover in the opposite step from the one for detaching.
- controller box cover
- rear upper cover
9) Fix two cables removed in the step 1) with wire saddle.
2-50
Chapter 2
10) Remove the screw [2] and the blanking seal [3] fixed to the right upper cover [1] (Do not use the removed screw and blanking seal).
F-2-147
11) Mount the speaker unit (lower) [1].
- 1 screw (binding; M4X20) [2]
- 1 screw (binding; M3X20) [3]
[1]
[3] [2]
F-2-148
12) Mount the speaker unit (upper) [1] on the speaker unit (lower), fix them with two screws (binding; M4X6) [2] from beneath.
[1]
[2]
F-2-149
13) Detach the cover [1] of the cable guide.
[1]
F-2-150
14) Peel off the released paper of the cable guide [1], affix it to the position on the right side as in the chart.
2-51
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-151
15) Attach the ferrite core [1] to the cable. Be sure that the length [2] is 50 mm. Fix it on the opposite side in the same procedure.
[1]
[2]
F-2-152
16) Connect the cable [2] to the speaker unit [1].
[1] [2]
F-2-153
17) Connect another cable [1] to the terminal [2] of the voice operation board.
2-52
Chapter 2
[2] [1]
F-2-154
18) Route the cable [1] through the cable guide [2] and the wire saddle [3], attach the cable guide cover [4].
[2] [3]
[1] [2]
F-2-156
20) Connect the power cable to the power plug.
21) Turn ON the main power switch.
22) Check if the voice operation board is recognized.
Service mode.
Select COPIER > DISPLAY > ACC-STS > PCI.
If "Voice Operation" is displayed, that means that the voice operation board is correctly recognized.
3. Operation Check
<When Using the Voice Operation Kit>
1) Press the reset key or the voice recognition button [1] three seconds or longer.
2-53
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-157
2) When the display on the control panel is enclosed with red lines, "Voice Operation Kit" becomes enabled.
If 'Voice Operation Kit' does not work, check the following points.
- Is the slide switch on the voice operation board switched to 66MHz?
- TTS-JA/TTS-EN and ASR-JA/ASR-EN should be installed properly in the Service mode: COPIER > Display > VERSION.
2-54
Chapter 2
1) Open the 4 wire saddles [1] on the upper rear cover, and move the cable [2] upward.
[2]
[1]
F-2-158
2) Detach the upper rear cover [1].
- 4 screws [2] (remove)
- 3 screws [3] (loosen)
[2]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-159
3) Detach the lower rear cover [1].
- 6 screws [2]
[2]
[1]
[2]
F-2-160
2-55
Chapter 2
[4]
[3]
F-2-161
4) In case the power code of the heater for the cassette pedestal [1] is connected, remove the stopper [2]; then, unplug the power code [1].
- 2 screws [3]
[3]
[2]
[1]
F-2-162
5) Detach the protection cover [1].
- 1 screw [2]
[1] [2]
F-2-163
6) Free the harness [2] by picking the reuse band [1].
[1] [2]
F-2-164
7) Remove the wire saddle [2] that holds the harness [1].
2-56
Chapter 2
[1] [2]
F-2-165
8) Mount the optional power supply [1].
- 5 screws (TP; M3X6) [2]
[1]
[2] [2]
F-2-166
9) Connect 7 connectors [2] to the optional power supply [1].
[1] [2]
[2]
[2]
F-2-167
10) Attach the protection cover [1].
- Hook 2 claws [2]
- 1 screws (the screw removed in step 5)) [3]
[1] [3]
[2]
F-2-168
2-57
Chapter 2
[2]
[1] [2]
F-2-169
3) Free the harness [1] from the 3 wire saddles [2].
[1] [2]
F-2-170
4) Mount the finisher connector mount [1].
- 1 screw (RS tightening; M3X8) [2]
[1] [2]
F-2-171
5) Fix the finisher harness in place with the 2 wire saddle [1] and the edge saddle [2], and connect 2 connectors [3].
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-2-172
6) Cut out the blanking plate [1] of the lower left cover with the nippers.
2-58
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-173
7) Attach the covers using the steps to detach them but in reverse.
- Lower left cover
- Lower rear cover
8) Put back the cassettes.
9) Fix the cable in place with the wire saddle.
10) Plug the power cable (for outlet) into the outlet.
11) Turn ON the switch of the main power.
<DADF-L1>
[9]
[5] [8]
[3]
[1]
[4]
[6]
[7]
[7]
[2] [6]
[2]
[10]
F-2-174
2-59
Chapter 2
1) Detach the pressing plate of the main unit, attach the blanking seal [1] to the hinge hole.
[1]
F-2-175
2) Remove five screws [1] on the upper side of the unit (Do not use these screws).
[1]
F-2-176
3) Tighten two stepped screws (M5X6) [1] to the upper rear side of the unit.
[1]
F-2-177
4) Set the stepped screws [1] to DADF hinge from the back of the unit, slide it forward.
2-60
Chapter 2
F-2-178
5) Fix the hinges to DADF with stepped screws (M4X10) [1]. Use one screw for the left side and two for the right side. Tighten them so that DADF is aligned
against the left side of the unit when closing DADF.
F-2-179
F-2-180
6) Open the DADF feeder cover [1] and separation guide [2].
[1] [2]
F-2-181
7) Attach the stamp [1] using tools such as tweezers. Attach the stamp with the stamped surface upside.
Incomplete fixation of the stamp results in jam. Press the stamp until it clicks.
2-61
Chapter 2
[1]
F-2-182
8) Close the separation guide and the DADF feeder cover.
9) Connect DADF cable [1].
[1]
F-2-183
1) Wipe DADF reading glass with a cloth moistened with water (well-wrung).
F-2-184
2-62
Chapter 2
2.16.5 Adjustment
0014-1116
1. Height Adjustment
1-1. Making Pre-Checks
Check if the copyboard reference points of the pick-up side are attached to the copyboard glass both on the front and rear sides when closing DADF.
F-2-185
Loosen the fixing nut [2] before adjustment. Tighten it after adjustment.
* When the front side is fixed incompletely -> Rotate the adjustment screw clockwise, set the front side to the glass.
* When the rear side or both sides are fixed incompletely -> Rotate the adjustment screw counterclockwise, set the rear side to the glass.
[1]
[2]
F-2-186
[1]
A
[2]
F-2-187
2) If the height is not correct, adjust it with right hinge height adjustment screw [1].
Loosen the fixing nut [2] before adjustment. Tighten it after adjustment.
2-63
Chapter 2
F-2-188
* Rotate the adjustment screw clockwise -> Gap A becomes wider
* Rotate the adjustment screw counterclockwise -> Gap A becomes narrower
3) Perform the step 1) 'Left Hinge Height Adjustment'. If there is any displacement, perform adjustment again.
The result of this adjustment is stored in the reader controller PCB. When installing DADF in the field, this adjustment should be performed to input the adjustment
result in the reader unit. For DADF, this adjustment is not performed in installing in the field. If this adjustment is not performed, the following problem occurs.
- Wrong detection of the document size
For the tray width adjustment, perform 'AB system adjustment' or 'INCH system adjustment'.
4. Right-Angle Adjustment
Here, the original feed direction of the machine is adjusted in relation to the optical system of the iR machine.
1) Prepare a test chart as shown using A4 or LTR copy paper.
2-64
Chapter 2
10mm
10mm 10mm
Right angle
10mm
F-2-189
2) It can be used by copying or cutting.
3) Check the right angle of the image at the edge of the copied paper. Check the right angle by reading the difference between A and B dimensions at the edge of
the copy. If there is a difference between A and B, perform adjustment from the step 3).
Chart
feed
direction
F-2-190
4) Loosen three screws [1] for hinge fixation.
F-2-191
F-2-192
2-65
Chapter 2
Loosen the fixing nut [2] before adjustment. Tighten it after adjustment.
F-2-193
F-2-194
* For A>B -> Rotate clockwise.
* For A<B -> Rotate counterclockwise.
6) Tighten all of the hinge fixing screw loosened in the step 3).
MEMO:
DADF reproduction ratio adjustment is performed by comparing the stream reading copy image and pressing plate reading copy image (because the DADF is for
color machine). Comparison between stream reading copy image and original is performed at DADF for the previous monochrome machine, so perform adjustment
taking this difference into account. When reproduction ratio adjustment by comparing stream reading copy image and original is performed as in the case of mon-
ochrome DADF, the following problems may occur.
- ACS erroneous decision
- Black text enhancement erroneous decision
4) Select the screen from the service mode screen in the following order.
2-66
Chapter 2
1. FEEDER
2. ADJUST
3. LA-SPEED (highlighted)
MEMO:
This is the new adjustment to adjust the white level of the stream reading image to the white level of the pressing plate reading image (because DADF is for color).
If this adjustment is not performed, the following problems may occur.
- Incorrect under-color density of the stream reading image
- Wrong detection of solid in the stream reading mode
1) Set paper (for user normal use) on the copyboard glass, close DADF.
2) Select the screen from the service mode screen in the following order, to display the adjustment screen.
1. COPIER
2. FUNCTION
3. CCD
3) Press DF-WLVL1 key to highlight.
4) Press OK key.
Auto adjustment is performed. When it is correctly completed, 'OK!' is displayed on the screen.
5) Take the paper out of the copyboard glass, set it on DADF document tray.
6) Press DF-WLVL2 key on the touch panel to highlight .
7) Press OK key.
Auto adjustment (both-side stream reading) is performed.
If completed normally, 'OK!' is displayed on the screen.
8) Press the reset key twice to get out from the service mode.
9) Turn OFF the main power switch according to the shutdown sequence.
This label aims to make the size easier to adjust for user's viewability.
1) Set the side guide (rear) [1] to the indication of 'A4/A3' or 'LTR/11X17' [2].
2) Affix the size label [3] in appropriate language to the feeder cover.
Determine the label position in the cross direction (arrow [5] direction) and affix the label so that the indication [4] on the side guide (the front) matches the
indication of the size label considering user's viewability.
[1]
[2]
[3]
7
1x1
R/1
AT
/A3
A4
[4]
F-2-195
2-67
Chapter 2
[5]
F-2-196
2. Affixing the Copyboard Glass Cleaning Label
1) Push and affix the copyboard glass cleaning label [1] to the reader unit front cover [2].
[1]
[2]
[2]
F-2-197
3. Fixing the Hinge Cover
1) Fix the hinge covers to the left and right hinge assemblies with two each self-tapping screws (M3X8) [1]. Fit the sheet inside, the rubber plate outside, and fix it.
[1]
F-2-198
2-68
Chapter 2
F-2-199
T-2-5
1) Fit the inside delivery tray [1] into the delivery assembly slot [2]; then, hook it on the rear cover slot [3] to secure it in position.
[3]
[2]
[1]
F-2-200
2) Plug the power cable (for outlet) into the outlet.
3) Turn ON the switch of the main power.
4) Enter the Service mode.
5) Set the menu flag below at 1.
COPIER > OPTION > ACC > IN-TRAY.
When '1' is set to this mode item, tray B will be enabled under 'delivery tray setup' in user mode.
2-69
Chapter 2
2-70
Chapter 3 Basic Operation
Contents
Contents
3.1 Construction
The machine may broadly be divided into the following functional system blocks: general control system block, original exposure system block, reader control
system block, printer control system block, laser exposure system block, image formation system block, fixing system block. and pickup/feed system block, For
detailed discussions of individual functions, see the chapters that follow.
[B]
[A] R-CON
[F]
[1]
[9]
MN-CON
[2] [E]
[D] [3]
[8]
[6]
[5] [7]
DC-CON [4]
[C] [10]
DC-DRIVER
[F] [11]
[12]
F-3-1
[A] General Control System [B] Original Exposure System [C] Laser Exposure System
main controller PCB reader controller PCB
DC controller PCB
DC driver PCB
[D] Image Formation System [E] Fixing System [F] Pickup/Feed System
3-1
Chapter 3
J502
[25] J693
[10]
J691
J301
J351 J302
J681 J352
J692
[17]
[16]
J251E
J217E
J640 J647 J218E J252E
[19]
J203 [21]
J210E
J310E J302E J254E J2120
[18] [20]
[20]J303E J250E
J209E J206 J303E
J207
J1157 J12
J1156 [27]
[26] J1158 J13
[28]
F-3-2
MEMO:
The arrows in the diagram indicate PCB connections, not the direction of signals.
3-2
Chapter 3
The following shows the machine's power-on sequence in the form of a flow chart, during which the various machine loads are initialized according to the instruc-
tions programmed in the machine firmware (from when the power switch is turned on to when the machine enters a standby state):
Power-on
CPU initialization
ASIC initialization
Printer ID check
Fan drive
Machine inside
Drum cartridge detection residual paper/ Fault CHK
Drum life detection 1 door open check
1 Standby
Period Description
PSTBY (print standby) when the machine is ready to accept a copy/print request signal.
PINTR (initial rotation) from when a print request signal is received to when an image signal is generated.
PRINT from when all toner has been transferred to paper and the paper is delivered.
LSTR (last rotation) from when the paper has been delivered to when all drive has been stopped.
3-3
Chapter 3
Start key
ON
PSTBY PINTR PRINT LSTR PSTBY
Porigon Motor [1]
(M13)
Image reguest
signal (PVREQ)
Laser activation
Y
M
C
Bk
Drum/ITB motor [1]
(M1)
Primary
charging bias
Developing bias
Y
M
C [2]
Bk
Primary
transfer bias Y
M
C
Bk
Secondary [3] [4]
transfer bias
Cassette 1 pickup [6]
motor (M4)
Cassette 1 pickup [5]
solenoid (SL2)
Registration
clutch (CL6)
Fixing heater [8] [7] [8]
(H1)
Fixing motor [9]
(M3)
F-3-4
[1] stabilizes the rotation.
[2] holds toner/carrier on the developing cylinder.
[3] transfers to paper.
[4] cleans the secondary transfer outside roller.
[5] picks up paper from the cassette.
[6] executes registration.
[7] controls 165 to 240 degrees Celcius.
[8] controls 140 to 195 degrees Celcius.
[9] executes half-speed rotation (to increase temperature of the pressure roller).
Period Description
PSTBY (print standby) whine the machine is ready to accept a copy/print request signal.
PINTR (initial rotation) from when a print request signal has been received to when an image signal is
generated.
PRINT from when all toner has been transferred to paper to when the paper is delivered.
LSTR (last rotation) from when the paper has been delivered to when all drive is stopped.
Start key
ON
PSTBY PINTR PRINT LSTR PSTBY
Porigon Motor [1]
(M13)
Image reguest
signal (PVREQ)
Laser activation
3-4
Chapter 3
3-5
Chapter 4 Main Controller
Contents
Contents
4.1 Construction
The machine's main controller block consists of the following components and provides the functions indicated:
T-4-1
Item Description
[1] Main controller PCB (main) controls the system, controls the memory, controls image processing for output to the printer
[2] Main controller PCB (sub R-A) color space conversion, rotation for electronic sorting, binary processing, resolution conversion
[3] Main controller PCB (sub PDRM-EF-A) image processing for printer output (color space compression, background removal, LOG conversion,
direct mapping, color balance, zoom fine adjustment, gradation conversion, screen processing,
framing, add-on)
[4] Main controller PCB (sub SJ-A) scanner interface, scanner image processing (resolution conversion, image rotation, compression/
expansion)
[5] Main controller PCB (sub LAN-bar-A) LAN connection, HDD controller, HDD power supply
[6] Boot ROM stores programs used for booting
[7] SRAM PCB retains service mode settings and HDD control information
[8] DDR-SDRAM retains program data and image data temporarily
[9] Main controller PCB (sub RB-A) (to be translating)
HDD HDD stores system software, retains image data for Box/fax functions
[A] Reader unit
[B] DC controller PCB
[C] Printer unit
[A]
[1]
[2]
[3]
[3]
[4]
[B]
[5]
[6]
HDD
[C]
[9] [8] [7]
F-4-1
4-1
Chapter 4
The following shows the major control functions of the main controller PCB (main) grouped according to jack/IC:
J1010
J1051
J1008
J1011
J1052
J1012
J1013
J1034
J1024
J1003
J1001
J1002
F-4-2
T-4-2
Jack No Discription
J1001 image memory (DDR-SDRAM, 1 GB; standard)
J1002 image memory (DDR-SDRAM, 512 MB) *1
J1003 SRAM PCB connection slot
J1008 main controller PCB (sub PDRM-EF-A) connection slot
J1010 main controller PCB (sub R-A) connection slot
J1011 main controller PCB (sub SJ-A) connection slot
J1012 optional board connection slot (security expansion board)
J1013 main controller PCB (sub LAN-BAR-A) connection slot
J1024 main controller PCB (sub RB-A) connection slot *1
J1034 boot ROM connection slot
J1051 main controller PCB (sub PDRM-EF-A) connection slot
J1052 optional board connection slot (voice guidance board)
The following is a discussion of the major control functions of the SRAM indicated with reference to ICs:
T-4-3
IC No. Description
IC1,2(SRAM) retains control information on the image data stored on the HDD; retains service mode settings data and Additional Function settings data
4-2
Chapter 4
4.3.1 Overview
0013-9211
The system software used to control the operation of the machine is stored on the HDD.
When the machine is started up, the CPU on the main controller PCB reads the system software from the HDD into the image memory (DDR-SDRAM) of the main
controller PCB for use as instructed by the boot program of the boot ROM.
The following screen remains on the control panel white the CPU is reading the system memory from the HDD into the image memory (DDR-SDRAM), with the
bar indicating the progress of the startup sequence.
Progress bar
F-4-3
Never turn off the main power while the progress bar is indicated. The CPU is accessing the HDD, and turning off the power can cause a fault (E602) on the HDD.
The engine becomes ready to accept a job when the start-up sequence ends normally. (Its control panel displays the control screen, and the Start key LED changes
from red to green.)
Progress bar
1 2 3
F-4-4
4-3
Chapter 4
System
CPU software
HDD
ROM
CPU
HDD
ROM
4-4
Chapter 4
E602-XXYY
- if XX='00'
T-4-4
XX YY
YY=10,1
YY=00,0 YY=11,2 YY=13,2 2,14,22,2
YY=03 YY=05 1,02,04 1 5 3,24
4-5
Chapter 4
- if XX='01 to FF'
XX YY
YY=10, HDD formatting
YY=00, YY=11, YY=13, 12,14,22
YY=03 YY=05 01,02,04 21 25 ,23,24
At time of start-up During normal operation
CHK- Partition in
XX Description HDD HDD
TYPE question
HDD formatting formatting
Items formatting by normal by safe
deleted by HD- mode + mode +
Remedy Remedy Remedy Remedy Remedy Remedy (typical) CLEAR SST SST
image data storage
01 FSTDEV area (e.g., Box) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 FSTDEV
possible (3
selected (3
image management partitions
1 partitions
02 IMG_MNG data *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 all stored simultane simultane
image data storage data (e.g., ous)
ous)
03 FSTCDEV area (for Chasing) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 Box)
general-purpose data
04 APL_GEN storage area *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 General APL_GE
general-purpose data possible (4 N selected
storage area partitions (4
2
05 TMP_GEN (temporary file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 General simultane partitions
ous) simultane
06 TMP_FAX fax (temporary file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 FAX ous)
07 TMP_PSS PSS (temporary file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 PSS
PDL-related file
storage area (font,
registration form,
PDLDEV
3 PDLDEV ICCProfile, PDL possible
selected
function color
correction UserFont
08 information file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 Icc Profile
Firmware storage
area (Booktable,
MEAP, Key,
certificate, PDF Not Not
4 BOOTDEV
dictionary, RUI possible possible
content, voice
dictionary (ICC
09 profile, PS test data)) *3 *8 *9 *10 *11 *12 System
10 5 APL_MEAP MEAP *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 MEAP possible possible
Not Not
6
11 APL_SEND address book, filter *2 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 SEND possible possible
HDD full sector fault
0
FF Not identified check and repair *4 *7 *9 *10 *11 *12 - - - -
4-6
Chapter 4
Other iR machine
Original
A
Copy Scan
• SEND
• FAX
A A • PullScan
• E-Mail
• BOX
Image data • PDL Print
Print output
PC
F-4-7
The image data (RGB data) collected by the CCD is processed by the main controller PCB (sub SJ-A, sub R-A, sub PDRM-PE-A).
4-7
Chapter 4
Reader unit
RGB 24
- Edge enhancement
If mono-color mode, - Smoothing
only Bk signals hereafter.
- Framing
- Blanking
- Frame erasing
CMYK
F-4-8
4-8
Chapter 4
The main controller processes the image data arriving from the reader unit for output to the printer unit.
Reader unit
RGB 24
Main controller PCB
(main + sub (R-A)/
(sub PDRM-PE-A)
Here, the Bk signal is generated
if an ACS session identifies the
original as being black-and-white. RGB 24 Image area
(Otherwise, it is let through.) signal
- Background removal
- Bk generation
In color mode, the Bk signal
is generated here.
RGB->CMY conversion
Smoothing
- Framing
- Blanking
F-4-9
4-9
Chapter 4
The main controller PCB processes data for compression, decompression, and editing.
Reader unit
RGB 24
4 Image area signal
Rotation
PDL input
IC1
Color conversion
JPEG
PC Binary processing
compression
JPEG decompression
DDR-SDRAM
HDD
F-4-10
The following shows the flow of image data when a copier function is being used:
Reader unit
DDR-SDRAM
HDD
F-4-11
4-10
Chapter 4
The following shows the flow of image data when a Box function is being used:
Reader unit
JPEG Rotation
compression
DDR-SDRAM
HDD
F-4-12
Reader unit
MMR compression
HDD
DDR-SDRAM
F-4-13
4-11
Chapter 4
The following shows the flow of image data when a fax transmission function is being used:
Reader unit
HDD
SDRAM
Fax unit
F-4-14
The following shows the flow of image data when a fax reception function is being used:
DC controller PCB
Resolution conversion
Rotation
HDD
SDRAM
Fax unit
F-4-15
4-12
Chapter 4
The following shows the flow of image data when a PDL function is being used:
Direct Print
Expansion Kit
JPEGTIFF/PDF
LIPS data
RGB
LIPS V/PS Expansion Kit-Q1
RGB
PS Print Server
PS data Unit
PS
CMYK
Main controller PCB Main controller PCB
(sub RO-A) (sub LANBAR-C)
JPEG compression
JPEG decompression
DDR-SDRAM
HDD
F-4-16
4-13
Chapter 4
PCB]
4) Remove the DC controller PCB. (page 10-22)[Detaching the DC
4.7 Parts Replacement Procedure Controller PCB]
5) Remove the main controller box. (page 4-14)[Removing the Controller
4.7.1 Controller Box Box]
6) Remove the main controller sub-board (sub-R-A board). (page 4-
15)[Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub-R-A)]
4.7.1.1 Before Removing the Main Controller Box
0013-6790
7) Remove the main controller sub-board (sub-PDRM-EF-A board). (page
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 4-15)[Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub-PDRAM-A)]
8) Remove the main controller sub-board (sub-SJ-A board). (page 4-
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper 15)[Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub SJ-A)]
Cover] 9) Remove the main controller sub-board (LANBAR-C board). (page 4-
2) Detach the left cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Cover] 16)[Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C)]
3) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover] 10) Remove the main controller sub-board(RB-A2 board). (page 4-
4) Remove the DC driver PCB. (page 10-25)[Removing the DC Driver 16)[Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub RB-A2)]
PCB] 11) Remove the SDRAM. (page 4-18)[Removing the Image Memory
5) Remove the DC controller PCB. (page 10-22)[Detaching the DC (SDRAM) PCB]
Controller PCB] 12) Remove the HDD. (page 4-18)[Removing the HDD]
4.7.1.2 Removing the Controller Box 13) Remove the BOOT ROM. (page 4-17)[Removing the Boot ROM
0013-6791
PCB]
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
4.7.2.2 Removing the Main Controller PCB
1) Detach the main controller cover [1]. 0013-6771
[1]
[1]
[1]
After mounting the main controller PCB (main), mount each PCB that is re-
moved before the replacement.
[1] Main Controller PCB (Sub R-A)
[2] Main Controller PCB (Sub PDEM-EF-A)
[3] [3] Main Controller PCB (Sub SJ-A)
[3] [4] Main Controller PCB (Sub LANBAR-C)
[5] Storage of program for BOOT ROM BOOT
[6] SRAM PCB
[7] DDR-SDRAM
[8] Main Controller PCB (Sub RB-A)
[9] HDD
[1]
F-4-18
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
3) Remove the DC driver PCB. (page 10-25)[Removing the DC Driver
4-14
Chapter 4
[2]
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper [1] [2]
Cover]
F-4-23
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
2) Remove the main controller PCB (sub-PDRAM-A)
4.7.3.2 Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub-R-A) - 2 screws [2]
0013-6777
[2]
[2] [2]
F-4-24
MEMO:
There are 2 main controller PCBs (sub-PDRM-A).
The procedure to remove them are the same.
[1] [2]
F-4-21 4.7.5 Main Controller PCB (sub SJ-A)
2) Remove the main controller PCB (sub-R-A)
- 2 screw [2] 4.7.5.1 Before Removing the Main Controller PCB (sub
SJ-A)
[1] 0013-6780
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
[2]
F-4-22
4-15
Chapter 4
[2]
[2] [2]
[1] [2]
[2] [2] [1] [3]
F-4-25
F-4-28
2) Remove the main controller PCB (sub SJ-A)
- 2 screws [2] 4.7.7 Main Controller PCB (sub RB-A)
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
[1] [2]
F-4-26
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
[2] In the case the main controller PCB (sub RB-A2) is not attached, this proce-
dure is not required.
- 2 screws [1]
- 1 mount [2]
- 1 connector [3]
[1] [2]
F-4-27 [1]
2) Remove the main controller PCB (sub LANBAR-C)
- 2 connectors [2]
- 2 screws [3] [2]
F-4-30
4-16
Chapter 4
Before starting the work, be sure to inform the user that all image data stored
in the Box will be lost and obtain his/her consent.
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper 4.7.9.2 Removing the Boot ROM PCB
Cover] 0014-2528
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover] / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
3) Remove the HDD. (page 4-18)[Removing the HDD] 1) Remove the 2 HDD mounts [2]
- 2 screws [1] each
4.7.8.2 Removing the SRAM
0014-2514
[2]
F-4-35
[1]
4.7.10 Image Memory (SDRAM)
F-4-33
4.7.10.1 Before Removing the Image Memory (SDRAM)
4.7.8.3 When Replacing the SRAM PCB
0014-3122
PCB
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 0014-2532
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
When the SRAM PCB is replaced, all data in its memory will be lost (file- 2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
4-17
Chapter 4
[1] [2]
F-4-39
2) Remove the HDD unit [1].
-2 connectors [2]
-6 screws [3]
- 1 cable clamp [4]
[1] [2] [1]
[3] [2] [4]
F-4-36
2) Open the fixing member in the direction shown by the arrow, and then
remove the image memory (SDRAM) PCB [1].
[1]
In case the 2 image memories (SDRAM) are attached, remove both of them.
[3]
F-4-40
4-18
Chapter 4
4) When the card data has been downloaded from NSA, check that the ID
data has correctly been downloaded on the screen brought up by making
the following selections:
user mode>system control settings>group ID control
(Only the downloaded ID data must be indicated.)
5) Make copies using a user card registered with NSA, and check that
statistical operations are made for the device in question.
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the left rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Rear Cover]
[3] [2]
[3] [1]
F-4-41
4-19
Chapter 5 Original Exposure System
Contents
Contents
5.1 Construction
The following are the major specifications, control mechanisms, and functions associated with the original exposure system:
T-5-1
Item Description
Source of light Xenon lamp (white)
Scan in book mode: scan by a moving contact image sensor (CIS)
in ADF mode: scan by a stationary contact image sensor (CIS; stream reading)
Reading resolution 600 dpi (main scanning direction) x 600 dpi (sub scanning direction)
Number of gradations 256
Productivity (w/ ADF in use) 28 ipm (single-sided, A4/LTR)
Carriage position detection by contact image sensor (CIS) HP sensor (PS501)
Magnification 25% to 400%
in main scanning direction: image processing by the main control PCB (main)
in sub scanning direction: image processing by the main controller PCB (main)
Lens rod lens array
CCD number of lines: 3 (RGB)
Number of pixels: 7488
maximum reading width: 310 mm
CIS drive control by reader motor (M501)
Scanning lamp activation control [1] by inverter circuit
[2] error detection
Original size identification [1] Book Mode
main scanning direction: by contact image sensor (CIS)
sub scanning mode: by reflection sensor (AB/Inch)
[2] ADF mode
main scanning direction: by slide guide in ADF
sub scanning direction: by photo sensor in ADF
5.1.2 Major Components
0013-8566
Original sensor 2
Reamer motor (M501)
Original sensor 1
Copyboard cover
Open/closed sensor
(front: PS502)
Reader heater*1
Inverter PCB
CIS HP sensor
(PS501)
Contact image
sensor (CIS)
5-1
Chapter 5
To printer /5 03
To ADF
04
J5
J5
20
11
05 J5
01
J5
J5
10
12
00
J5
J5
J5
J5
06
J5
01
8
J5
01
5
Copyboard cover
open/closed sensor
(rear: PS503) Inverter PCB
Copyboard cover
open/closed sensor
(front: PS502) CIS HP
CIS
sensor (PS501)
CIS control
Image signal
F-5-2
5-2
Chapter 5
The following shows the functional construction of the reader controller PCB:
DC24V
DC15V
DC5V
DC3.3V
J504
J505
IC505 J503
IC501
IC513
IC514 IC515
IC517
J506
IC521
IC519
J510
CPU
IC520 IC522
J511
J508 J512
F-5-3
T-5-3
Jack Description
J500 used to supply power to the ADF.
J501 used for power from the machine (printer unit).
J502 used for communication with the machine (printer unit).
J503 used for communication with the ADF.
J504 used for communication with the ADF.
J505 used for connection to the main motor.
J506 used for connection with the original cover open/closed sensor, CIS HP sensor.
J510 used for connection with the contact image sensor (CIS).
J511 used for connection with the original size sensor (AB/Inch).
J512 used for connection with the inverter PCB.
T-5-4
IC Description
IC501 reader motor driver
IC505 image data parallel/serial conversion
IC513 EEPROM (backup of service mode settings)
IC514 EEPROM (backup of service mode settings)
IC515 image processing (shading correction)
IC517 A/D converter
IC519 CPU (boot program storage)
IC520 system software storage (flash ROM)
IC521 A/D converter
IC522 A/D converter
5-3
Chapter 5
SREADY STBY
Reader motor
(M501)
Scanning lamp
(LA1)
CIS HP sensor
(PS501)
Shading Shading shading
position *1 position CIS output offset correction
position *1
F-5-4
CIS HP
sensor
*1
2. shading adjustment
5.2.2 Basic Sequence of Operations in Response to a Press on the Start Key (book mode, 1 original)
0013-8576
Shading correction
Start key
ON
Shading
position
: forward
: reverse
*1: if the copyboard cover/ADF is 'open', corresponds to the point of original size detection
F-5-6
5-4
Chapter 5
CIS HP
sensor
*2 *1
1. Check CIS position *2
3. Scan original
*1
4. Mode to standby position
5.2.3 Basic Sequence of Operations in Response to a Press on the Start Key (ADF mode, 1 original)
0013-8577
Shading correction
Start key
ON
: forward
: reverse
F-5-8
CIS HP
sensor
*1
1. Check CIS position
*1
2. Scan original
5-5
Chapter 5
5.3.1.1 Overview
0013-8578
The following components are associated with the scanner drive system:
Reader motor
Copyboard cover
open/closed sensor
(PS503)
Sensor
light-blocking
plate
(reverse)
[3]
[2] (reverse)
copyboard cover
open/closed sensor Carriage
(PS502)
Contact image
sensor (CIS
CIS HP sensor
Guide shaft
F-5-10
[1] Reader Motor (M501) Drive Signal
used to turn on/off the motor and change its direction/speed of rotation.
[2] Contact Image Sensor (CIS) Home Position sennsaor (PS501) Detection Signal
used to indicate that the contact image sensor (CIS) is in home position,
[3] Copyboard Cover Sensor (front, PS502; rear, PS503) Detection Sugnal
used to indicate the state (open/closed) of the copyboard cover.
The reader motor driver turns on/off the reader motor and controls its direction/speed of rotation.
OPT_MCK
J505
CCW B*
1
MD_POW B
CPU Motor 2
M_ENABLE
driver A M501
3
RETURN A*
4
M_VREF
F-5-11
MEMO:
The machine uses any of the following scan speeds according to selected mode:
T-5-5
5-6
Chapter 5
Original
Start position Original leading edge trailing edge Stop
Travel
speed
Travel distance
[1] acceleration area: accelerates to a speed suited to the selected mode.
[2] margin area: drives to ensure a specific speed.
[3] image read area: scans an image at a specific speed.
[4] deceleration area: after the trailing edge of the image, decelerates and stops.
F-5-12
5-7
Chapter 5
5.3.2.1 Overview
0013-8580
The machine uses a contact image sensor (CIS) to read images, line-by line.
T-5-6
Item Description
Scanning lamp used to illuminate originals.
Rod lens array used to collect light reflected by originals.
CCD array used to collect reflected light coming through a rod lens array.
Copyboard glass
Scanning lamps
(scan direction)
Scanning lamps
CCD array
CCD
F-5-13
5-8
Chapter 5
The contact image sensor (CIS) read images in keeping with the following flow of analog image processing:
Actual output
characteristics
1
1
1
Input
8
8
9
8
9
10
9
10
11
10
11
12
11
t
ui
12
rc
ci
13
er
12
riv
13
els
14
pix
13
14
8
15
46
14
15
16
15
16
16
F-5-14
If any of the following occurs, be sure to execute the following service mode item to correct the output among the channels:
- there is a difference in the output of the image density among channels after replacement of the contact image sensor (CIS).
- the CCD-LUT setting is not 0 after replacement of the reader controller PCB.
Service Mode:
- setting CIS unit gain correction data
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CCD-LUT
- CCD Gain Fine Correction
COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>LUT-ADJ2
(making adjustments using a D-10 chart)
5.3.3 Enlargement/Reduction
5-9
Chapter 5
The machine's scanning lamp is a xenon lamp, in which xenon gas is sealed inside a tube. Along the glass tube are 2 electrodes, while the inside the glass tube is
coated with phosphorous material. When a high-frequency voltage is applied to the electrodes, electrons occur within the gas, thus causing the phosphorous material
to emit light.
Electrode Electrode
Fluorescent Opening
medium
Glass tube
Electrode Electrode
F-5-15
5.3.4.2 Overview
0013-8586
The scanning lamp is controlled for the following, and is composed of the items indicated:
- activation/de-activation
- error detection
CIS
Xenon tube Inverter PCB Reader controller PCB
J5018
J5015 J512
1 GND
3 1
1 2 Activation LANP_ON
2 3 control circuit
2 2 CPU
1 14.5V 3
3 4
F-5-16
5.3.5.1 Overview
0013-8589
The machine identifies the size of an original based on the measurements it takes of the light reflected by the original at specific points of the CCD (inside the CIS)
and the output of the reflection sensor.
- main scanning direction: CCD (4 points for AB; 3 points for Inch)
- sub scanning direction: reflection photosensor (1 point for AB; 1 point for Inch)
1) External Light Search (main scanning direction only)
While keeping the scanning lamp on, the machine measures the level of light at specific points of the CCD for main scanning direction.
2) Detecting the Sensor Output Level
The machine turns on the scanning lamp, and measures the CCD levels at individual points of detection in main scanning direction.
The machine also turns on the reflection photosensor and measures its output for sub scanning direction.
The machine identifies the size of the original based on the resulting combination of the measurement and the output.
5-10
Chapter 5
The length in main scanning direction is measured by checking the intensify of light at specific points while moving the contact image sensor (CIS) to a point 30
mm from the leading edge of the original. The length in sub scanning direction, on the other hand, is measured by means of the sensors mounted to the following
locations:
AB-Configuration
Sub scanning direction
Point of original
detection 1 B5R
Point of original
detection 2 A5 A4R
Point of original
detection 3 B5 B4
Point of original
detection 4 A4 A3
30mm
Inch-Configuration
Sub scanning direction
Original sensor 2
Main scanning direction
Point of original
detection 1 STMT-R
Point of original
detection 2 LTR-R LGL
Point of original
detection 3 LTR 11" 17"
30mm
F-5-17
Book Mode
1 original (A4R), copyboard cover (or ADF) closed
1) Standby
CIS: in home position
xenon lamp: off
original sensor: off
CIS
Original sensor
point of detection 1
Copyboard cover point of detection 2
point of detection 3
Reader unit point of detection 4
Copyboard glass
CIS HP
F-5-18
2) Copyboard Cover Opened
5-11
Chapter 5
Original sensor
1
(External light) 2
3
4
Original sensor
Original(A4R)
25 1
2
(External light)
3
4
Original sensor
Original(A4R)
1
25 2
3
4
Original sensor
Original(A4R)
1
2
15
3
4
Original sensor
Original(A4R)
1
2
3
4
5-12
Chapter 5
Copyboard glass
CIS HP
F-5-24
AB-Configuration Inch-Configuration
A3 11"X17"
A4 LTR
B4 LGL
B5 LTR-R
A4R STMT-R
A5 No original
B5R
5.3.6.1 Overview
0013-8592
Main power
switch Start key
ON ON
WMUPR STBY
1st 2nd
SCAN SCAN
Dust detection control Dust detection control
Dust detection control
F-5-26
2. Particulars of Control
(1) At the End of a Job (dust detection)
The contact image sensor (CIS) checks the light reflected by the platen roller of the ADF at a point of reading to find out the presence/absence of dust. If the
presence of dust is detected, the contact image sensor moves to the next candidate point (2 times max.; A -> B -> C; B -> C -> A; or C -> A -> B).
The point identified will be used as the point of reading for the next job.
- For the control at the end of a job, the sensor will never move to point D.
- For the control at the end of a job, a message prompting cleaning of the glass surface will be indicated if an original is placed in the ADF while the presence of
dust has been detected at all points (A, B, C). The Start key is disabled until the message is cleared.
5-13
Chapter 5
D A B C
At end of job
Pattern 1
Pattern 2
Pattern 3
At start of job
F-5-27
(3) Between Sheets
The contact image sensor (CIS) is not moved for detection of dust.
The machine undertakes reading at a point determined by control executed at the end of a job or at the start of a job; if the presence of dust is identified, the
machine executes image correction.
T-5-7
Platen roller
0.5mm 0.5mm
D A B C
Stream
reading Lens
glass
Contact image sensor (CIS)
Scanning lamp
F-5-28
5-14
Chapter 5
Service Mode:
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DST-POS (level 1)
- use it to set an original reading position when the ADF is in use.
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DFDST-L1 (level 1)
- use it to adjust the dust reading detection level for between sheets.
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DFDST-L2 (level 1)
- use it to adjust the dust reading detection level for the end of a job.
5.3.7.1 Overview
0013-8593
The image processing system has the following major specifications and functions:
Contact image
sensor (CIS) Reader controller PCB
CCD
Analog image A/D Shading processing Controller block
processing conversion
F-5-29
The PCB used by the image processing system has the following functions:
- Reader Controller PCB drives the CCD, performs analog image processing, performs A/D conversion, performs shading
correction
The machine processes images using its reader controller PCB line by line, and the processing consists in the following;
(1) Analog Image Processing
(a) drives the CCD
(b) performs gain correction and offset correction for the CCD output
(c) performs A/D conversion for the CCD output
(2) Digital image Processing
(a) performs shading correction
Even-numbered Odd-numbered
pixel pixel
SCD control
signal
CCD drive control
Analog
image signal
Line correction EEP-ROM
Even- data Target
CPU
numbered value
Analog pixel SRAM
image processing
A/D
- gain correction conversion J203
- offset correction Digital Digital
Odd-
numbered image signal Shading image signal
pixel 10 correction 8
CCD/AP circuit
F-5-30
The machine's CCD sensor is a linear image sensor that consists of 3 lines (RGB, 1 line each), and it is composed of 7488-pixel photocells. The signals generated
through photo conversion at the light-receiving segment are sent as analog signals according to pixels in the order of G, B, and R.
5-15
Chapter 5
R R R R R R R R R R R R
G G G G G G G G G G G G
B B B B B B B B B B B B
Single analog
shift register
output
G B R G B R G B R G B ......
F-5-31
5.3.7.3 Gain Correction and Offset Correction for the CCD Output
0013-8595
The analog video signal from the CCD is subjected to gain correction (in which the rate of amplification is corrected to a specific level) and offset correction (in
which the output voltage in the absence of incident light is also corrected to a specific level).
The analog signal after correction is then converted into 8-bit digital signals that comply with the individual levels of pixel voltage by the A/D converter.
An original of even density does not necessarily mean uniform CCD output because of the following factors:
(1) variation in the sensitivity of each pixel of the CCD
(2) uneven intensity across the rod lens array
(3) difference in intensity of light between the center and ends of the scanning lamp
(4) deterioration of the scanning lamp
The machine performs shading correction to correct any discrepancy in the output of the CCD. It performs shading correction at power-on and or for each job.
The machine measures the density of the standard while plate, and uses the result as density data. The data is then subjected to computation to obtain the target
value for use during shading correction.
The machine executes shading correction for each scan of the original. It measures the density of the standard white plate, and compares the measurement against
the target value stored in the shading correction circuit; the machine then sets up the difference as the shading correction value, and uses it to correct any variation
among CCD pixel when scanning the originals, thus evening out the image density levels.
White
Original density
Standard while plate
F-5-32
5-16
Chapter 5
5.4 Parts Replacement Procedure 5.4.1.2 After Replacing the Copyboard Glass
0014-3112
F-5-33
When removing the copyboard glass, take care not to touch the following: 820686679349
- glass surface
- standard white plate
The presence of dirt can cause white/black lines in the images. If dirt is
found, clean it with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol. W-PLT-X W-PLT-Z
W-PLT-Y
F-5-35
B. Enter the value indicated by the bar code found at the upper left of the
copyboard glass (copyboard sheet) using the following service mode
item:
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>BOOK-RG
(offset value against color displacement caused by copyboard glass)
-04
BOOK-RG
F-5-36
F-5-34
5-17
Chapter 5
F-5-39
2) Disconnect the connector [1], and detach the flexible cable [2].
F-5-37
When removing the ADF reading glass, take care not to touch the glass
surface.
The presence of dirt can cause white/black lines in the images. If dirt is
found, be sure to clean it using lint-free paper moistened with alcohol.
Enter the value indicated by the bar code found on the ADF reading glass
using the following service mode item:
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>DF-RG
(offset value against color displacement caused by stream reading glass)
F-5-40
3) Remove the cover [3].
-8 screws [2]
002
DF-RG
F-5-38
5-18
Chapter 5
F-5-43
6) Disconnect the 3 connectors [1].
F-5-47
10) Remove the reader controller PCB [2].
-9 screws [1]
F-5-44
7) Remove the cover [2].
-6 screws [2]
F-5-48
F-5-45
5.4.2.4 After Replacing the Reader Controller PCB
8) Disconnect the 2 connectors [1], and free the cable from the wire saddle 0014-3116
- Before replacing the reader controller PCB, be sure to generate the latest P-
PRINT printout.
- If you carry out the power ON and the copier returns to the standby
condition after the controller circuit PCB replacement, turn ON/OFF the
power supply once again.
<if you are initializing the RAM of the reader controller without replacing
the PCB>
- Using the SST, upload the reader controller backup data; after initializing
the RAM, download the data, thus eliminating the need for the following
adjustment.
5-19
Chapter 5
b. offset value against color displacement for copyboard glass (copyboard COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-WLVL2
cover)
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>BOOK-RG When you have finished the foregoing adjustments, put the P-PRINT print-
c. offset value against color displacement for copyboard glass (ADF) out [1] you have previously generated in the service book cassette to replace
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>DF-RG the old P-PRINT printout.
DF-RG BOOK-RG
F-5-50
2. ADF-Related Adjustment
The machine keeps ADF-related service mode data in the RAM of the
reader controller; as such, you will have to make the appropriate F-5-51
adjustments if you have replaced the reader controller or initialized the 2) While freeing the 3 hooks [1], detach the inverter PCB [2].
RAM.
1) Enter the values indicated in the P-PRINT printout you have previously
generated for the following:
a. main scanning direction position adjustment (stream reading)
COPIER>ADJSUT>ADJ-XY>ADJ-Y-DF
b. original stop position adjustment
FEEDER>ADJSUT>DOCST
c. original feed speed (magnification) adjustment
FEEDER>ADUST>LA-SPEED
5-20
Chapter 5
1) Detach the reader rear cover. (page 10-16)[Detaching the Reader Rear
Cover]
1) Remove the 2 screws [1]; then, disconnect the connector [2], and detach
the 2 wire saddles [3].
F-5-55
2) Detach the plate [2].
-2 screws [1]
F-5-53
2) Remove the spring [1], and detach the scanner motor [2].
F-5-56
3) Remove the contact image sensor (CIS).
-connector [1]
-flexible cable retainer [2]
-flexible cable [3]
F-5-54
1) Detach the reader front cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Reader Front
Cover]
2) Detach the reader rear cover. (page 10-16)[Detaching the Reader Rear
Cover] F-5-57
3) Detach the copyboard glass. (page 5-17)[Removing the Copyboard
Glass]
5.4.5.2 Removing the Contact Image Sensor (CIS) When detaching the contact sensor unit, take care not to touch the scanning
0014-1381
lamp and the lens assembly.
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
1) Pull the drive belt (front) [1] in the direction of the arrow so that the
contact image sensor (CIS) [2] will move where it is shown in the figure.
5-21
Chapter 5
-012 72 70
CCDU-RG MTF-SG
MTF-MG
F-5-60
Also, be sure to update the values indicated on the service label attached be-
hind the reader left cover by the values indicated on the CIS label.
Reference:
The machine is not shipped out of the factory with the CIS label attached to
it.
1) Detach the reader rear cover. (page 10-16)[Detaching the Reader Rear
Cover]
F-5-59
Be sure to enter the values indicated on the CIS label attached to the contact
image sensor (CIS) using the following service mode items:
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>CCDU-RG
(offset value against color displacement caused by CIS)
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>MTF-MG
(MTF correction value for main scanning direction)
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>MTF-SG
(MTF correction value for sub scanning direction)
F-5-61
2) Detach the 2 sensors [1] from the sensor base.
5-22
Chapter 5
After replacing the sensor, pull the drive belt (rear) [1] in the direction of the
arrow so that the contact image sensor (CIS) [2] is returned to the
F-5-62
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 2) Detach the reader rear cover. (page 10-16)[Detaching the Reader Rear
Cover]
1) Pull the drive belt [1] in the direction of the arrow so that the contact image
sensor (CIS) [2] is where indicated in the figure. 5.4.8.2 Removing the Original Size Sensor (AB/Inch-
configuration)
0014-1393
F-5-63
2) Remove the CIS home position sensor [3].
-connector [1]
F-5-66
2) Disconnect the connector [1], and detach the flexible cable [2].
When detaching the sensor, do so as if to push it under the claw [2] found at
the rear.
F-5-67
3) Detach the cover [2].
-8 screws [2]
F-5-64
5-23
Chapter 5
F-5-68
4) Remove the original sensor [2].
- hook [1]
F-5-69
5-24
Chapter 6 Laser Exposure
Contents
Contents
6.1 Construction
T-6-1
Laser Light
Wave length 780 to 800nm (infrared rays)
Output 5mW
Number of Laser Light 4-laser (1-beam/color)
T-6-2
Scanner Motor
Motor type DC brushless motor
Number of rotation iR C3380/2880: approx. 34000rpm
Bearing type Oil
T-6-3
Polygon Mirro
Number of facets 6-facet
T-6-4
List of Controls
Timing for laser activation ON/OFF control
Main scanning direction sync control
Sub scanning direction sync control
BD correction control
Light intensity control APC control
Others Scanner motor speed control
6.1.2 Overview
0013-8531
The machine's laser exposure system serves to form a static (latent) image on the surface of the photosensitive drum according to the video signals from the main
controller, and it consists of 2 laser driver PCBs, a BD circuit (Note 1), and a scanner motor among others.
These components are constructed as a single entity (scanner unit), and are controlled by the DC controller.
6-1
Chapter 6
M-CON
D-CON
[10]
[1]
[10]
[11]
[12]
[13]
[11]
Y M C Bk
[10] [12] [10] [10]
[10]
[11] [11]
F-6-1
[1] Y/M laser driver
[2] Y/M video signal
[3] Y/M laser control signal
[4] Scanner motor control signal
[5] C/Bk video signal
[6] C/Bk laser control signal
[7] BD circuit
[8] BD signal
[9] C/Bk laser driver
[10] Imaging lens
[11] Reflecting mirror
[12] Polygon mirror
[13] Scanner motor
M-CON : main controller
D-CON : DC controller
The machine's laser scanner unit uses a single scanner motor (polygon mirror motor) to scan 4 laser beams across the surface of the photosensitive drum, thus saving
space (1-polygon mirror/4-laser beam method; Note 2).
The laser/scanner unit uses the following sequence when making a full-color print:
1) The print command arrives from the main controller. In response, the DC controller turns on the scanner motor to rotate the 6-facet mirror.
2) When the scanner motor starts to rotate, the DC controller uses the scanner motor control signal and the BD signal to make sure that the scanner motor rotates
at a specific speed.
3) When the revolution of the scanner motor has reached a specific speed, the DC controller sends video signals for individual colors (YMCBk) to the laser driver
PCB.
4) In response, the respective laser driver turns on the laser diode.
5) The resulting laser beam hits the 6-facet mirror, which is rotating at a specific speed.
6) The laser beam then is reflected by the 6-facet mirror, and is moved to the imaging lens and the reflecting mirror found in front of the mirror to reach the surface
of the photosensitive drum.
6-2
Chapter 6
7) As the 6-facet mirror rotates at a specific speed, the laser beam scans the surface of the photosensitive drum accordingly.
8) As the 6-facet mirror rotates and, as a result, the laser beams scan the surface of the photosensitive drum at a specific speed, a static image of multiple colors is
formed on the drum surface.
1 : The machine's BD circuit is found on its CBk driver PCB, and the BD signal occurs in keeping with the activation of the laser diode of the Bk driver.
2 : 1-Polygon 4-Laser Method
The term refers to a method in which a single polygon mirror is used for 4 laser beams. There are 4 laser diodes, the beams of which are directed to a multiple-facet
mirror mounted on a single scanner motor. The method inherently brings about a reduction in space.
The laser light goes on and off when the laser diode of the laser driver PCB goes on and off at a specific intensity. The machine's laser driver PCB consists of 2
PCBs (Y/M laser driver PCB, C/Bk laser driver PCB), each with 2 systems of driver circuitry. The circuit turns on and off the laser light of individual colors ac-
cording to the combination of laser control signals (LC_CTL0/LC_CTL1) coming from the DC controller.
T-6-5
D-CON
[4] [5]
[6]
[2] [3]
[1]
F-6-2
[1] Y/M laser driver
[2] Y laser control signal
[3] M laser control signal
[4] C laser control signal
[5] Bk laser control signal
[6] C/Bk laser driver
In the forced outage mode, the intensity settings made through APC are cancelled.
6-3
Chapter 6
[1]
600DPI 1200DPI
1/2
1/2
1/2
F-6-3
[1] 1 pixel
6-4
Chapter 6
M-CON
VDO Bk
VDO M
VDO C
BD Bk
VDO Y
BD M
BD C
BD Y
D-CON
BD RAW1
Laser Drive Signal Y, M
C Bk
[2]
[3]
[1]
F-6-4
[1] Y/M laser driver
[2] BD circuit
[3] C/Bk laser driver
[1]
VDO (C,Bk)
T1
VDO
VDO (Y,M)
T2
VDO
F-6-5
[1] Reference BD
The machine executes synchronization in sub scanning direction so as to match the lead edge of an image and the lead edge of paper. This control is executed for
every color, and is controlled by the DC controller.
6-5
Chapter 6
M-CON
Print command
VDO Bk
Bk TOP
VDO M
VDO C
M TOP
VDO Y
C TOP
Y TOP
D-CON
[2]
[1]
F-6-6
[1] Y/M laser driver
[2] C/Bk laser driver
The following is a timing chart depicting the relationship between the TOP signal of individual colors and video signals:
6-6
Chapter 6
[1]
[2]
P TOP
Y TOP
M TOP
C TOP
Bk TOP
[3]
VDO Y
[3]
VDO M
[3]
VDO C
[3]
VDO Bk
F-6-7
[1] Print command
[2] Internal timer
[3] Video signal for a single page
6.2.1.4 BD Correction
0014-0763
The polygon mirror used in the machine's laser scanner has resulted in imperceptible manufacturing variation of its mirror surface angle. In other words, the ma-
chine, which determines the start points of 4 main scanning lines using the Bk laser as the reference BD, is inherently subject to variation in the starting points of
Y and M main scanning lines.
To make up for the variation, the machine computes the variation among the angles of individual mirrors by measuring BD intervals, correcting the start points of
the Y and M main scanning lines based on the result of the computation.
The machine executes this correction each time it is turned on or for each print job.
6-7
Chapter 6
D-CON
BD circuit
D-CON
Actual write
start position BD circuit
F-6-8
VDO
T1
VDO
T1
VDO
T1
F-6-9
The following diagram shows the flow of the control mechanism:
6-8
Chapter 6
START
BD interval
measurement
Short interval Specific interval Specific interval Specific interval
Write start
position correction
END
F-6-10
Bk is used to detect the reference BD signal and, as such, laser light is directed to the surface of the polygon mirror. In other words, the write start position in main
scanning direction for Bk is determined based on actual measurement and, for this reason, the possible presence of variation in the angle of the polygon mirror
surface will not lead to variation of Bk write start position.
The laser driver for C is found directly under the Bk laser driver and, for this reason, the C laser driver directs laser light against the same polygon mirror surface
as the Bk laser driver, eliminating the effects of variation in the angle of the polygon mirror surface. The write start position of C, for this reason, is also free of
variation as in the case of Bk.
The machine uses APC control to make sure that the intensity of laser light remains at a specific level.
The machine uses 2 laser driver PCBs, each with a laser driver IC taking care of 2 colors and performing APC control for individual colors.
The following is an outline of APC control operation, executed each time the machine is turned on and for each print job:
1) The DC controller sends the laser control signal (LC_CTL_X(0)=0, LC_CTL_X(1)=1) to the laser driver IC on the laser driver PCB. (X differs depending on
the color.)
2) The laser driver IC is set to APC mode, thus forcing the laser diode (LD) to go on.
3) The laser driver IC monitors the laser diode (LD) by means of a photo diode (PD), adjusting the output of the laser diode until its light is a specific level of
intensity.
4) The laser driver IC stores the laser output in memory for use in the next print job.
6-9
Chapter 6
PD
LC_CTL_P3(0)
Laser Driver IC
LC_CTL_P3(1)
LD
Laser
Relay
PCB
D-CON
5V
PD
LC_CTL_P4(0)
Laser Driver IC
LC_CTL_P4(1)
LD
F-6-11
The machine controls the laser scanner motor so that it rotates at a specific speed.
The control mechanism is governed by the motor speed control block and the reference signal generation block according to the instructions from the CPU of the
DC controller.
The motor speed control block compares the speed detection signal (FG, BD) against the reference signal generated by the reference signal generation block to
control the acceleration signal (ACC) and the deceleration signal (DEC) so that the scanner motor rotates at a specific speed.
The machine uses 2 speed detection signals with the aim of helping the laser scanner unit last longer (Notes). The FG signal is a detection signal for coarse adjust-
ment used at time of motor start-up, while the BD signal is a detection signal used to fine-adjust the motor to the target speed.
The motor control mechanism operates as follows:
1) The DC controller turns on the ACC signal, thus causing the scanner motor to rotate.
2) The DC controller uses the result of FG signal detection to control the ACC signal and the DEC signal so that the motor will rotate at a specific speed.
3) The DC controller switches from the FG signal to the BD signal; then, using the result of BD signal detection, controls the ACC signal and the DEC signal so
that the motor will continuously rotate at the target speed.
6-10
Chapter 6
D-CON
CPU
[1] [2]
BD RAW1
[5] [6]
[4]
DEC
ACC
FG
[3]
F-6-12
[1] Reference signal generation block
[2] Motor speed control block
[3] Scanner motor
[4] C/Bk laser driver
[5] BD circuit
[6] Laser relay PCB
MEMO:
The life of the laser scanner unit is dependent on the length of time during which the laser light is emitted.
To reduce the need for the detection of the BD signal associated with the emission of laser light, the machine also uses the FG signal for speed detection.
6-11
Chapter 6
[2]
6.3 Parts Replacement Procedure
[2]
F-6-13
2) Disconnect the connector [1] and the flat cable [2]. F-6-17
When mounting the laser scanner unit, fit the boss [1] of the scanner unit into
the slot of the machine, and be sure that the unit is secured in place.
[1]
F-6-18
F-6-15
4) Remove the laser scanner unit [1].
- 3 screws [1]
[2]
F-6-19
Also, check to see that the heights of the screw [1] on the front side and the
screw [2] on the rear side are the same.
6-12
Chapter 6
[1]
[2]
F-6-20
When replacing the laser scanner unit, register the values described on the
label which is included in the package in the service modes below. After reg-
istration, attach the label onto the front cover.
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-Y1 to 8
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-M1 to 8
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-C1 to 8
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-K1 to 8
Registration of the main scanner reproduction ratio correction value
6-13
Chapter 7 Image Formation
Contents
Contents
7.1 Construction
The main specifications, controls and functions of the image formation system are as described below.
T-7-1
Secondary transfer
Charging system Roller contact charging
Charging roller diameter 24.7 mm
Cleaning mechanism Reverse bias
T-7-9
7-1
Chapter 7
7.1.2 Overview
0013-8461
The image formation system is the core of the machine, ultimately forming toner images on paper.
The machine's imaging system consists of a photosensitive drum, developing cylinder, 4 drum units containing carrier, 4 toner containers, ITB unit, fixing assembly,
and secondary transfer outside roller, all controlled by the DC controller.
When the print command arrives from the main controller, the DC controller controls the laser/scanner unit and HVT1/2 (high-voltage PCB) to form images on
paper according to the instructionsarriving in the form of a video signal.
[4]
[5]
[3]
[6]
[2] Y
M
C
BK
[1]
VDO
DEV
PR1
TR2
TR1
HVT1 HVT2
D-CON
[8] [7]
M-CON
F-7-1
[1] Laser scanner unit
[2] Drum unit
[3] ITB unit
[4] Toner container
[5] Fixing assembly
[6] Secondary transfer outside roller
[7] Video signal
[8] Print command
The machine's printing process may broadly be divided into 6 blocks, which are made up of a total of 10 steps. The machine forms images on print paper by exe-
cuting the functions assigned to these blocks.
The following is a block diagram of the printing process, followed by an outline of the steps:
7-2
Chapter 7
Delivery
Fixing block
7.fixing
ITB cleaning block
8.ITB cleaning
Transfer block
ITB 6.separation
4.primar
y trans
fer
4.primar
y trans
fer
3.Development 4.primar
Development
y trans
fer 5.secondary
block Y 4.primar transfer
9.Drum cleaning y trans
fer
photosensitive
2.laser beam drum 10.post
exposure -exposure
M
photosensitive drum C
photosensitive drum Bk
1.primary charging
photosensitive drum
Static image formati Drum
on block cleaning
block
Pickup
flow of paper
F-7-2
A. Static Image Formation Block
Forms a static image on the surface of the photosensitive drum.
step 1: primary charging (charges the surface of the drum to an even negative potential)
step 2: laser beam exposure (forms a static image on the surface of the photosensitive drum)
B. Developing Block
Deposits toner over the static image on the surface of the photosensitive drum, thus turning it into a visible image.
step 3: development
C. Transfer Block
Moves the toner image from the surface of the photosensitive drum to print paper.
step 4: primary transfer (moves toner from the surface of the photosensitive drum to the ITB)
step 5: secondary transfer (moves toner from the ITB to paper)
step 6: separation (separates paper from the ITB)
D. Fixing Block
Fuses the toner image to the paper.
step 7: fixing
This block consists of 2 steps, at the end of which a static image is formed on the surface of the photosensitive drum.
At the end, those areas of the surface of the photosensitive drum that have not been exposed by the laser beam (dark area) retain negative charges, while those
exposed by the beam are free of negative charges. The resulting static image is not visible to the human eye and, thus, is called a static "latent" image.
Time (t)
0
-100
Photosensitive drum surface potential (V)
Light area
-500
Dark area
laser beam
Primary charging Laser exposure Primary transfer Primary charging
(step 1) (step 2) (step 4) (step 1)
F-7-3
7-3
Chapter 7
Photosensitive drum
AC bias
F-7-4
Step 2: laser beam exposure
In this step, a static image is formed on the surface of the photosensitive drum.
The negatively charged surface of the photosensitive drum is exposed by a laser beam. As a result, those areas hit by the beam are neutralized (light area), thus
eliminating negative charges and consequently forming a static image on the surface.
Laser beam
F-7-5
7-4
Chapter 7
In this block, the machine uses a toner projection method in which it deposits toner over the surface of the photosensitive drum, thus turning the static image into
a visible image. The developer used here is a 2-component developer, composed of non-magnetic toner and carrier.
Toner
Photosensitive drum
Carrier
Developing cylinder
AC bias
DC bias
Blade
Toner feedscrew A
Toner feedscrew B
F-7-6
Step 3: development
The drum unit consists of a photosensitive drum, developing cylinder, and a blade.
The developer is composed of toner (mainly of resin and dye) and carrier (iron powder) mixed in a specific ratio. The friction occurring between toner and carrier
causes the toner to become negatively charged and carrier to become positively charged.
The developer adheres to the surface of the developing cylinder by the work of a fixed magnet, and a blade is used to form a uniform layer of developer.
At this time, the areas of the photosensitive drum exposed by the laser beam will have a positive potential in relation to the developing cylinder.
As a result, the toner charged to a more or less identical potential as the developing cylinder will move to and stick to the areas of the photosensitive drum exposed
by the laser beam. This phenomenon is referred to as "toner projection," and is used to turn the image on the surface of the photosensitive drum into a visible image.
The "light area" of the photosensitive drum is charged to a negative potential; however, the diagram below shows it as being charged to a positive potential, indi-
cating that its potential is higher than that of the developing cylinder when the cylinder is used as the reference.
+V
Drum surface potential (light area)
0
Potential (V)
Toner potential
7-5
Chapter 7
This block consists of 3 steps, in which the toner image is moved from the photosensitive drum surface to paper.
ITB
DC bias
photosensitive drum
F-7-8
ITB
Paper
DC bias
F-7-9
step 6: separation
In this step, the rigidity of paper is used to separate paper from the ITB.
Thin paper has little body. The static eliminator decreases the charges on paper, thus weakening the static bonding and, consequently, facilitating separation.
7-6
Chapter 7
ITB
Paper
Static
eliminator
F-7-10
The machine uses an on-demand method, which tends to require less heat than other methods. The machine's heater heats up fast and does not require power in a
standby state, with the ultimate result that the machine is characterized by a short wait time and high energy efficiency.
The machine's pressure roller has a higher potential than the fixing sleeve, thus enabling the full retention of the negatively charged toner on paper and, at the same
time, preventing adhesion of toner to the fixing sleeve.
step 7: fixing
In this step, the toner on the paper is subjected to heat and pressure so that it will melt (while mixing colors) to create a permanent image.
Fixing sleeve
Fixing heater Pressure roller
Paper
F-7-11
7-7
Chapter 7
In this block, the ITB is cleaned to prevent image faults that otherwise could occur because of soiling on the ITB.
Residual toner
ITB
Tension roller
F-7-12
ITB
Residual toner
Photosensitive drum
F-7-13
7-8
Chapter 7
Photosensitive drum
Laser beam
F-7-14
7.2.1 Overview
0013-8474
This circuit works for applying bias to the primary charging roller, the developing cylinder, the primary transfer roller and the secondary transfer outer roller. These
biases are generated by the control of the DC controller to HVT1 and HVT2.
See the following table for the main circuit
7-9
Chapter 7
[3]
[2]
[1] [5]
[4]
PRI_DC_YMC
DEV_DC_Bk
DEV_AC_Bk
PRI_DC_Bk
PRI_AC_Bk
PRI_AC_M
PRI_AC_C
PRI_AC_Y
TRI_Bk
TRI_M
TRI_C
TRI_Y
TR2S
TR2
[6] [7] [10]
HVT1 HVT2
D-CON
F-7-15
[1] Developing cylinder
[2] Photosensitive drum
[3] Primary transfer roller
[4] Primary charging roller
[5] Secondary transfer outer roller
[6] Primary charging AC high-voltage generation circuit
[7] Primary charging high-voltage generation circuit
[8] Developing AC high-voltage generation circuit
[9] Developing DC high-voltage generation circuit
[10] Primary transfer DC high-voltage generation circuit
[11] Secondary transfer DC high-voltage generation circuit
The primary charging bias is generated to charge the surface of the photosensitive drum to an even negative potential as preparatory work for image formation.
The bias is generated by the primary charging AC high-voltage generation circuit and the primary charging DC high-voltage generation circuit of HVT1.
The primary charging AC high-voltage generation circuit is used to generate the AC bias applied to the primary charging roller. It generates 4 types of biases
(PRI_AC_Y, PRI_AC_MJ, PRI_AC_C, PRI_AC_Bk), independent among individual colors.
The primary charging DC high-voltage generation circuit is used to generate the DC bias applied to the primary charging roller. It generates 2 types of biases
(PRI_DC_YMC, PRI_DC_Bk) for color and Bk.
The AC and DC biases that have been generated by these circuits are combined at such times as specified for application to the primary charging roller of the drum
unit.
The level of the primary charging bias varies in keeping with the instructions from the DC controller.
7-10
Chapter 7
The AC and DC biases thus generated are combined at such times as specified for application to the developing cylinder.
The level of the developing bias varies in keeping with the instructions from the DC controller.
The primary transfer bias is used to transfer toner from the surface of the photosensitive drum to the ITB.
The bias is generated by the primary transfer DC high-voltage generation circuit of HVT2. The circuit is used to provide a DC bias for application to the primary
transfer roller, producing 4 independent biases for individual colors (TR1_Y, TR1_M, TR1_C, TR1_Bk). These DC biases are applied to the primary transfer roller
at such times as specified.
The level of the primary transfer bias varies according to the instructions from the DC controller.
The DC controller, on the other hand, switches the voltage level of the primary transfer bias for constant voltage control according to the primary transfer current
feedback signal (TR1S) arriving from the primary transfer high-voltage generation circuit.
The secondary transfer bias is used to transfer toner from the ITB to paper.
The bias may be either DC positive bias or DC negative bias generated by the DC high-voltage generation circuit of HVT2. The DC positive bias is applied to the
secondary transfer roller at time of toner transfer, while the DC negative bias is applied to the secondary transfer roller at time of cleaning.
The high-voltage power supply circuit applies these secondary transfer biases (TR2) to the secondary transfer roller in keeping with a specific printing sequence as
follows:
The level of the secondary transfer bias varies in keeping with the instructions from the DC controller.
The DC controller, on the other hand, switches the level of the secondary transfer bias in keeping with the secondary transfer current feedback signal (TR2S) arriving
from the secondary transfer DC high-voltage generation circuit for constant voltage control.
To ensure an ideal image against the deterioration of parts associated with imaging otherwise occurring as a result of changes in the environment or in the machine,
the following mechanisms are used:
Y
M
C
BK UN16
UN15
Laser
Scanner
Unit
Item Description
[1]Drum film thickness detection computes the film thickness of the photosensitive drum
[2]ATR control determines the amount of toner to supply
7-11
Chapter 7
Item Description
[3]Color Dmax control determines the best level of laser power
[4]Black Dmax control determines the best level of developing bias
[5]PASCAL control determines the best gradation table
[6]Dhalf control determines the best gradation table
[7]Abridged Dhalf control determines the best gradation table (abridged)
[8]Color displacement correction control determines the correction value of color displacement
[9]ATVC control determines the best level of transfer bias
The items that are executed as part of image stabilization control differ depending on the condition of the machine (environment or deterioration of parts associated
with the image formation system). The following table shows the items:
T-7-11
Items
Condition Down-time Drum film ATR control Color D-max Black D-max PASCAL D-half Abridged D- Color ATVC
(Max) thickness control control control control half control displacemen control
detection t control
Power-on 22 sec
Yes Yes Yes Yes
(approx.)
Drum unit replacement 215 sec
Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
(w/ new) (approx.) *1
Return from sleep state 22 sec
Yes Yes Yes Yes
*2 (approx.)
Initial rotation 10 sec
Yes Yes Yes
(approx.)
Printing *3 15 sec
Yes Yes Yes
(approx.)
Post-rotation 55 sec
Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
(approx.)
When user-specific 100 sec
calibration is performed (approx.) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
(full correction)
When user-specific 55 sec
calibration is performed (approx.) Yes Yes Yes Yes
(quick correction)
*1: The down-time interval includes the time during which the drum unit rotates idly (10 sec).
*2: This item is executed when the ongoing sleep state lasts more than 8 hr (otherwise, nothing will take place).
*3: At times, ATR control and color displacement may be executed by interrupting the ongoing print job.
MEMO:
- When the user mode "auto gradation adjustment $ full adjustment" is selected, PASCAL control, D-half control and ARCDAT control are implemented in this
order to adjust the image gradation density (full adjustment).
- When the user mode "auto gradation adjustment $ quick adjustment" is selected, D-half control and ARCDAT control are implemented in this order to adjust
image gradation density (quick adjustment).
To form an optimum image against the possible wear on the photosensitive drum, the machine checks the thickness of the drum film. The check is made for every
drum (color), and the result is recorded in EEPROM of the DC controller.
The DC controller is referred when this data detects the primary charging AC bias, the primary transfer bias, and the ATR control target value.
1. Start-Up Timing
at power-on, when closing/opening the front cover, at time of printing
2. Particulars of Control
The DC controller goes through the following to detect the thickness of the drum film:
1) computes the drum count based on "length of time during which the photosensitive drum has rotated" and "length of time during which the primary charging AC
bias is applied."
2) adds the count obtained in 1 above to the count stored in EEPROM.
3) identifies the count as indicating any of the following 3 in terms of the drum film thickness detection data based on the latest count obtained in 2 above: initial
condition, normal condition, final condition.
4) in the event of there being a difference as the result of comparison of the latest drum film thickness data against the stored drum film thickness data, the new data
is written over the existing data; in the absence of a difference, on the other hand, no write operation will take place and the new data will be discarded.
7-12
Chapter 7
[1]
M1
[2]
[3] Y
M
C
BK
HVT1
[4]
D-CON
EEPROM
Y Y
M M
C C
BK BK
F-7-17
[1] Drum/ITB motor drive signal
[2] Photosensitive drum
[3] Primary charging roller
[4] Primary charging AC bias drive signal
[5] Internal data
[6] Drum count
[7] Drum film thickness detection data
MEMO:
The drum film thickness-related data stored in EEPROM may be either drum count or drum film thickness detection data, the drum film thickness count being
internal data and used when determining bias levels.
The machine executes ATR control to supply toner so that the ratio between toner and carrier inside the drum unit may remain ideal.
2. Particulars of Control
The machine computes the amount of toner to supply for each color, and supplies it to the drum unit.
The machine uses the following 2 types of data to compute toner amounts:
- Video Count (for each print)
The machine uses the video data arriving from the main controller to compute the amount of toner consumed, and makes up for it by supplying the drum unit
with the same amount.
- Result of Detection by the Patch Image Read Sensor (to every 80-sheet *1)
The machine measures the toner image formed on the ITB using the patch image read sensor, and supplies the drum unit so that the density will be identical to
the target density.
*1: The condition of execution is based on printing an original with an image ratio of 25%.
7-13
Chapter 7
ITB
Y
M
C
BK
UN16
[2]
D-CON
[1]
M-CON
F-7-18
[1] Video data
[2] Result of detection by the patch image read sensor
UN16: patch image read sensor (also serves as color displacement sensor A)
The machine uses D-max control to limit changes in the image density possibly occurring as the result of deterioration of the photosensitive drum or toner. The
image density is corrected on the printer side.
This control consists of 2 types: color D-max and black D-max.
Color D-max is density correction of colors (Y, M, C), while black D-max is density correction of Bk.
The details of these control mechanisms are as follows:
7-14
Chapter 7
ITB
[1]
UN16
[2]
[4] [5]
Laser Scanner
unit
HVT1
[3]
[6] [7]
D-CON
F-7-19
[1] Photosensitive drum
[2] Developing cylinder
[3] Path image data
[4] Laser output
[5] Developing DC bias
[6] Color D-max control
[7] Black D-max control
UN16: patch image sensor
2. Particulars of Control
In the presence of a specific condition, the DC controller forms a patch pattern of the color in question on the ITB. Thereafter, it uses the patch image sensor to
measure the density of the patch, and corrects the output of the laser light of the color in question so that the density will be identical to the target density.
The machine executes this control only for the color of the drum unit that has been replaced.
ITB
M
Y Y
M C
C
Laser Scanner
unit UN16
[3]
[2] [1]
D-CON
F-7-20
[1] Patch image data
[2] Laser output
[3] Photosensitive drum
UN16: patch image sensor
MEMO:
In previous machines, density is corrected by varying the developing bias of individual colors. The machine uses the same developing bias for all colors (a design
consideration made to facilitate work at the factory), not being able to vary the developing bias for individual colors. To work around the fact, the machine corrects
the density of individual colors (Y, M, C). It, however, varies the developing bias for Bk as in previous machines.
7-15
Chapter 7
3. Flow of Operation
Start-up
DC controller
UN16
Y8 DC controller
Y3
D-max correction table creation
Y2 (Y, M, C)
Y1
DC controller
0 Laser output
Laser output determination
F-7-21
2. Particulars of Control
In the presence of a specific condition, the DC controller forms a patch pattern (Notes) of Bk on the ITB.
Thereafter, the DC controller uses the patch image sensor (UN16) to measure the patch density, thereby correcting the developing DC bias of Bk so that the density
will be identical to the target density.
ITB
Bk
[3]
UN16
[1]
HVT1
[2]
D-CON
F-7-22
[1] Patch image data
[2] Developing DC bias
[3] Developing cylinder
UN16: patch image sensor
MEMO:
To reduce down-time, the machine forms only one patch on the ITB. If, however, the measured patch density is outside the range of correction, it forms an additional
patch. If the density is still outside the range of correction for a second time, the machine continues until it has formed as many as 4 patches.
7-16
Chapter 7
Start-up
DC controller
UN16
Patch reading
1st patch
DC controller
Density
Black D-max correction
Target
table formation
Correction
range
Bk1
0 Vdc
2nd patch
Density
Bk2
Target
Bk1
0 Vdc
No
Within correction range?
Yes
4 patches max.
DC controller
2. Control Description
When the specified conditions are satisfied, the main controller prints three kinds of the stored patch pattern (see MEMO) on paper. Service technician sets the test
print to the reader. Reader reads the gradation density of the patch pattern from the test print. After that, the main controller creates the image gradation density
correction table from the gradation density data of the patch pattern read by the reader. In this control, the gradation correction for all colors is executed regardless
of replaced drum cartridge.
3. Operation Flow
7-17
Chapter 7
Start-up
Main controller
DC controller
Data output(V-CON)
100
Ideal gradation
characteristics
Density data(D-CON)
Gradation characteristics
after correction
0 100
Data output(V-CON)
F-7-24
MEMO:
This control creates the following 3 types of patch patterns.
- pattern for copy (64-patch for each color)
- character pattern (64-patch for each color)
- photo pattern (64-patch for each color)
The machine uses the main controller to execute gradation correction to enable ideal gradation characteristics.
1. Start-Up Timing
- when the drum unit is replaced with a new one
- during post-rotation executed every 1000 prints
- during execution of calibration (user mode)
2. Particulars of Control
In the presence of a specific condition, the main controller sends the patch data of individual colors (Y, M, C, Bk) to the DC controller, which in turn forms a patch
pattern of each color (Y, M, C, Bk) on the ITB. Thereafter, the DC controller uses the patch image sensor (UN14) to measure the patch pattern, and sends the result
back to the main controller, which executes gradation correction based on the data so that ideal halftone images may be obtained.
In this control, the machine also forms a reference patch for use by abridged D-half control, and stores the reference data for abridged D-half control collected from
UN14. (See Notes.)
The machine executes gradation correction for all colors, regardless of which drum unit may have been replaced.
7-18
Chapter 7
ITB
UN16
Laser Scanner
unit
[4] [1]
D-CON
[2]
[3]
M-CON
F-7-25
[1] Patch image data
[2] Density data
[3] D-half control
[4] Video data
UN16: patch image sensor
3. Flow of Operation
7-19
Chapter 7
Start-up
Main controller
DC controller
Data output(V-CON)
100
Ideal gradation
characteristics
Density data(D-CON)
Gradation characteristics
after correction
0 100
Data output(V-CON)
F-7-26
MEMO:
The patch pattern formed in the course of this control may be either of the following 3 types:
- pattern with priority on characters (6 patches in total for each color)
- pattern with priority on photo (6 patches in total for each color)
- reference pattern for abridged D-half (1 patch for each color)
Flow of Computing the Correction Value for Abridged D-half
Start-up
DC controller
Reference patch pattern
creation for ARCDAT
UN16
Patch reading
Density data(D-CON)
100
DC controller
40 INT
20
7-20
Chapter 7
The machine performs abridged D-half control to attain ideal gradation characteristics and to reduce downtime (by the main controller).
1. Start-Up Timing
- when the power is turned on
- during post-rotation executed every 25 prints (*1)
- during return from sleep
2. Particulars of Control
In the presence of a specific condition, the DC controller forms a patch pattern of each color (Y, M, C, Bk) on the ITB (a single pattern for each color, a total of 4
patterns). Thereafter, the DC controller measures the patch pattern using the patch image sensor (UN14), and sends the result back to the main controller, which in
turn compares it against the abridged D-half reference data backed up in memory and uses the difference as the offset value for D-half.
ITB
Y
M
C k
B
UN16
Laser Scanner
unit
[4] [1]
D-CON
[2]
[3]
M-CON
F-7-28
[1] Patch image data
[2] Density data
[3] Abridged D-half control
[4] Video data
UN16: patch image sensor
3. Flow of Operation
7-21
Chapter 7
Start-up
DC controller
UN16
Patch reading
DC controller
Main controller
Comparison of measurement data (SIN)
Density data(D-CON)
20 SIN
10 40 Main controller
Data output(D-CON)
Offset value (alpha) determination
(i.e., difference between SIN and INT)
Main controller
Inclusion of result in
D-half correction table
Density data(D-CON)
60 Gradation characteristics
after correction
40
20
40
Data output(V-CON)
F-7-29
The machine performs the following 3 types of control to correct displacement of color possibly caused by differences among components of its laser scanner unit
and drum unit:
- main scanning write start correction
- sub scanning write start correction
- main scanning magnification correction control
The DC controller forms patterns for detection of color displacement for individual colors, and uses the color displacement sensor to detect the position of the pat-
terns.
The DC controller computes the degree of displacement with reference to the position of the pattern detected; based on the result, the DC controller or the main
controller corrects the displacement for individual colors.
7-22
Chapter 7
ITB
Y
M
C
BK
Y
M
C
BK
UN15
UN16
Video Data
Laser Scanner Unit
[1] [1]
D-CON
M-CON
F-7-30
[1] Color displacement detection signal
UN16: color displacement sensor A
UN15: color displacement sensor B
D-CON: DC controller
M-CON: Main controller
A. Start-Up Timing
- at power-on
- when the front cover is opened/closed
- during recovery from sleep
- during initial rotation upon detection of a change in the environment (condition 1)
- between sheets upon detection of a change in the environment (condition 2)
- When new drum unit is installed
Condition 1:
as a result of comparison against the previously detected machine inside temperature, a change of 4 deg C or more exists
Condition 2:
- the standby time has lasted 10 min or more and the machine inside temperature has changed 1 deg C or more
- during continuous printing, the machine inside temperature is different from the previously detected temperature by 4 deg C or more
[1]
F-7-31
7-23
Chapter 7
B
A
C
[1]
F-7-32
[1] Color displacement sensor A
The machine uses Y as the reference when measuring color displacement and, therefore, does not make correction for the reference color.
A B
[1] [2]
F-7-33
[1] Color displacement sensor A
[2] Color displacement sensor B
Main scanning magnification correction control computes colour displacement correction values based on the partial magnification adjustment values for the image
main scanning direction. There are eight blocks for each of the four colours, Y, M, C and Bk, giving a total of 32 values, which are programmed in the service
mode when the device is installed.
Whenever the laser scanner unit is replaced, all 32 of the partial magnification adjustment values for the image main scanning direction (which appear on a label
affixed to new laser scanner units) must be entered into the following service modes, otherwise colour displacement will occur.
COPIER > ADJUST > LASER >FSLUT-Y 1 to 8 correction values for partial magnification correction Y blocks 1 to 8
COPIER > ADJUST > LASER >FSLUT-M 1 to 8 correction values for partial magnification correction M blocks 1 to 8
7-24
Chapter 7
COPIER > ADJUST > LASER >FSLUT-C 1 to 8 correction values for partial magnification correction Y blocks 1 to 8
COPIER > ADJUST > LASER >FSLUT-K 1 to 8 correction values for partial magnification correction K blocks 1 to 8
Also, when the DC controller circuit board is replaced, the above values should be entered as per the details on the service label or on the P-PRINT label.
In the case of transferring toner, this control has 2 types of controls: the primary transfer ATVC and the secondary transfer ATVC, to decide the most suitable
transfer bias.
[1]
[2]
[4] [3]
HVT2
ROOM_TEMP2
ROOM_TEMP1
TR1S_BK
TR1S_M
TR1S_C
TR1S_Y
TR2S
D-CON
F-7-34
[1] Primary transfer roller
[2] Secondary transfer outside roller
[3] Machine inside environment sensor
[4] Machine outside environment sensor
b. Particulars of Control
T-7-12
a. Start-Up Conditions
- at power-on
- when the drum unit is replaced with a new one
- during initial rotation
- during post-rotation executed every 1000 prints
- during recovery from sleep
- during execution of calibration
b. Particulars of Control
T-7-13
7-25
Chapter 7
If continuous print is carried out while there is no toner being sent on to the ITB cleaning blade, the blade may bend backwards. This sequence feeds non-transferred
toner to the cleaning blade in order to prevent this problem.
1. Timing
- When belt rotation is performed after 1,000 sheets printing.
2. Sequence details
After image formation in the normal sequence, a black band (half-tone pattern) is formed over the total width of the ITB, for a length of 10mm, with density FFh.
Once the black band clears the secondary transfer roller, secondary transfer outer roller cleaning (see Note) is performed.
Further, once the black band is formed, the cumulative counter resets to the default (0).
Negative bias (TR2 signal) is applied to the secondary transfer outer roller to prevent rear soiling of the print paper, and this creates a difference in electro-potential
between the ITB and the roller. As a result, residual negative toner sticking to the secondary transfer outer roller returns to the ITB and is collected in the cleaning
unit by the ITB cleaning blade.
1. Timing
- During the page interval after 15 OHP sheets have been printed consecutively.
- Upon belt rotation after seven or more sheets have been printed since the previous OHP black band operation.
2. Sequence details
After image formation in the normal sequence, a black band (half-tone pattern) is formed over the total width of the ITB, for a length of 80mm, with density FFh.
Once the black band clears the secondary transfer roller, secondary transfer outer roller cleaning (see Note) is performed.
Further, once the black band is formed, the cumulative counter resets to the default (0).
Negative bias (TR2 signal) is applied to the secondary transfer outer roller to prevent rear soiling of the print paper, and this creates a difference in electro-potential
between the ITB and the roller. As a result, residual negative toner sticking to the secondary transfer outer roller returns to the ITB and is collected in the cleaning
unit by the ITB cleaning blade.
This sequence forms a band of toner to prevent any deterioration in developing that may occur after continued formation of low duty images.
1. Timing
When the average image duty per sheet falls below the standard value alpha (image ratio 2%).
2. Sequence details
When ATR control is performed, the cumulate image value duty since the previous ATR is extracted and, when the average image duty per sheet falls below the
standard value alpha (image ratio 2%), immediately after ATR patch formation, the toner band width (*1) is calculated and an A4 width colour belt is formed on
the ITB. Then, toner volume equivalent to that used to form the colour band is added to the refill counter by the video counter. This initiates toner refill, thus
preventing any deterioration in developing.
Also, with this function, even if a colour band is not formed, once ATR control is performed, the average image duty standard value alpha and the cumulative
counter both reset to their default values.
*1: The 1dot line (thrust A4 width) x toner band width video count is fixed so that it is equal to the per dot average image duty standard value alpha x average image
duty sheet count - cumulative image duty.
7-26
Chapter 7
A4 width
On ITB
F-7-35
Service Modes:
The per sheet average image duty standard value alpha can be changed in the following service mode.
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > DEVL - VTH
Setting range: 1% to 4%
MEMO:
Normally (when ATR control is performed between sheets, etc.), the colour band sequence is performed right after ATR control. However, when ATR is performed
when post rotation is being performed, the sequences are carried out in the order ATR control to ARCDAT control to colour band sequence.
3. Control flow
Start
Yes
End
F-7-36
7-27
Chapter 7
7.5.1.1 Overview
0014-0776
The machine uses 4 drum units (Y, M, C, Bk), each consisting of a drum unit, developing cylinder, primary charging roller, and carrier and housed under the ITB.
The following 3 types of electrical loads are associated with the supply path:
- motor: 2 types (development motor, drum/ITB motor)
- clutch: 1 type (developing sleeve clutch)
D-CON
[2]
M2 3
[1]
CL1 4
M1
Toner
[3]
[5] [4]
[6]
[7]
F-7-37
[1] Developing cylinder
[2] Photosensitive drum
[3] Waste toner feedscrew
[4] Primary charging roller
[5] Carrier
[6] Toner transport feedscrew A
[7] Toner transport feedscrew B
M1: drum/ITB motor
M2 and M3: development motor
CL1 through CL4: developing sleeve clutch
7-28
Chapter 7
The machine uses its DC controller to detect the presence/absence of a drum cartridge with reference to the primary charging AC bias detection signal (ANO_1).
The machine executes the detection when the power is turned on or when the front cover is closed, causing the DC controller to check the level of current of ANO_1
for individual drum unit.
If the result of detection indicates a level of the ANO_1 signal above a specific value, the DC controller will assume the absence of the unit in question, and at the
same time, notifies 'the absence of drum unit' on the touch panel.
[2]
[1]
Y
M
C
BK
ANO_1
PRI_AC
HVT1
ANO_1
PRI_AC
D-CON
F-7-38
[1] Primary charging roller
[2] Drum unit
D-CON
CPU
EEPROM
F-7-39
The following shows the timing at which the machine executes the detection and the flow of detection:
1. Timing of Detection
at power-on, after the front cover is opened/closed
2. Flow of Operation
7-29
Chapter 7
Start
No
All drum units present? Display 'No drum unit' message
Yes
No
All fuses present? End
Yes
Blow fuse
Fuse detection
No
Fuse blown
Yes
End
F-7-40
Do not replace drum units with new ones unnecessarily, in order to check function operations during service, etc. The device blows the drum fuse as soon as it
detects a new drum unit and resets the drum life counter to 0. Even if the old drum unit is replaced immediately, the drum life counter will increment as a new drum
unit.
Service Mode:
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > AINR-OFF
Invalidates drum initialisation that is performed when a new drum unit is installed. Also, the fuse is not blown, as it would usually be after drum initialisation is
completed.
This mode would be used to replace a drum unit temporarily in order to check image quality, for example when trying to trace the cause of a problem.
0: Initialisation carried out for new unit. Fuse blown. (Default)
1: No initialisation for new unit. Fuse not blown.
Further, this service mode should be set to [1] only when necessary for service. After the service is complete, the setting must always be returned to [0].
7-30
Chapter 7
The device is fitted with two toner shutters (the toner refill shutter and the waste toner shutter) to prevent toner soiling from the toner refill inlet or the waste toner
outlet when a drum unit is being removed or replaced.
These shutters are not motor driven but are opened and closed manually.
The toner refill shutter is opened/ closed by means of the position of the manually operated lock slide on the drum unit. When the slide is in the lock position, the
toner refill shutter is open and when the slide is in the unlock position, the toner refill shutter is closed.
The waste toner shutter is opened/ closed by means locking and unlocking the manually operated lock lever on the process unit. When the lever is in the lock
position, the waste toner shutter is open and when the lever is in the unlock position, the toner refill shutter is closed.
D-CON
[9] [6]
[8]
[1]
[7]
[10]
PS12
[4]
[5]
[2]
[3]
F-7-41
[1] Toner refill shutter
[2] Rear main plate
[3] waste toner shutter
[4] lock slide on the drum unit
[5] Waste toner case
[6] Waste toner discharge shutter open/closed detection signal
[7] Drum unit lock slide
[8] Bar
[9] Toner vessel
[10] Drum unit
T-CRG: toner container
D-CRG: drum unit
PS12: waste toner discharge shutter open/closed sensor
Error Code:
- E990-0000 (waste toner transport shutter error)
PS12 (waste toner shutter open/close detection sensor) output is H when waste toner shutter is open.
When the output of the abolition toner shutter opening and shutting detection sensor doesn't become "H" when it WMUPR period after the sleep returns after eight
hours or more pass, the door opening and shutting is detected or main power switch turns on, the error is generated.
7-31
Chapter 7
7.6.1 Overview
0014-0770
There are four toner retainers for Y, M, C and Bk. The retainer for each color is composed of toner and a stirring plate.
There is a hopper assembly under the toner retainer. There are an agitating plate, scraping spring and toner feed screw in the hopper assembly.
M-CON
D-CON
[1]
M8 11
[3]
[2]
[4]
TS1 TS4
PS3 PS6
[9]
F-7-42
[1] Stirring plate
[2] Agitating plate
[3] Scraping spring
[4] Toner feed screw
[5] Toner feed motor drive signal x4
[6] Toner sensor detection signal
[7] Toner feed level signalx4
[8] Toner container
[9] Drum unit
M8 through M11: Toner feed motor
PS3 through PS6: Toner feed level sensor
TS1 through TS4: Toner residual level sensor (piezosensor)
The toner for each color is fed from the toner retainer, via the hopper assembly, to the drum unit.
7-32
Chapter 7
M-CON
D-CON
M8 11
[3] [2]
[9]
CCW
[4]
PS3 PS6 [5]
[10]
F-7-43
[1] Stirring plate
[2] Agitating plate
[3] Scraping spring
[4] Sensor flag
[5] Toner feed screw
[6] Toner feed motor drive signal
[7] Toner feed motor error detection signal
[8] toner container
[9] drum unit
[10] Hopper assembly
M8 and M11: Toner feed motor
PS3 through PS6: Toner feed level sensor
The following is a timing chart depicting when 4 A4 full-color prints are made (with an image ratio of 40%):
[1] [2]
PS3 PS6
CCW CW
M8 M11
M2 M3
CL1 CL4
Error code:
E025-0000: Y developing assembly supply error
E025-0001: M developing assembly supply error
E025-0002: C developing assembly supply error
E025-0003: Bk developing assembly supply error
Any of the foregoing errors is identified when there is no change in the output of a specific sensor (PS3 through PS6) used for a particular developing assembly.
Reference:
While toner is being supplied, the toner supply motor (M8 through M11) is rotating counterclockwise (CCW). In other words, if all is normal, the toner supply
feedscrew will rotate, thus causing the output of PS3 through PS6 to change.
Reference:
7-33
Chapter 7
If all is normal, the toner supply motor (M8 through M11) rotates clockwise (CW). If something goes wrong and the motor rotates counterclockwise (CCW), how-
ever, the toner supply feedscrew will rotate to cause a change in the output of PS3 through (with the machine assuming malfunction of the toner supply motor).
To detect the toner residual level of the hopper assembly for each color, this machine uses the following two kinds of detecting methods.
- Detection by the piezosensor
- Detection by toner refill quantity detection sensor
M-CON
D-CON
[4]
[3] [2]
[1]
TS1 TS4
PS3 PS6
[5]
F-7-45
[1] Hopper assembly
[2] Toner detection signal
[3] Toner refill quantity detection signal
[4] drum unit
[5] toner container
TS1 through TS4: toner sensor (piezoelectric sensor)
PS3 to PS6: Toner feed level sensor
1. Detection by piezosensor
This is the detection for the presence or absence of the toner on the hopper assembly by the piezoelectric-vibrating piezosensor (TS1~4) mounted on the lower area
of the hopper assembly. It is executed at power ON, after the hopper assembly feeding and during the toner recovery control (hopper assembly forced feeding).
Piezosensor executes one set (sixteen times of reading) and judges the toner presence/absence based on the toner ratio at that time.
Toner absence: When the read value is judged as toner absence twelve times or more out of sixteen times
Toner presence: When judged as toner absence eight times or less out of sixteen times
7-34
Chapter 7
When toner is absence, the printing operation of the main body is stopped.
The toner feed level per one block varies, so the toner residual information is just a target. When the toner residual becomes 1% or less, the residual information is
not displayed on the touch panel and 0% is displayed at the time of the toner absence.
When toner is absence, the printing operation of the main body is stopped.
The toner feed level per one block varies, so the toner residual information is just a target. When the toner residual becomes 1% or less, the residual information is
not displayed on the touch panel and 0% is displayed at the time of the toner absence.
7.7.1.1 Overview
0013-8506
The transfer assembly is divided into the primary transfer block and the secondary transfer block.
The primary transfer block serves to move toner from the photosensitive drum to the ITB, while the secondary transfer block functions to move toner from the ITB
to print paper.
The transfer assembly consists of the following components: ITB cleaning unit, ITB, primary transfer roller, primary transfer roller, secondary toner inside roller,
tension roller, secondary transfer outside roller.
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10]
[11] [12]
F-7-46
[1] ITB cleaning unit
[2] ITB cleaning feedscrew
[3] ITB cleaning blade
[4] Tension roller
[5] Primary transfer roller
[6] ITB
[7] Idler roller
[8] Secondary transfer inside roller
[9] Secondary transfer outside roller
[10] Secondary transfer static eliminator
[11] Primary transfer block
[12] Secondary transfer block
The primary transfer block uses the drum/ITB motor (M1) to rotate the secondary transfer roller and the ITB cleaning feedscrew. The drive of M1 is controlled by
the DC controller.
The following describes the major control mechanism associated with the primary transfer block:
7-35
Chapter 7
D-CON
[4]
M1
[1]
[2]
[3]
F-7-47
[1] ITB cleaning feedscrew
[2] ITB
[3] Secondary transfer inside roller
[4] Drum/ITB motor drive signal
M1: drum/ITB motor
This controls for removing fingerprint that was left on ITB in the case that users touch the ITB by mistake (e.g., jam removal). This is controlled by the DC con-
troller. In accordance with user mode (cleaning of inside the machine) , the DC controller removes fingerprints that was left on ITB by executing the following
operations.
[1] [2]
ITB
TR2
HVT2
VDO
D-CON
M-CON
F-7-48
[1] ITB cleaning blade
[2] Bk halftone pattern
1. Particulars of Operation
1) The machine forms a Bk halftone pattern on the ITB over the length of the belt.
2) The machine executes ITB idle rotation. (about 45 sec)
As a result, the ITB cleaning blade removes the Bk band together with the fingerprints from the ITB. (The waste toner is collected in the cleaning unit.)
3) The machine repeats the foregoing steps (1 and 2) 3times.
4) The machine executes secondary transfer outside roller cleaning (Notes).
It takes about 180 seconds for all of the operations described above to be completed.
7-36
Chapter 7
To prevent soiling of the back of print paper, the machine applies a negative bias (TR2 signal) to the secondary transfer outside roller, thus creating a potential
between ITB and roller; as a result, the negatively charged residual toner and the secondary transfer outside roller is drawn back to the ITB, where it is scraped off
by the cleaning blade for collection in the ITB cleaning unit.
MEMO:
This is a cleaning sequence using toner. The amount of toner used in one sequence is equivalent to that required to print 40 sheets of A4 at 5% image ratio.
The secondary transfer block uses the drum/ITB motor (M1) as the source of drive to operate the secondary transfer roller. (M1 is controlled by the DC controller.)
D-CON
[2]
M1
[1]
F-7-49
[1] Secondary transfer outside roller
[2] Drum/ITB motor drive signal
M1: drum/ITB motor
The machine collects waste toner discharged from the 2 types of cleaning units (ITB cleaning unit, drum cleaning units of individual colors) for collection in the
waste toner case.
When the power is turned on or for each print job, the DC controller drives the waste toner transport motor (M12) to rotate the feedscrew inside the waste toner
pipe, thereby moving the waste toner.
The waste toner pipe is connected to the discharge outlet of the cleaning unit. When M12 goes on, the waste toner collecting at the discharge outlets is moved
through the waste toner pipe for collection in the waste toner case.
D-CON
WASTETNR_MTR_ON
[1] [2]
WASTETNR_MTR_ERR
[3]
M12
[9]
[4]
[7]
PS11
[8]
F-7-50
[1] ITB cleaning unit
[2] Waste toner discharge outlet
[3] Drum cleaning unit
[4] Waste toner discharge outlet
7-37
Chapter 7
[5] Screw
[6] Waste toner pipe
[7] Waste toner case
[8] Waste toner
[9] Waste toner screw
M12: waste toner transport motor
PS11: Waste toner case detection sensor
The machine executes the following 2 types of detection to find out the level of waste toner collected inside the waste toner case:
- detection by an optical sensor
- detection with reference to the video count
The DC controller checks the result of these detection mechanisms when the power is turned on, when the front door is opened/closed, and for each print job. If it
finds that the level of waste toner is above a specific value, the DC controller issues to the main controller either of 2 messages (waste toner case full alert, waste
toner case full).
The following shows the relationship between messages and waste toner levels:
T-7-15
Waste toner
Message type Message contents Detected by
quantity
Waste toner full warning "Waste toner bottle needs to be replaced soon. (Continued printing possible.)" Approx. 95% Optical sensor
Waste toner full "Replace waste toner bottle." 100 % Video count
M-CON
[1]
D-CON
[4]
[2]
[5]
PS11 [3]
[3] [4]
F-7-51
[1] Waste toner count
[2] Waste toner case full alert detection signal
[3] Waste toner case
[4] Waste toner
[5] Waste toner screw
UN6: waste toner sensor (optical sensor)
MEMO:
The sensor consists of a light-emitting segment (LED) and a light-receiving segment (PD).
When the level of waste toner is low, the light from the LED is received by the photodiode. When the level increases, on the other hand, the presence of waste toner
blocks the light from the LED, thus preventing reception of light by the photodiode, thus causing the output of the sensor to change from High to Low. The change
in the sensor output causes the DC controller to assume that the waste toner case is 95% full with waste toner.
7-38
Chapter 7
[5]
[2] PD
LED
[1]
[3] [4] PD
LED
F-7-52
[1] Waste toner sensor (optical sensor)
[2] Small amount of waste toner
[3] Large amount of waste toner
[4] Waste toner
[5] Waste toner screw
The machine remains ready to make prints even when a waste toner case full alert has been issued.
MEMO:
In this machine, to prevent the collected waste toner from accumulating like a heap and from overflowing out of the waste toner case, the waste toner screw built
in the waste toner case is rotated and the toner is made even. The waste toner screw is rotated by the motor (M12).
MEMO:
This machine also has a waste toner case replacement detection function. After opening and closing the main body front cover at the status of alarm, abnormality
of the waste toner level, the case is judged as having been replaced when it was detected as toner absence by the optical sensor (UN8) mounted on the back side of
the waste toner case.
7-39
Chapter 7
[1]
[1] F-7-56
F-7-53 5) Turn the handle [1] by 180 deg, and then, hold the handle [1] and the grip
2) Press the claw [1] downward to detach the handle cover [2]. [2] to pull out the process unit [3] until it stops.
[1]
[2]
[2]
[3] [1]
F-7-54
3) Press the release lever [1] to open the right cover [2]. F-7-57
6) Remove the process unit [1].
- 2 screws [2]
For taking in/out of the process unit, make sure to do with the duplexing unit
[3] open. [1] [2]
[1]
[2]
F-7-58
[3] [2]
F-7-55
7-40
Chapter 7
[1]
[1]
F-7-59
2) Press the claw [1] to detach the handle cover [2].
[1]
[1]
F-7-62
5) Turn the handle [1] by 180 deg, and then, hold the handle [1] and the grip
[2] to pull out the process unit [3] until it stops.
[2]
F-7-60
3) Press the release lever [1] to open the right cover [2].
For taking in/out of the process unit, make sure to do with the duplexing unit
[3] open.
[2]
[3] [1]
F-7-63
[1] 6) Press the push button [1], and hold the grip [2] to open the ITB unit [3]
upward.
[3] [2]
F-7-61
4) Remove the 2 screws [1].
7-41
Chapter 7
[4]
[7]
[1]
[2]
[5] [7] [5] [3] [7] [6] [4]
F-7-67
3) Remove the drum ITB motor [1].
- 4 screws [2]
[1]
[2]
F-7-65
8) Release the shutter [1] of the drum cartridge to remove the drum cartridge
[2].
F-7-68
1) Remove the upper rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Upper Rear
Cover]
2) Remove the lower rear cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Lower Rear
Cover]
3) Remove the all-night power supply PCB. (page 10-22)[Detaching the
All-Night Power Supply PCB]
1) Disconnect the 7 connectors on the optional power supply PCB [1] and the F-7-69
12 connectors on the controller power supply PCB [2]. 2) Remove the toner cartridge guide [1].
2) Remove the optional power supply/controller power supply mount [3]. - 6 screws [2]
7-42
Chapter 7
[1]
[2] [1]
F-7-73
F-7-70
2) Press the claw [1] downward to detach the handle cover [2].
3) Pull out the hopper supply unit [1].
- 4 screws [2]
[1]
[2] [2]
[1]
[2]
F-7-71
F-7-74
7.9.5 Developing Motor (Bk/Y/M/C) 3) Press the release lever [1] to open the right cover [2].
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 For taking in/out of the process unit, make sure to do with the duplexing unit
[3] open.
1) Remove the upper rear cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Upper Rear
Cover]
2) Remove the lower rear cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Lower Rear
Cover]
3) Remove the all-night power supply PCB. (page 10-22)[Detaching the
All-Night Power Supply PCB] [1]
4) Remove the printer power supply assembly. (page 10-18)[Detaching the
Printer Power Supply Assembly]
[2]
[1]
7-43
Chapter 7
Do not touch the ITB. If the ITB is scratched, it may cause the pickup fault
or degradation of the print quality.
In case the print quality is degraded due to touching the ITB, clean the ITB
with soft and dry cloth.
If the print quality is not improved, execute the following:
[Additional Functions] > [Adjustment/Cleaning] > [Cleaning inside Main
Unit] > [Start]
[1]
[1]
[2]
[1]
F-7-76
5) Turn the handle [1] by 180 deg, and hold the handle [1] and the grip [2] to
pull out the process unit [3] until it stops.
F-7-79
8) By pressing the ITB lock lever [1], remove the ITB unit [2] in the direction
of the arrow.
[1]
[1]
[2]
[3] [1]
F-7-77
6) Press the push button [1], and hold the grip [2] to open the ITB unit [3]
upward. [2]
F-7-80
7-44
Chapter 7
[2]
[1] [1]
F-7-84
5) Pick the tabs [2] of the both edges to remove the secondary transfer outer
roller [1].
[2] [2]
[2] [2]
F-7-81
[1]
F-7-85
In case the white spot image occurred after replacing the secondary transfer
roller, clean the ITB unit.
Initial settings / registration > adjustment / cleaning > cleaning within the
main body
F-7-83
4) Remove the shaft retainer [1].
- 1 screw [2]
7-45
Chapter 8 Pickup/Feeding System
Contents
Contents
8.1 Construction
The major specifications, controls, and functions of the pickup/feeding system are as follows:
T-8-1
Item Description -
Paper compartment front loading
Pickup method cassette separation retard
manual feeder separation pad
Paper reference center
Paper volume cassette 1/2 550 sheets (80 g/m2 )
manual feed tray 50 sheets (80 g/m2)
Paper size cassette 1 B4, A4, B5, LGL, LTR, EXE, A4R, B5R, LTRR, A5R. STMTR,
cassette 2 A3, B4, A4, B5, LGL, LTR, EXE, LDR, A4R, B5R, LTRR, A5R, STMTR, 11x17 to 12x18
manual feed tray A3, B4, A4, B5, LDR, LGL, LTR, A4R, B5R, LTRR, A5R, STMTR,11x17 to 12x18, EXE,
postcard, envelope, free size
Paper weight cassette 1/2 64 to 80 g/m2 (single-sided)
64 to 80 g/m2 (auto double-sided)
manual feed tray 64 to 128 g/m2 (if double-sided, manual feeding only; no auto duplexing)
Paper size switch-over cassette 1/2 by the user
manual feed tray by the user
Duplexing method through path
envelopes:
Com10, Monarch, DL, ISO-C5, ISO-B5
postcard: A6R non-default, A5R non-default, A4 non-default
Speed of process iR2880/2880F/2880i/2880G Normal speed: 337 mm/sec
Half speed: 143 mm/sec
Quater speed: 71.5 mm/sec
i3380/3380F/3380i/3380G Normal speed: 337 mm/sec
Half speed: 143 mm/sec
Quater speed: 71.5 mm/sec
Delivery accessory Inner 2-Way Tray-D1
Copy Tray-J1
Finisher-Z1
Buffer Path Unit-E2
Finisher-Y1
Saddle Finisher-Y2
Punch Unit-L1/M1/N1/P1
8-1
Chapter 8
F-8-1
[1] Pickup assembly (cassette 2)
[2] Pickup assembly (cassette 1)
[3] Manual feed pickup assembly
[4] Registration roller assembly
[5] Transfer assembly
[6] Duplexing/feeding assembly
[7] Fixing assembly
[8] No.1 delivery assembly
[9] No.2/No.3 delivery assembly
8-2
Chapter 8
[25]
[35]
[36] [24]
[23]
[22]
[21]
[20]
[19]
[18]
[17]
[16]
[15]
[14]
[13]
[12]
[11]
[10]
[9]
8-3
Chapter 8
[8]
[7]
[6]
[5]
[4]
[1]
[2]
[3]
F-8-3
[1] Pickup from cassette 1
[2] Pickup from cassette 2
[3] Pickup from cassette pedestal (option)
[4] Pickup from side paper deck (option)
[5] Pickup from manual feeder
[6] Delivery to copy tray 1
[7] Delivery to copy tray 2 (option)
[8] Delivery to copy tray 3 (option)
8-4
Chapter 8
[7]
[6]
[5]
[4]
[1]
[2]
[3]
F-8-4
[1] Pickup from cassette 1
[2] Pickup from cassette 2
[3] Pickup from cassette pedestal (option)
[4] Pickup from paper deck (option)
[5] Pickup from manual feeder
[6] Delivery to Finisher-Z1 (option)
[7] Delivery to copy tray 3 (option)
[7]
[6]
[5]
[4]
[1]
[2]
[3]
F-8-5
8-5
Chapter 8
[17]
[16]
[15]
[14]
[13]
[12]
[11]
[10]
[9]
[8]
[7]
[6]
8-6
Chapter 8
1. Main Body
M14
M7
M3
CL6
CL5 M6
M4
SL2
M5
SL3
F-8-7
M3 : Fixing motor
M4 : Cassette 1 pickup motor
M5 : Cassette 2 pickup motor
M6 : Registration Multi Motor
M7 : Duplexing motor
M14: No.1 delivery motor
SL2: Cassette 1 pickup solenoid
SL3: Cassette 2 pickup solenoid
CL5: Manual pickup clutch
CL6: Registration clutch
2. Delivery Assembly 2/3
M2A
SL2A SL3A
M1A
SL1A
F-8-8
M1A: No.2 delivery motor
M2A: No.3 delivery motor
SL1A: No.1 delivery solenoid
SL2A: No.2 delivery solenoid
SL3A: No.3 delivery solenoid
8-7
Chapter 8
Print Start
PRINT
*1 *3 *2
Cassette 1 pickup motor
(M4)
Cassette 1 pickup
solenoid (SL2)
Cassette 1 retry sensor
(PS25)
Registration Multi Motor
(M6)
Registration Front Sensor
(PS7)
Registration clutch
(CL2)
Fixing motor
(M3)
Inner Delivery Sensor
(PS1)
Delivery Motor 1
(M14)
Delivery Sensor 1
(PS27)
F-8-9
The machine increases the speed of moving paper over specific intervals. An overview and the associated accessories for the increase in speed are as follows:
1. Finisher-Z1 in Use
[2]
[1]
F-8-10
[1] Increase in Speed for Pickup
The speed is 1.5 times as high as the process speed (in the case of manual feed, decelerates to about 0.6).
[2] Increase in Speed for Reversal
8-8
Chapter 8
The speed is 2 times as high as the process speed (no increase if for delivery to tray 3).
2. Finisher-Y1/Y2 in Use
[2]
[1]
F-8-11
[1] Increase in Speed for Pickup
The speed is 1.5 times as high as the process speed (in the cassette of manual feed, decelerates to about 0.6).
[2] Increase in Speed for Reversal
The speed is 2 times as high as the process speed.
Media Types
T-8-2
Pickup
Print media Delivery Speed
Cassette/Side Deck Manual Feed
Plain paper 64-105 g/m2 YES YES Normal speed
Recycled paper 64-80 g/m2 YES YES Normal speed
Color paper 64-105 g/m2 YES YES Normal speed
Punched paper 64-105 g/m2 YES YES Normal speed
Heavy paper 1 106-163 g/m2 YES YES Half speed
OHT YES YES*1 Quarter speed
Heavy paper 2 170-220 g/m2 - YES Half speed
Coated paper 106-163 g/m2 - YES Half speed
Tracing paper - YES Normal speed
Label - YES Half speed
Envelop - YES Half speed
Postcard - YES Half speed
*1: Half speed from tray to registration roller.
Resolution
T-8-3
8.3.3 Feeding Speed of Each Feeding Path and Timing for Switching Feeding Speed
0014-5566
Acceleration and starting point of acceleration according to each delivery outlet and materials and sizes are as follow:
The following 5 points are the points at which the feeding speed is changed (points to change the speed control).
(1) 10 mm downstream from the fixing rear roller.
(2) 10 mm downstream from the inner delivery roller.
(3) Reversing sensor ON
8-9
Chapter 8
8-10
Chapter 8
T-8-5
This machine executes fixing arch control (details will be explained later at fixing control). In the case of executing reversing of the large size paper, after the paper
leading edge turns on the reversing sensor [2], the paper trailing edge is pulled by fixing, resulting in failure to correctly measure time until the paper stops at the
reversing point.
So, the following controls are performed for reversing the large size paper.
When the paper leading edge turns on the reversing sensor [2], and if the trailing edge point, which is calculated from the paper size, does not pass over the secondary
transfer roller [5] [6] (in the case of executing arch control of fixing), drop the speed of the delivery-2/-3 motors to 135mm/s. Because 135mm/s is the lower speed
for fixing arch control, the paper will not be pulled from the point of the fixing to the reversing. When the trailing edge passes over the secondary transfer roller [5]
[6], the fixing arch control is completed. And then, the fixing speed is returned to 143mm/s, so as the speed of the delivery-2/-3 motors.
Afterwards, the paper feeding speed accelerates to 460mm/s when the trailing edge is at the point of +10mm from the fixing rear roller [4], and starts to decelerate
at the point of 43.8mm from the reversing roller [1] (30mm from the reversing roller = reversing point [3], the distance from when the delivery-3 motor starts at
460mm/s until it completely stops = 13.8mm) to let it stop at the reversing point.
The followings show the timing for reversing accelerating control according to the paper size (after turning on the reversing sensor until the delivery-3 motor is
stopped).
8-11
Chapter 8
[4]
[6]
[5]
F-8-12
[1] reversing roller
[2] reversing sensor
[3] reversing point
[4] fixing rear roller
[5] Secondary transfer outside roller
[6] Secondary transfer inside roller
8.4.1.1 Delay Jam for Those Other Than the Pickup Unit
0014-0307
Start key ON
or PRINT set
INTR / PRINT
[1] [1]
Sensor N-1
Jam check
Normal Error
Sensor N
Sensor
Pre-registration sensor (PS7)
Inside delivery sensor (PS1)
No. 1 delivery sensor (PS27)
Duplexing paper sensor (PS10)
Fixing inlet sensor (PS14)
No. 2 Delivery sensor (PS1A)
Reversing sensor (PS4A)
No. 3 Delivery sensor (PS5A)
8-12
Chapter 8
The leading edge of paper does not reach the sensor after the cassette 1/2 pickup motor has started to rotate.
Or, in the case that the paper leading edge does not reach to the sensor within specified time after turning on the manual feeder pickup clutch
Start key ON
or PRINT set
INTR / PRINT
Jam check
Normal Error
Sensor N
Start key ON
or PRINT set
INTR / PRINT
L+A L+A
Jam Check
Normal Error
Sensor N
Sensor
Cassette 1 retry sensor (PS25)
Cassette 2 retry sensor (PS26)
Pre-registration sensor (PS7)
Inside delivery sensor (PS1)
No. 1 delivery sensor (PS27)
Duplex paper sensor (PS10)
The machine makes a check to see that there is no paper over the following sensors before it starts initial multiple rotation at power-on:
Sensor
Cassette 1 retry sensor (PS25)
Cassette 2 retry sensor (PS26)
Pre-registration sensor (PS7)
Inside delivery sensor (PS1)
No. 1 delivery sensor (PS27)
Duplex paper sensor (PS10)
8-13
Chapter 8
Sensor
Pre-registration sensor (PS7)
In the case that the transparency sensor detects paper that is different from the specified.
Sensor
Transparency sensor PCB (UN18, UN19)
A door open jam is identified when the machine detects the opening of the door while it is making copies/prints.
Sensor
Front cover open sensor (PS17)
Right cover open sensor (PS19)
8.5.1 Overview
0014-0313
[7]
[8]
[10] [9]
F-8-16
[1] Cassette paper sensor
[2] Pickup roller
[3] Feed roller
[4] Separation roller
[5] Pickup vertical path roller
[6] Cassette retry paper sensor
[7] Vertical path guide
[8] Lower right cover
[9] Holding plate
[10] Lifter plate
8-14
Chapter 8
Print Start
PRINT
*1 *3 *2
Cassette 1 pickup motor
(M4)
Cassette 1 pickup
solenoid (SL2)
Cassette 1 retry sensor
(PS25)
Registration Multi Motor
(M6)
Registration Front Sensor
(PS7)
Registration clutch
(CL2)
Fixing motor
(M3)
Inner Delivery Sensor
(PS1)
Delivery Motor 1
(M14)
Delivery Sensor 1
(PS27)
F-8-17
The size of paper inside the cassette is detected by the cassette size dial, and is communicated to the cassette size detection PCB.
As may as 15 positions may be detected with reference to the combinations of on and off states of the array of 4 actuators mounted to the cassette size detection
PCB on the printer side and operating in conjunction with the cassette size dial.
In the absence of a cassette, all 4 actuators are off, causing the machine to assume there is no cassette.
1. Size switch of AB configuration/Inch configuration
The cassette size dial is equipped with a switch operated to change between AB and Inch configurations; the cassette size detecting switch will detect the configu-
ration as soon as a cassette is fitted in the machine.
[2]
[1]
INCH SW4
SW3
[3]
SW2
SW1
SW0
SW4-ON=INCH
F-8-18
[1] AB/Inch switch
[2] Cassette size dial
[3] Cassette size detection PCB
8-15
Chapter 8
T-8-6
The following are default sizes the machine will assume when U1 through U4 are detected:
T-8-8
8-16
Chapter 8
A-FLS
G-LTR
G-LGL
A-LTR (LTR)
A-LTRR (LTRR)
Service mode:
COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-U1
COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-U2
COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-U3
COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-U4
The level of paper inside the cassette is checked using the following sensors:
T-8-9
Cassette 1 Cassette 2
Paper level sensor A PS21 PS23
Paper level sensor B PS22 PS24
Paper sensor PS8 PS20
[2]
[3]
[1]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
F-8-19
[1] Flag
[2] Cassette paper sensor
[3] Lifter clutch
[4] Cassette paper level sensor A
[5] Cassette paper level sensor B
[6] Paper level sensor flag
[7] Lifter gear
[8] Tray
8-17
Chapter 8
OFF OFF
When half full with paper
Cassette paper Cassette paper Paper
level sensor B level sensor A
OFF ON
When there is little paper
Cassette paper Paper
Cassette paper
level sensor B level sensor A
F-8-20
T-8-10
Paper level sensor A Paper level sensor B Paper sensor Paper level Control panel indication
8.6.1 Overview
0014-0319
The machine executes the manual feeder pickup by carrying down the driving from the registration multi motor (M6) to the manual feeder pickup roller with con-
necting the manual feeder pickup clutch (CL5).
The mechanisms of the manual feeder pickup assembly and the manual feed tray are shown in the following figures.
8-18
Chapter 8
[8]
[1]
SL4
MLT_SL_ON
M6
DC Driver DC-CON
F-8-22
[1] Lifting plate
8-19
Chapter 8
Reference:
The sensor that detects the last paper is not equipped with the manual feeder pickup unit of this machine.
The multi-pickup roller starts to rotate when the manual pickup clutch (CL5) goes on to start upper separation to pick up a single sheet of paper. When the leading
edge of the sheet reaches the pre-registration sensor (PS7) and is moved a specific distance, the manual pickup clutch goes off, causing the sheet to arch in the
registration roller area.
When the registration clutch (CL6) goes on, the manual feed pickup clutch (CL5) once again goes on to pick up paper. The manual feed pickup clutch (CL5) goes
off immediately before the trailing edge of paper moves past the manual feed pickup roller; thereafter, the registration roller serves to pull off the paper.
Print start
PRINT LSTR
Registration multi
pickup motor (M6)
Multi lifting plate up/
down solenoid (SL4)
Manual feed pickup
clutch(CL5)
Registration
clutch (CL6)
Pre-registration
sensor (PS7)
F-8-23
The width of paper is detected with reference to the output of the variable resistor (SVR1), which operates in conjunction with the movement of the side guide.
The side guide in the manual feed tray is set when the user moves it to place paper in the cassette.
[2]
[1] [3]
[4]
[6]
[5]
F-8-24
[1] Side guide (rear)
[2] Stop arm
[3] Center gear
[4] Side guide (front)
[5] Variable resistor (SVR1)
[6] Manual feed tray
Calculate the paper width from the A/D converted value of the manual feed volume.
Register the A/D converted values of 3 points (paper width of A4, A4R, and A6R) that are the reference values to the backup RAM beforehand. (Execute the setup
in the service mode.)
Service Modes:
- Register the reference points
COPIER > FUNCTION > CST > MF-A4R
COPIER > FUNCTION > CST > MF-A6R
COPIER > FUNCTION > CST > MF-A4
8-20
Chapter 8
8.7.1 Overview
0014-0324
The registration roller is driven with the registration multi motor (M6).
The registration clutch (CL6) is located between the registration roller and the registration multi motor, and it controls ON/OFF of the registration roller in order to
match a paper and an image on the drum at the predetermined registration point.
DC controller PCB
J314
Registration clutch drive signal
M6
CL6
F-8-25
In this machine, it is controlled to turn OFF the pickup motor (in case of cassette pickup), manual feeder pickup clutch (in case of manual feeder pickup), and the
duplexing feeding motor (in case of duplexing re-pickup) to make papers stop at the point where the distance from the pre-registration sensor to the registration
roller (19.9 mm) + predetermined registration arching (cassette/duplexing: 3 mm, manual feed: 5.5 mm) are added after the pre-registration sensor detects the lead-
ing edge.
When executing the accelerated pickup (300 mm/sec), decelerate to 200 mm/sec when the pre-registration sensor turns ON.
When the registration clutch turns ON, the registration roller starts to rotate and feeds paper to the secondary transfer assembly.
The registration clutch is turned OFF either after a paper is fed the predetermined amount (paper length + 50ms) or when the next paper turns ON the pre-registration
sensor.
The machine does not have the horizontal registration adjustment function by the horizontal registration detection at the time of duplexing feeding.
However, practically, adjustment of the horizontal registration point is possible by adjusting the write start timing of the horizontal scanning of the laser (horizontal
scanning interval signal) in terms of software in the service mode setting.
In the service mode, set the horizontal registration adjustment value for each source of paper. The range of adjustment value is +/-2.5 mm. In case of duplexing re-
pickup, the write start timing of the horizontal scanning of the laser is corrected in accordance with the horizontal registration adjustment value of the source of
paper.
Service Mode:
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ>ADJ-REFE
Use it to adjust the horizontal registration for the 2nd side of small-size double-sided prints.
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ>ADJ-RE-L
Use it to adjust the horizontal registration for the 2nd side of large-size double-sided prints.
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ>LOOPREFE
Use it to adjust the degree of arching for the 2nd side of double-sided prints.
The term "2nd side of a double-sided print" as used in relation to the machine's service mode refers to the side that receives an image second in order; in other words,
it corresponds to the 1st side of the original.
Reference:
Small paper: a paper whose length of paper feeding direction is LTR (216 mm) or shorter, e.g., A4 and B5.
Large paper: a paper whose length of paper feeding direction is longer than LTR (261 mm), e.g., A3, A4R, and B5R.
8-21
Chapter 8
The machine determines the following cases as the material difference jam, and stop its operation.
- In case the material is non-transparency when transparency is set.
- In case the material is transparency when material other than transparency is set.
In this machine, one transparency sensor is used for material difference detection. The transparency sensor is allocated at the almost same position of the pre-reg-
istration sensor (a point where 21.5 mm upstream from the registration roller) on the feeding path. (In addition, the pre-registration sensor is allocated at the point
where 19.9 mm upstream from the registration roller.) The transparency sensor is comprised of 2 PCBs of LED; the light emission area (UN18) and the light re-
ception area (UN19).
In this machine, the material difference is detected according to the transmittance of material being fed. The transmittance of material is calculated according to the
sensor output (reference value A) under the condition that no shielding material presents at the transparency sensor, and the sensor output (measured value B) under
the condition that a fed material presents.
The prism facing to the transparency sensor is allocated at the right door side. Because the detected voltage changes by opening/closing the right door, the reference
value must be measured after opening/closing it. Measurement method of the reference value is as follow:
1) Turn ON the LED of transparency sensor, and read the sensor output 3 times with constant interval (every 16 ms).
2) Among the read values, save the smallest value as the reference value A (the 3 read values fall somewhere into the predetermined range).
3) Turn OFF the LED and finish the measurement.
If the result of the step 4 indicates that the material is non-transparency while transparency is set and vice versa, the machine considers as a jam due to the material
difference, and stops the machine. (Jam code: 0D93)
Reference:
The detection is not designed to protect a transparency for CLC (a transparency with a white mark on the leading edge) from being fixed in order to avoid the
occurrence of symptoms that cause damage on the fixing assembly or error codes when it is used.
In this machine, a transparency for CLC might be wrapped around the fixing assembly when using it, and it causes the fixing inside delivery delay jam (0107 jam).
When the fixing motor is stopped because of a jam detection processing, a transparency is not completely wrapped around the fixing roller. By executing the jam
processing from the upstream of feeding as a jam processing flow, it prevents the sheet to be wrapped around the fixing assembly. Therefore, the control detecting
a transparency for CLC and stopping print is not executed.
2. Control Mechanism
The sensors and motors regarding the fixing arch control are shown as below.
PS16 M3 FUSE_M_XA
PS2 FUSE_M_A
FUSE_M_B
FUSE_M_XB
LOOP_SNS
DC Driver DCON
LOOP2_SNS
F-8-26
8-22
Chapter 8
3. Control Sequence
The sequence of arch control is shown as below.
a. Starting arch monitoring
Start arch monitoring from the point where the leading edge of paper enters fixing (the point of reaching the fixing nip).
PS16 PS2
F-8-27
Reference:
This machine has two different sensors to detect large and small arch respectively to prevent noise and faulty image.
If there is large arch when a paper passes through the secondary transfer roller, the paper with large arch will straighten and noise occurs. If a paper hits somewhere,
faulty image (including soiled paper edge, etc) may occur.
To prevent this symptom, make the arch level of a paper smaller before passing through the secondary transfer roller so that the paper passes through the secondary
transfer roller without a large arch.
At the point where the leading edge of At the point where the
paper reaches the fixing nip trailing edge of paper
has passed the secondary
During arch control transfer roller
8-23
Chapter 8
8.9.1 Overview
0014-0327
At both-sided print in this machine, a paper is reversed at the reversal slot of the delivery assembly outside the machine, returned and re-picked up through the
duplexing feed assembly to the registration roller assembly.
In reversing, keep the trailing edge of paper at 30mm upstream from the reversing roller [1], and stop temporarily with the remained portion delivered outside the
machine from the reversal slot. After that, rotate the reversing roller reversely and return the paper, feed it through the duplexing inlet roller [4] to the duplexing
feed assembly. The delivery motor 3 activates the reversing roller and the duplexing inlet roller.
The duplexing feed assembly has two sets of duplexing feed roller [5] [7]. These rollers feed papers to the registration roller assembly. Duplexing motor activates
the duplexing feed roller.
[1] [2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[7]
F-8-29
[1] Reversing roller
[2] Reversal sensor (PS4A)
[3] Duplexing inlet sensor (PS3A)
[4] Duplexing inlet roller
[5] Duplexing feeding roller 1
[6] Duplexing feed sensor (PS10)
[7] Duplexing feeding roller 2
There are following restrictions regarding duplexing feeding for this machine.
- Duplexing feeding is possible only for plain paper. Heavy paper (105 g or more) is out of specification (since reversing feeding is not assured).
- Sizes available for duplexing feeding are B5 (vertical scanning; 182 mm) to 12X18 (vertical scanning; 457 mm)
- Output of papers of 450mm or more SRA3 and 12X18 to the delivery 3 is out of specification (since it is impossible to stack them on the tray of the delivery 3).
The number of sheets circulating in the passing at duplexing feeding varies due to the delivery position and the paper size.
When outputting to the delivery 1 and 2, the number of circulating papers of small size (smaller than A3) and large size (A3 or more) is 3.
When outputting to the delivery 3, the number of circulating is 3 for small size (smaller than A3) and 1 for large size (A3 or larger).
This is because the reversing roller and the delivery roller 3 has the same drive source (the delivery motor 3) and two sheets of A3 or larger size cannot be delivered
simultaneously in the reversing and re-pickup directions.
The following are the number of circulating papers at duplexing feeding according to the delivery position and the paper size.
T-8-12
Delivery 1 / 2 Delivery 3
Small size (smaller than A3) 3 3
8-24
Chapter 8
The timing of duplexing pickup is determined with registration clutch ON of the previous paper as trigger, as in the case of the pickup control of cassette pickup.
When specified interval (cassette holder, time due to the size) passed after registration clutch ON for the previous paper, the timing of re-pickup is generated and
re-pickup is started.
A4/LTR
1-2 2-2 1-1 3-2 2-1 4-2 3-1 5-2 4-1 5-1
5 sheets
A4/LTR
1-2 2-2 1-1 3-2 2-1 4-2 3-1 5-2 4-1 6-2 5-1 6-1
6 sheets
A3/LDR
1-2 2-2 1-1 3-2 2-1 3-1
3 sheets
1-1
1-2
F-8-30
However, in the case of delivery to tray 3 (outside), the machine uses single-sheet circulation.
- Configuration with an Accessory Installed
5 sheets 1-2 1-1 2-2 2-1 3-2 3-1 4-2 4-1 5-2 5-1
F-8-31
8-25
Chapter 8
F-8-32
The 1st sheet is picked up.
F-8-33
An image is formed for the 2nd side of the 1st sheet. The 2nd sheet is picked up.
F-8-34
The 1st sheet is turned over, and is moved for duplexing registration. An image is formed for the 2nd side of the 2nd sheet.
8-26
Chapter 8
F-8-35
The 1st sheet is moved for registration once again. The 2nd sheet is turned over and moved for duplexing registration. The 3rd sheet is picked up.
1
1
F-8-36
An image is formed for the 1st side of the 1st sheet and the 2nd side of the 3rd sheet. The 2nd sheet is moved for duplexing.
1 3
F-8-37
The 1st sheet is delivered. The 3rd sheet is turned over and is moved for duplexing registration. The 2nd sheet is moved for registration once again. The 4th sheet
is picked up.
8-27
Chapter 8
1
2
F-8-38
An image is formed for the 1st side of the 2nd sheet and for the 2nd side of the 4th sheet. The 3rd sheet is moved for duplexing.
2 4
F-8-39
The 2nd sheet is delivered. The 4th sheet is turned over, and is moved for duplexing registration. The 3rd sheet is moved for registration once again. The 5th sheet
is picked up.
2 1
3
F-8-40
An image is formed for the 1st side of the 3rd sheet and for the 2nd side of the 5th sheet. The 5th sheet is moved for duplexing.
8-28
Chapter 8
3 5
2 1
F-8-41
The 3rd sheet is delivered. The 5th sheet is turned over, and is moved for duplexing registration. The 4th sheet is moved for registration once again.
3
2 1
5
4
F-8-42
An image is formed for the 1st side of the 4th sheet. The 5th sheet is moved for duplexing.
4
3
2 1
F-8-43
The 4th sheet is delivered. The 5th sheet is moved for registration once again.
8-29
Chapter 8
4
3
2 1
F-8-44
An image is formed for the 1st side of the 5th sheet.
5
4
3
2 1
F-8-45
The 5th sheet is delivered.
8.10 Delivery
There are some delivery accessories available for this machine: the 2 / 3 delivery units, the finisher Z1 and the saddle finisher Y2. For the purpose of improving the
productivity, the 2 / 3 delivery units are connected to the main body as the standard equipments. Also, when mounting the finisher Y1or the saddle finisher Y2,
buffer path unit must be mounted.
When media is delivered to the delivery outlet 1 and 2, the feeding speed is accelerated at the point of inner delivery roller + 10mm. When the processing speed is
constant, the feeding speed is accelerated to 460mm/s. Due to the drive configuration of the delivery motor 2 and 3, when the motor is rotating at 1/2 speed or slower,
feeding speed cannot be accelerated to 1/2 speed or faster. For this reason, the feeding speed is not accelerated when the processing speed is 1/2 speed. When the
processing speed is 1/4, the feeding speed is accelerated to 1/2 speed (71.5 mm/s). When the feeding speed of the media is accelerated to 460 mm/s and the media
is delivered from the delivery outlet 2, for the purpose of keeping consistency in its speed, the feeding speed is decelerated so that the feeding speed returns to
constant speed when the trailing edge (5mm) reaches the fixing rear roller.
When the media is delivered to the delivery outlet 3, the media stops temporarily after acceleration at the reversal slot, and then is fed to the delivery outlet 3 at
460mm/s. In this case as well, for the purpose of keeping consistency in its speed, the feeding speed is decelerated so that the feeding speed returns to constant speed
when the trailing edge (5mm) reaches the fixing rear roller.
In this machine, the delivery method is FD (face-down) delivery only in delivery 1 through 3. There is no so-called "reversal delivery mechanism" in which switch-
over of FU (face-up) / FD (face-down) is available.
8-30
Chapter 8
In delivery to the finisher Z1, the activation of the delivery sensor 2 is the trigger of the delivery notice to the finisher Z1.
The points of acceleration differ by the processing speed as the feeding speed of the media cannot be accelerated to 1/2 speed or faster when the motor is rotating
at 1/2 speed or slower due to the drive configuration of the delivery motor 1.
Also, in the case of delivery to the saddle, media is delivered without acceleration although the processing speed is constant as the media is delivered at the constant
speed (143mm/s) due to the constraint of saddle processing. When the processing speed is 1/2 speed, the media speed is accelerated to the constant speed (143mm/
s) as well as in the case of delivery to the tray, and delivered to the saddle afterwards.
In delivery to the finisher Y1 / saddle finisher Y2, the activation of the buffer outlet sensor is the trigger of the delivery notice to the finisher Y1 / saddle finisher Y2.
In this model, when selecting the delivery tray A/B/C in user mode, the output point changes according to the type of accessory.
T-8-14
8-31
Chapter 8
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
F-8-48
8.11.1.2 Removing the Cassette Pickup Unit 1
0014-0665 8.11.3 Sensor Mounting Plate
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
2) Disconnect the connector [1], and free harness from the 2 wire saddles [2] / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
and the clamps [3].
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 2]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 1]
F-8-49
pickup unit 1
F-8-47
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
8-32
Chapter 8
[1] [2]
F-8-54
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
8.11.4.1 Removing the Pickup Roller Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
0014-2606
[1]
[1] [2]
F-8-52
[3]
[1]
F-8-56
F-8-53 3) Remove the power supply cord base [1].
-5 screws [2]
8.11.6 Separation Roller
8-33
Chapter 8
[2]
[1]
[3]
[3]
[4]
[2] [1]
F-8-61
3) Remove the power supply cord base [1].
[1] -5 screws [2]
[4]
F-8-58
5) Remove the cassette pickup motor 1 [1].
-2 screws [2] [2]
[1] [2]
F-8-62
4) Remove the pickup motor base [1].
-2 connectors [2]
-1 screw [3]
-5 screws [4]
[4]
[2]
F-8-59 [3]
8-34
Chapter 8
F-8-67
5) Detach the cover [1] from the cassette size sensor mount.
F-8-64
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 2]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
F-8-68
Pickup Unit 1]
6) Remove the sensor [1] from the cassette size sensor mount.
8.11.9.2 Removing Cassette Size Sensor
0014-0694
F-8-69
2) Disconnect 2 connectors [1] [2] from the cassette size PCB. / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
3) Free the harness from the cable clamps [3] [4].
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 2]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 1]
6) Remove the sensor mounting plate. (page 8-32)[Removing the Sensor
Mounting Plate]
F-8-66
4) Remove the cassette size sensor mount [1].
- 2 screws [1]
8-35
Chapter 8
F-8-70
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover] 1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover] 2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette 3) Remove the manual feed unit. (page 8-38)[Removing Manual Feed
Pickup Unit 2] Unit]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette 4) Remove the manual feed tray unit. (page 8-38)[Removing Manual Feed
Pickup Unit 1] Tray Unit]
6) Remove the sensor mounting plate. (page 8-32)[Removing the Sensor
Mounting Plate] 8.11.13.2 Removing Slide Resistor
0014-1178
F-8-71
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 2]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 1]
6) Remove the sensor mounting plate. (page 8-32)[Removing the Sensor
Mounting Plate]
8-36
Chapter 8
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 2]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 1]
F-8-77
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
Cover]
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover] [3]
2) Detach the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover] [3]
3) Detach the right lower cover. (page 10-12)[Detaching the Right Lower
Cover]
4) Remove the cassette pickup unit 2. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette
Pickup Unit 2] [2]
5) Remove the cassette pickup unit 1. (page 8-32)[Removing the Cassette [1]
Pickup Unit 1]
[1]
F-8-76 F-8-79
2) Remove the cassette size sensor PCB [1].
- 3 connectors [2] 8.11.17 Manual Feed Tray Unit
- 2 clamps [3]
8.11.17.1 Before Removing Manual Feed Tray Unit
0014-1174
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Remove the manual feed unit. (page 8-38)[Removing Manual Feed
Unit]
8-37
Chapter 8
1) Disconnect the connector [1] and remove the edge saddle [2].
[3]
[1]
F-8-84
F-8-81
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
[1]
8.11.18.2 Removing Manual Feed Unit
0014-1173
[3]
F-8-85
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Remove the manual feed unit. (page 8-38)[Removing Manual Feed
Unit]
[1] [2]
8.11.19.2 Removing Manual Feed Pickup Roller
F-8-82 0014-1263
8-38
Chapter 8
[1] [2]
F-8-90
[1]
8.11.20 Manual Feed Separation Pad
F-8-86
2) Remove the plate [1]. 8.11.20.1 Before Removing Manual Feed Separation Pad
- 1 screw [2] 0014-1268
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
3) Remove the manual feed unit. (page 8-38)[Removing Manual Feed
Unit]
4) Remove the manual feed pickup roller. (page 8-38)[Removing Manual
Feed Pickup Roller]
[2] [1]
F-8-87
3) Remove the bush [1].
F-8-91
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
[1] Cover]
F-8-88
8.11.21.2 Removing Registration Motor
4) Detach the manual feed tray upper cover [1]. 0014-2624
F-8-89
5) Remove the plastic E-ring [1]; then, remove the manual feed pickup roller
[2] from the shaft.
When removing the manual feed pickup roller, be careful not to drop the
dowel pin.
8-39
Chapter 8
[1]
F-8-92
2) Disconnect 7 connectors from the Accessories power supply PCB [1].
F-8-95
3) Disconnect 12 connectors from the controller power supply PCB [2].
4) Remove the Accessories power supply/controller power supply mount
[3]. 8.11.23 Duplex Feed Sensor
- 9 cable clamps [4]
- 3 edge saddles [5] 8.11.23.1 Before Removing Duplexing Feed Sensor
- 1 connector [6] 0014-1271
[7] [1] [4] [2] 1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
[2]
F-8-96
2) Remove the duplexing feed sensor [1].
- 1 connector [2]
[1]
[2]
F-8-94
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover] F-8-97
2) Remove the right cover. (page 10-32)[Removing the Right Cover]
8-40
Chapter 9 Fixing System
Contents
Contents
9.1 Construction
The major specifications, controls, and functions of the fixing system are as follows:
T-9-1
item function/method
Fixing method on-demand fixing
Fixing heater Heater (H1 and H2) (Inside the fixing film unit)
Control temperature 220 deg C (normal speed, normal temperature, plain paper)
Fixing drive control ON/OFF control, constant speed rotation control
Fixing temperature detection fixing film unit
- fixing main thermistor (contact)
- fixing sub thermistor 1 (contact)
- fixing sub thermistor 2 (contact)
Protection function execute the following error detection to block the power to the fixing heater in the case of error.
- thermistor (TH1/TH2/TH3) temperature detection
- fixing thermo switch (TP1)
operating temperature 270 deg C
T-9-2
TH1
M3
TP1
TH3
TH2
H2
H1
pressure roller
F-9-1
9-1
Chapter 9
M15
FM6
PS29
PS28
FM7
F-9-2
VINJDG
J218-1 4
J2110E-7 J214-2
J225B-1
J223-6
J223-2
J223-4
J2110E-8 ZX J214-1
FUSE_M_A/B/XA/XB
DUPLEX_M_A/XA/B/XB
SUB_THRM2
MAIN_THRM
SUB_THRM1
3 2 1
J1001
TH1
TH2 TH3
M7
TP1
M3
F-9-3
9.2.1.1 Overview
0014-5556
Temperature control of the fixing heater is done by using the main thermistor, which is in contact with the centre part of the heater, to detect temperature. Sub-
thermistors 1 and 2, which contact the ends of the film, are there to detect temperature rises at the ends of the fixing film, which happen when small size paper (A4R,
etc.) is being fed continuously.
The purpose of this function is to reduce the time required for the first print by pre-heating the fixing unit in standby, according to prescribed conditions.
9-2
Chapter 9
Reference:
Specifically, flying start is initiated with the following timings.
- With the control panel Copy/ Copy (quick) screen displayed, one of the control panel soft keys is touched, one of the numeric keys is pressed, or a cassette is
opened/ closed.
- Common to all function tabs on the control panel, a control panel tab toggle button (soft key) is pressed.
- In some other mode, the device recovers from sleep1 or sleep2.
Fixing temperature
5 sec 15 sec
FlyingStart
F-9-4
service modes:
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>FX-ASTBY
Standby temperature control ON/OFF 0: OFF (default) 1: ON
To increase the time till 1st sheet print, set to [1].
Temperature control during printing regulates temperature from the beginning of the print cycle and until completion. The temperature of the target changes de-
pending on the material kind and the elapsed time and the number of sheets from the print beginning.
Thermistor
reading [deg C]
Time [ t ]
F-9-5
9-3
Chapter 9
T-9-3
iRC2880
process option
>specific fixing mode
>mode 2
Half speed plain paper (64 to 105 g/m2) plain paper 190 to 165/200 to 175
thin paper (less than 64 g/m2) plain paper L 180 to 155/190 to 165
rough paper *1 heavy paper 1 205 to 185/215 to 195
rough paper (strong) *2 heavy paper 2 220 to 200/225 to 205
special fixing mode 2 *3 iRC3380 200 to 175/205 to 180
special printing process
>plain paper
>mode 2
iRC2880
process position
>special fixing mode
>mode 2
1/4 Speed OHT OHT 175 to 150/185 to 165
*1 heavy paper: heavy paper (106 to 169 g/m2), bond paper (64 to 105 g/m2), coated paper (106 to 169 g/m2), label
*2 heavy paper(strong): extra heavy paper (170 to 220 g/m2), extra heavy coated paper (170 to 220 g/m2), postcard, 2-pane card, 4-pane card, envelope
*3 For details of special fixing mode 2 settings, see user's guide.
Service Mode:
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > P-CGH-TM
Default: 0
Resets the temperature at which job is restarted and the amount of time required before the restart when the paper size is changed to larger sizes (A4R or wider)
during down-sequence control.
T-9-4
Entry -2 -1 0 1 2
Temperature at Return 125 138 150 175 200
Time Before Return 90 90 30 30 30
Enter a greater entry if reducing the downtime during paper size switchover is desired. Enter a smaller entry to prevent hot offset immediately after the switchover.
Open/close positions of the shutter is detected by the fan shutter HP sensor (PS28) and fan shutter position sensor (PS29). When sub-thermistor 1 (TH2) detects
temperature listed below, fan shutter motor (M15) is rotated until the fan shutter HP sensor detects the shutter. And then, positive rotation of the fan shutter motor
(M15) is initiated and the shutter is moved to a position corresponds to the paper size chosen. The fan shutter motor is reversely rotated in the last-rotation period,
and the shutter is returned to the home position. If paper size is changed during continuous printing, the shutter is returned to its home position first and then the
shutter is moved to a position corresponds to the paper size chosen.
9-4
Chapter 9
M15
FM6
PS29
PS28
FM7
direction of movement
Shutter Light-Blocking Plate
PS28 PS29
M15
F-9-6
MEMO:
The shutter can be opened/closed during printing. This does not intervene the printing.
The rate at which the shutter opens/closes is about 50mm / sec, and it takes about 1.15 seconds for the shutter to travel the maximum distance (between home position
and LTR position).
Below is a table showing the temperature rages at which the shutter fan will be turned ON.
- At ambient temperature and humidity (at full speed)
T-9-5
9-5
Chapter 9
T-9-6
9-6
Chapter 9
When the temperature reading of the sub-thermistor 1 has dropped by 3 degrees C since the fan was turned on, the fan will be stopped.
In the case of continuous printing on smaller size paper (A4R or smaller), the down-sequence control will be activated decreasing print speed instead of turning on
the fan shutter in order to regulate the temperature of the fixing film edge.
Error code:
E840-0000: Fan Shutter Error
This machine observes the output of thermistor connection signal (FUSER CNCTX) when walm-up rotating after power supply ON and after the door opens and
closes, and is judging the presence of the fixing unit.
When it is judged that there is no fixing unit, the DC controller stops the start-up operation of this machine.
The following messages are displayed at the same time.
"Prepare a new fixing roller. Call service representative."
T-9-9
Result
Source of reference
fixing assembly absent fixing assembly present
thermistor connection signal (FUSER CNCTX) H (connected) L (open)
9-7
Chapter 9
This equipment runs down-sequence control in the cases listed below. Down-sequence control decreases the print speed by lengthening the interval between sheets
in order to prevent film deterioration caused by heated edge of the fixing film during continuous printing of small-sized (smaller than A4R) paper.
- When the sub-thermistor 1 temperature reading exceeds the readings listed below
- When the sub-thermistor 2 temperature reading exceeds 220 degrees C
Also in the case of uncertain paper size (e.g., by manual feeding or unspecified paper size) it executes the down sequence control as well as in the case of printing
small sized papers.
The following table indicates the down sequences in accordance with the paper type).
T-9-10
Sub-Thermistor 1
Temperature (Reading at
Ambient Temperature
Process speed Paper type User setting Printing speed (ppm)
and Humidity / Low
Temperature and
Humidity)
Normal speed plain paper plain paper
220/225
(64 to 105 g/m2)
thin paper plain paper L
210/215
(less than 64 g/m2)
special fixing mode 2 *3 LBP3380
special printing process
>plain paper 30 to 4
>mode 2
235/240
LBP2880
process option
>special fixing mode
>mode 2
half-speed plain paper plain paper
190/200
(64 to 105 g/m2)
thin paper plain paper L
180/190
(less than 64 g/m2)
rough paper *1 heavy paper 1 205/215
rough paper (strong) *2 heavy paper 2 220/225
special fixing mode 2 *3 LBP3380 15 to 2
special printing process
>plain paper
>mode 2
200/205
LBP2880
processing option
>special fixing mode
>mode 2
1/4 Speed OHT OHT 180/185 7 to 2
*1 rough paper: heavy paper (106 to 169 g/m2), bond paper (64 to 105 g/m2), coated paper (106 to 169 g/m2), label paper.
*2 extra heavy paper (170 to 220 g/m2), extra heavy coated paper (170 to 20 g/m2), Jpn postcard, 2-pane Jpn postcard, 4-pane Japan postcard, envelope.
*3 For settings and details of special fixing mode 2, see the User's Guide.
In the case of continuous print of the small size paper (the width less than A4R), it executes fixing film edge cooling control to prevent film deterioration caused
by heating of the fixing film edge, as opposed to the down sequence.
This machine does the control to make pressuring/releasing the fixing film unit to prevent the fixing film being transformed.
Pressuring/releasing of fixing film unit are regulated by pressure plate [1] and releasing lever [2]. Pressure plate [1] pushes fixing film unit [4] by a spring to press
it to pressure roller [5]. Release lever [2] is rotated by fixing motor (M3), pushes pressure plate [1] down to release fixing film unit [4] from pressure roller [5].
pressuring operation
Fixing motor (M3) rotates in a positive direction. The pressure plate [1] puts down the fixing film unit by the power of the spring and presses to the pressure roller
[5].
releasing operation
Fixing motor (M3) reverses, pressure release lever 2 [2] pushes up the pressure plate [2] so that the fixing film unit [4] releases from the pressure roller [5].
9-8
Chapter 9
[5]
[4] [4]
M3 [2] M3
[3] [3]
[5] [5]
Pressed Released
F-9-7
[1] Pressure plate
[2] Release lever
[3] Sensor flag
[4] Fixing film unit
[5] Pressure roller
PS13: Fixing pressure releasing home position sensor
M3: Fixing motor
Below are the cases in which pressure will be applied to the fixing film unit:
- When pressure is not applied at power-on state
- When pressure is applied at power-on state
- When returning from sleep mode
- After jam removal
- When the state of pressure application is not certain after opening / closing doors with interlocks such as front cover (E.g. when a door is opened while pressure
is being applied)
Below are the cases in which pressure will be released from the fixing film unit:
- In power ON jam at power-on state
- When paper jam has occurred
- When the equipment enters the sleep mode (both the soft switch and the timer are applicable)
The fixing motor (M3) will be rotated forward (the positive rotation) when pressure is applied. The fixing motor (M3) will be rotated in the opposite direction (the
negative rotation) when pressure is released.
The sensor flag [3] in conjunction with the pressure release cover [2] will be rotated, and the fixing automatic pressure release position sensor (PS13) will detect
the movement. This regulates the start / end timings of applying and releasing pressure.
Error code
Error in pressure/release of fixing film unit
In case that the output of fixing automatic pressure phase sensor is not changed although rotating/reversing the fixing motor
9.4.1 Overview
0013-8529
It is a function that detects overheating of the fixing assembly to cut off the power to the heater.
The machine is equipped with the following mechanisms that detect overheating of the fixing assembly to cut the power to the heater:
- cutting off the power using the DC controller (CPU)
- cutting off the power using a safety circuit
- cutting off the power using a thermal switch
9-9
Chapter 9
TH2 TH3
DC Driver PCB
Zero Cross ZEROX
TP
TH1 Detector PCB
THERR
H1 H2 RDRV
Relay Safety Circuit
SOFTRON
HTDRV1
DC Controller
Triac
PCB
HTDRV2
AC Driver PCB
MAIN THRM
SUB THRM2
SUB THRM1
F-9-8
- Go low the relay drive signal (SOFTRON), thus the safety circuit on the DC driver PCB turns to low the relay drive command (RDRV).
As a result, the relay turns off to cut off the power to the heater.
Cutting Off the Power Using the Safety Circuit
The machine monitors the output voltage (MAIN_THRM, SUB_THRM1, SUB_THRM2) of the main thermistor/sub thermistor 1/sub thermistor 2. If the output
of MAIN_THRM is about 0.38 V or less (equivalent of 258 deg C or more), or that of SUB_THRM1/SUB_THRM2 is about 0.7 V or less (equivalent of 255 deg
C or more), the safety circuit on the DC driver PCB outputs the themistor error signal (THERR) to the DC controller PCB.
- The DC controller PCB makes the heater drive signal (HTDRV1,HTDRV2) "L" and turns off the fixing heaters.
Triac (in the AC driver PCB) is turned off, energizing to the fixing heater is intercepted.
- The safety circuit in the DC driver PCB makes the relay drive signal (RDRV) "L". The relay is turned off, and energizing to the fixing heater is intercepted.
Cutting Off the Power Using a Thermal Switch
If the fixing heater overheats and the reading of the thermal switch exceeds about 270 deg C, the thermal switch (TP1) goes off to cut the power to the fixing heater.
9-10
Chapter 9
T-9-11
9-11
Chapter 9
1) Detach the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
1) Remove three screws [1] and open the double hinge of the right cover. [2] [1]
F-9-12
2) Remove the shutter unit [1].
- 2 connectors [2]
- 5 screws [3]
[1] [3]
[1]
[3]
[2]
[3]
F-9-9
[2]
2) Detach the connector cover [1].
- 1 screw [2] F-9-13
3) Remove 3 screws [1], and detach the cable cover [2].
[1]
[1]
[2] [2]
[1]
[1]
F-9-14
4) Disconnect the connector [1].
5) Remove the screw [2], and open the retainer arm [3].
F-9-10 [3] [2]
3) Remove the fixing unit [1].
- 3 connectors [2]
- 4 screws [3]
[1]
[2]
[3] [3]
[2] [1]
F-9-15
6) Remove the screw [2] that fixes the grounding wire [1].
7) Disconnect 2 connectors [3].
F-9-11 8) Remove the screw [4], and open the retainer arm [5].
9-12
Chapter 9
[1]
F-9-19
3) Tighten the 5 screws [1], and pull out the protection sheet [2].
[1] [2] [3]
[1]
F-9-16
9) From the fixing film unit [1], slide the 2 leaf springs [2] in the direction of
the arrow, and remove them; then, remove the separation guide [3].
[2]
[2]
[2]
F-9-20
1) Remove the fixing film unit. (page 9-12)[Removing Fixing Film Unit]
Points to Note when Attaching the Shutter Unit
When attaching the shutter unit [1], it could damage the fixing film. There- 9.5.3.2 Removing Pressure Roller
fore, be sure to go through the following procedure. 0013-8777
1) Cover the fixing film with the protection sheet [2]. / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
[1] 1) Remove the screw [1]; then, remove the inlet guide [2] by sliding in the
direction of the arrow.
[1] [2]
F-9-21
2) Open the jam removal door [1], and inset the screwdriver [2] as indicated
in the following figure.
[2]
F-9-18
2) Fit the shutter unit [1] onto the positioning pin [2].
[2] [1]
F-9-22
3) By lifting one side of the pressure roller [1], remove the bush [2] and
bearing [3].
9-13
Chapter 9
[2]
[3]
[1]
F-9-23
4) Remove the pressure roller [1] by sliding it.
[1]
F-9-24
5) From the removed pressure roller [1], remove the following parts.
- 1 gear [2] (1 hook [3])
- 1 bush [4]
- 1 bearing [5]
[2]
[3]
[1]
[4]
[5]
F-9-25
9-14
Chapter 10 Externals and Controls
Contents
Contents
10.1.1 Overview
0013-8651
The machine's control panel consists of the following PCBs, LCD, and touch panel, each offering the functions that follow:
- LCD display function
- contrast adjustment
- touch switch input
- hardware key input
J2117A,J2117B
Color LCD
J2137 J6891,J6892
Control panel Keypad PCB
inverter PCB
Control panel
F-10-1
The CPU on the main controlled PCB sends data (display data) to the control panel CPU PCB as instructed by the program.
The data is sent through the control panel PCB to reach the color LCD.
The machine is equipped with a density adjustment volume (VR6801) on its keypad PCB for use by the user to adjust the contrast of the LCD screen.
MEMO:
The color LCD is driven by the main controller, and the control panel CPU PCB serves to relay the drive signals.
10.2 Counters
10.2.1 Overview
0013-8656
The machine is equipped with counters that indicate the counts of output according to types of printers. These counters are indicated in response to a press on the
Check key on the control panel, and they operate as follows (as set at time of shipment from the factory):
T-10-1
10-1
Chapter 10
Guide to Notations
large: large-size paper (longer than 364 mm in feed direction; count increased by 1).
small: small-size paper (364 mm in feed length or shorter).
total: all (C+P; count increased by 1).
duplex: duplexing (in auto duplexing; count increased by 1).
- The 3-digit number in the counter column indicates the setting of the following service mode item: COPIER >OPTION >USER > COUNTER1 to 6
- counters 2 through 6 may be changed using the following service mode item: COPIER>OPTION>USER.
*1: F14-3019/3011/3029/3012/3049/3014/3059/3015
*2: F14-3001
*3: F14-3031
*4: F14-3041/3060/3070/3044 /3048/3078
*5: F14-3061/3068
*6: F14-3091/3094
The machine increases the count depending on the selected mode (single-sided, double-sided), delivery location, and the type of accessory connected to it.
10.3 Fans
10.3.1 Overview
0013-8659
The machine is equipped with the following fans arranged as shown in the diagram:
T-10-3
10-2
Chapter 10
FM1 FM2
FM5
FM8
FM11
FM4
F-10-2
FM9
FM7
FM10
FM6
FM3
F-10-3
10-3
Chapter 10
Among the fans mounted to the machine, the delivery adhesive fan and the power supply fan 2 execute 2-speed control. Switching of the rotation speed is executed
by switching the voltage by the voltage switching PCB of the fan.
24V 13V
24V/ 3V/ 0V
Drive signal
Voltage
CPU Half-speed
signal switching circuit
Fan
F-10-4
Controller fan
10-4
Chapter 10
13V
24V
Cassette heater (H4)
ELCB 1/2
3.3V ANALOG
3.3V
24R
24V
5V
Printer power supply
only 100V
Arrestor 24VU1 DC driver PCB
PCB
SW1 SW2
Fixing heater (H1) SW3
24VU2
Sensor
Each load
24VU2
13VA2
13VA
Printer power
3VA
5VA
AC drive PCB supply PCB
Fixing heater (H2)
24UV3
13VA1
Thermal switch (TP1) 13VA2
13VB
3VB
To 13V
No.2/No.3 24V
delivery assembly Controller power supply PCB
To 2-cassette pedestal Y3/ 24V1
All-night power
Accessories power
supply PCB
13V 13V
To finisher Z1 To 2-cassette pedestal Y3/
24V side paper deck Z1 24V2
3VB
To finisher Y1, 13VA2
side finisher Y2, 24V 24VA
and buffer path unit E1
13VA2
13VA2
12VA
5VA
13VB
24VU1 : non-all 13VA1 : non-all 5VA : non-all 3VA : non-all 3VB
night night night night
24VU2 : non-all 13VA2 : non-all 13VB : all night 3VB : all night
night night
Fax Board Main Controller
24VU3 : non-all 24VA : non-all PCB
night night
F-10-6
10-5
Chapter 10
The reader controller PCB uses the 24/13 VDC from the printer unit to generate the following DC voltages:
- 16 VDC (for scanning lamp)
- 12 VDC (for CCD)
- 5 VDC (for sensor)
- 3.3 VDC (for IC)
DC13V
DC12V/5V
To DF AC100V
To printer unit
(scanner PCB)
DC24V DC13V DC16V
From printer unit
/5 03
To DF
04
J5
2
0
J5
DC24V
1
0
J5
J5
0
1
0
2
5
J5
1
0
J5
J5
J5
0
15
AC100V
J5
0
18
Reader controller PCB
Inverter PCB
DC24V DC16V
DC13V DC12V
DC13V DC5V
DC13V DC3.3V
F-10-7
Sleep mode 2
Standby
PSTBY
F-10-8
10-6
Chapter 10
The power from the printer unit to the accessories is routed as follows:
[2] [A]
[B]
[1] [3]
[9] [C]
[4]
[5]
[E] [8] [7] [6] [D]
F-10-9
[1] Reader unit power cable
[2] DADF I/F cable
[3] Reader communication cable
[4] Finisher Y1 / saddle finisher Y2 I/F cable
[5] Pickup heater cable
[6] Side deck heater cable
[7] Side deck I/F cable
[8] Cassette pedestal I/F cable
[9] AC input
[A] DADF-L1
[B] Reader unit
[C] Printer unit
[D] Cassette Feeding Unit-Y3
[E] Paper Deck-Z1
The ratings and the power tolerances of the printer power supply PCB are as follows:
T-10-5
The ratings and the power tolerances of the controller power supply PCB are as follows:
T-10-6
10-7
Chapter 10
Rated output and power supply tolerance of the accessory power supply PCB are shown below:
T-10-7
Rated output and power supply tolerance of the all-night power supply PCB are shown below:
T-10-8
The machine's DC power supply PCB and those of its accessories are equipped with protective functions against excess current and voltage, which will automati-
cally cut off the output voltage in response to an error power condition (caused, for example, by a short-circuit on a load).
If any of these protective mechanism has gone on, turn off the main power switch of the printer unit, and remove the cause of activation; then, leave the machine
alone for about 3 min, and turn its power back on to reset it.
10.4.5.1 Overview
0013-8673
Low power mode (at time of shift The machine moves through different states in response to the passage of times programmed
shipment) in advance.
Description The machine performs its power save functions in keeping with the requirements of the
Energy Star standards.
10-8
Chapter 10
T-10-10
Sleep mode Shift The machine moves through different sates in response to the passage of times selected in
Additional Function or in response to a press on the control panel software power switch.
Description In sleep mode 1, the DC controller PCB and the main controller PCB are supplied with
power. In sleep mode 2, the main controller PCB is supplied with power. In both sleep modes
1 and 2, the power to the fixing AC heater is off.
Also, if there is a network communication and RTC communication during the sleep mode
2, the machine can recover without booting the HDD. When booting the HDD, sleep mode
1, the protection time (120 min) to protect the HDD duration number must be retained. Power
consumption can be kept at low level by not booting the HDD.
When there is network communication and RTC communication during sleep mode 2, the
machine recovers as CPU recovery status (without booting HDD). If there is no Network
communication for 15 sec after the recovery of CPU, the machine transits to sleep mode 2.
If there is a network communication during 15 sec after recovery, the machine transits to
sleep mode 2 after service mode setting time (*1) from the last network communication.
*1 Service mode:
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > WUEV-LIV
Default: 15 sec
Setting range: 10 to 600 sec
3. AC Off Mode
The machine remains in this sate when its main power switch remains off. All its power remain off.
T-10-11
When the machine is used as a Windows printer, enabling 'Use SNMP' causes the operating system to collect machine status information at specific intervals, pre-
venting the machine from starting a sleep state.
To avoid the situation, disable the setting (Windows' printer properties).
-Disabling 'Use SNMP'
1) Select 'Configure Port' on the Ports screen (printer properties).
10-9
Chapter 10
F-10-10
2) Remove the check mark from 'SNMP Status Enabled'.
10-10
Chapter 10
F-10-11
10-11
Chapter 10
[1]
F-10-14
3) Detach the right lower cover [1].
- 2 screws [2]
[1]
F-10-12
2) Detach the front cover [1].
- 1 screw [2]
- 2 pins [3]
[1] [2]
F-10-15
[2]
[1]
F-10-13
10-12
Chapter 10
[1]
[2]
[2]
[1]
F-10-17
3) Push down the claw [1] and then remove the handle cover [2]. F-10-21
7) Remove the right front cover [1].
[1] - 3 screws [2]
[2]
[2]
[1]
F-10-18
4) Remove the face cover [1].
[2]
[1]
F-10-19 F-10-22
5) Remove the screw [1] and slide the inside right cover [2] to the direction 10.5.1.4 Rear Right Cover
of the arrow.
10.5.1.4.1 Detaching the Rear Right Cover
0014-0636
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
[2]
F-10-20
6) Remove the right front inside cover [1].
- 2 screws [2]
[1]
[2]
F-10-23
3) Disconnect the reader power cable [1].
4) Detach the rear right cover [2].
10-13
Chapter 10
[3]
F-10-24
[1]
10.5.1.5 Upper Left Cover
10.5.1.5.1 Detaching the Left Cover [2]
0014-0640
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
F-10-27
1) Open the front cover.
10.5.1.7 Left Rear Cover (Upper)
10.5.1.7.1 Detaching the Left Rear Cover
0014-0641
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
[1]
F-10-25
2) Detach the left cover [1].
- 4 screws [2] [1] [2]
[1]
F-10-28
1) Release the 4 wire saddles [1] on the rear upper cover to free the cable [2]
upward.
F-10-26
10-14
Chapter 10
[2]
[2]
[2]
[1]
[3]
[1] F-10-32
F-10-29 3) Detach the rear lower cover [1].
2) Detach the rear upper cover [1]. - 6 screws [2]
- 4 screws [2] (Remove)
- 3 screws [3] (Loosen) [2]
[1]
[2]
[2]
[1]
[3]
F-10-30 [2]
1) Release the 5 wire saddles [1] on the upper rear cover to free the 2 cables
[2] upward.
If the pedestal [3] has been installed, disconnect the lattice connector [4].
[2]
[4]
[3]
F-10-34
[1]
F-10-31
2) Detach the rear upper cover [1]. 10.5.1.10 Reader Front Cover
- 4 screws [2] (Remove)
- 3 screws [3] (Loosen) 10.5.1.10.1 Detaching the Reader Front Cover
0014-1336
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
10-15
Chapter 10
[2] [1]
F-10-38
F-10-35 3) Remove the 4 screws [1] to detach the reader rear cover [2].
3) Remove the 2 screws [1] to remove the copyboard glass retainer (left) [2].
[2]
[1]
F-10-39
4) Remove the 2 screws [3] to detach the reader front cover [4]. / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
[1]
[2]
F-10-37
1) Open the copyboard cover (pressing plate/ADF). For taking in/out of the process unit, make sure to do with the duplexing unit
2) Disconnect the reader unit communication cable [1] and the ADF [3] open.
communication cable [2] (models with ADF only).
10-16
Chapter 10
[1]
[2]
[1]
F-10-44
7) Detach the hopper unit cover [1].
- 3 screws [2]
[2]
[3] [2]
F-10-41
4) Remove the 2 screws [1].
[1]
[1]
[2]
F-10-45
8) Detach the inside front left cover [1].
- 3 screws [2]
[2]
[1]
F-10-42
[1]
5) Turn the handle [1] 180 deg. Pull the process unit [3] out until it is stopped
while holding the handle [1] and the grip [2].
[2]
F-10-46
9) Disconnect the 17 connectors [2] and remove the screw [3] from the
hopper unit relay PCB [1] to remove the grounding wire.
[2]
[3] [1]
F-10-43
6) Detach the inside front right cover [1].
- 2 screws [2]
10-17
Chapter 10
[3]
[2]
[3]
[2]
[2] [2]
F-10-47 [3]
10) Free the harness [2] from the cable guide [1], detach the cable guide [1].
- 3 screws [3]
F-10-50
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover [1]. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
Cover]
[1] [2] 10.5.4.2 Detaching the Controller Power Supply PCB
F-10-48 0013-6817
[2]
[2]
[2] [3]
[2]
[1]
1) Disconnect the 7 connectors on the optional power supply PCB [1] and the
12 connectors on the controller power supply PCB [2].
2) Remove the optional power supply/controller power supply mount [3].
- 9 cable clamps [4]
10-18
Chapter 10
[7]
F-10-55
3) Detach the lattice connector [1] to the cassette pedestal. / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
- 1 screw [2]
1) Open the front cover [1].
[2] [1]
F-10-53
[1]
4) Disconnect the 5 connectors [1].
5) Remove the 6 cable clamps [2]. F-10-56
6) Remove the 5 edge saddles [3]. 2) Press the open/close button [1] to open the right cover [2].
[2]
[3]
[2] [2]
[3]
F-10-57
3) Push the claw [1] to detach the handle cover [2].
[2]
F-10-58
4) Detach the face cover [1].
10-19
Chapter 10
[2]
[1]
[1]
F-10-59
5) Remove the screw [1], slide the inside right cover [2] in the direction of
the arrow.
[1]
[2]
[2]
F-10-62
F-10-60 8) Detach the connector [1].
6) Detach the inside front right cover [1].
- 2 screws [2] [1]
[2]
[1]
F-10-63
9) Remove the 2 screws [1].
F-10-61
7) Detach the front right cover [1].
- 3 screws [2]
[1]
F-10-64
10) Detach the screw cover [1] on the left side of the control panel, and
remove the screw at the back of it.
10-20
Chapter 10
[4]
[3] [1]
F-10-65 F-10-68
11) Slide the control panel [1] to the right, and pull it out forward. 6) Detach the plate [1].
- 2 screws [2]
[1]
[2]
F-10-69
7) Remove the frame [1] inside the control panel.
F-10-66 - 12 screws [2]
F-10-71
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
10-21
Chapter 10
Cover]
3) Detach the DC driver PCB. (page 10-25)[Removing the DC Driver [7] [1] [4] [2]
PCB]
[1] [2]
F-10-72
2) Detach the DC controller PCB [1].
- 8 screws [2]
[1] [2]
[2] [1]
F-10-75
4) Detach the printer power supply PCB [1].
- 2 connectors [2]
- 1 edge saddle [3]
- 4 screws [4]
[2] [2]
[4] [3] [2]
[4]
[2]
F-10-73
10.5.9.1 Before Detaching the Printer Power Supply PCB [4] [1]
0014-2488
F-10-76
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper 10.5.10 All-Night Power Supply PCB
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower 10.5.10.1 Before Detaching the All-Night Power Supply
Cover] PCB
3) Detach the left lower cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Lower 0013-6804
10.5.9.2 Detaching the Printer Power Supply PCB 1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
0014-2489 Cover]
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
Cover]
1) Disconnect the 7 connectors on the optional power supply PCB [1] and the
12 connectors on the controller power supply PCB [2]. 10.5.10.2 Detaching the All-Night Power Supply PCB
2) Remove the optional power supply/controller power supply mount [3]. 0013-6814
10-22
Chapter 10
[3]
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower 1) Remove the left cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Left Cover]
Cover]
10.5.12.2 Removing HVT1 PCB (for image forming)
10.5.11.2 Removing the Electric Leak Breaker / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
0014-1283
0014-2621
[2]
See the picture showing the colors of the cords connected to each faston. At-
tach the codes back exactly as is shown in the picture when restoring them.
[1]
[BK]
[1]
F-10-80
2) Remove HVT1 PCB assembly.
- 1 connector [1]
- 2 screws [2]
[WH]
[1]
[1]
[BK]
[2]
[WH]
[1]
F-10-78
2) Remove 2 screws [2] and remove the electric leak breaker.
10-23
Chapter 10
In case the print quality is degraded due to touching the ITB, clean the ITB
[1] with soft and dry cloth.
If the print quality is not improved, execute the following:
[Additional Functions] > [Adjustment/Cleaning] > [Cleaning inside Main
Unit] > [Start]
[2]
[1]
F-10-82
[2]
4) Remove the HVT1 PCB [1].
- 2 screws [2]
[2]
F-10-85
[1] 3) Remove the screws [1].
F-10-83
[1] [2]
10.5.13 HV2 PCB
F-10-86
4) Detach the upper ITB cover [1].
- 4 screws [2]
[1]
[2] [2]
F-10-87
5) Detach the high-voltage contact cover [2].
- 3 claws [1]
Do not touch the ITB. If the ITB is scratched, it may cause the pickup fault
or degradation of the print quality.
10-24
Chapter 10
[1] [2]
[1]
[2] [1]
F-10-88
F-10-91
6) Remove the HVT2 [3].
- 2 connectors [1] 4) Remove the screw [1] that fixes the grounding wire [2].
- 3 claws [2] 5) Remove the AC driver PCB [3].
- 4 connctors [4]
[3] - 2 edge saddles [5]
- 4 screws [6]
[5]
[4]
[2] [1]
F-10-89 [6] [3] [6] [4]
F-10-92
10.5.14 AC Driver PCB
10.5.15 DC Driver PCB
10.5.14.1 Before Removing the AC Driver PCB
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
0014-1289
10.5.15.1 Before Removing the DC Driver PCB
0014-1292
[2]
[2]
[4]
[7]
[1]
[5] [7] [5] [3] [7] [6] [4] F-10-93
F-10-90 2) Remove 28 connectors [1], 3 wire saddles [2], and 3 edge saddles [3] from
the DC driver PCB.
3) Detach the lattice connector to the cassette pedestal.
- 1 screw [2]
10-25
Chapter 10
[1]
[2] [2]
[1]
[1] [1]
[2]
[1] [3] [1] [2] [1] [3] [1] F-10-97
F-10-94
3) Remove the L-shaped sheet metal [1]. 10.5.16 Control Panel CPU PCB
- 2 screws [2]
10.5.16.1 Before Removing the Control Panel CPU PCB
[2] [1] [2] / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
0014-2585
[2]
F-10-95
4) Remove the DC driver PCB mount [3].
- 4 screws [4].
[4] [3] [1]
[2] F-10-98
[1] 3) Remove the control panel CPU PCB [1].
- 4 connectors [2]
- 2 connectors [3]
- 4 screws [4]
[2] [1]
[4]
[4]
[4]
[3]
[4]
[4] [2]
[3] F-10-99
F-10-96
10.5.17 Control Panel Key Switch PCB
5) Remove the DC driver PCB [1].
- 12 screws [2]
10.5.17.1 Before Removing the Control Panel KEY PCB
0014-2587
10-26
Chapter 10
[2]
F-10-104
[4] [3] [1] 10.5.18.1 Before removing the Control Panel Inverter
F-10-100 PCB
0014-2589
3) Detach 6 connectors [1] from the control panel CPU PCB. / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
4) Detach 2 connectors [2] from the control panel inverter PCB.
5) Detached the cables from 3 cable clamps [3] and 2 edge saddles [4]. 1) Remove the control panel. (page 10-19)[Detaching the Control Panel]
[2] [1] 10.5.18.2 Removing the Control Panel Inverter PCB
0014-2590
[2]
[3] [1]
F-10-101
6) Remove the metal sheet [1].
- 2 screws [2] [4] [3] [1]
F-10-105
[1]
3) Remove the control panel inverter PCB [1].
- 3 connectors [2]
- 4 screws [3]
F-10-102
[1]
7) Remove the frame [1] inside the control panel.
- 12 screws [2]
[3] [2] [3]
[2] [2] F-10-106
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
Cover]
10-27
Chapter 10
[1] [1]
[2]
[1]
[2]
F-10-107
F-10-110
3) Remove the front process unit Fan [1].
- 1 connector [1]
When attaching the 4 fastons, make sure the numbers assigned to the fastons
match the numbers shown in the below picture.
3
[BK]
1
[WH]
2
[WH]
4
[BK] [1] [2]
F-10-111
F-10-112
10-28
Chapter 10
[2] [2]
F-10-116
[2] 1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
Cover]
F-10-113
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
2) Remove the fixing exhaust fan (front) [1] and then the fixing exhaust fan Cover]
(rear) [2].
- 1 group of connectors [3] 10.5.23.2 Removing the Power Supply Fan
0014-2642
[3] [1]
F-10-114
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper 10.5.24 Delivery Cooling Fan
Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
Cover] 10.5.24.1 Before Removing the Delivery Contact Fan
0014-2639
[1]
F-10-115
2) Remove the power supply fan 2 [1].
- 2 screws [2]
10-29
Chapter 10
F-10-118 F-10-121
2) Remove the delivery contact fan [1]. 2) Remove the fan duct [1].
- 1 connector [2] - 1 claw [2]
- 1 wire saddle [3]
- 1 reuse band [4] [2]
- 1 edge saddle [5]
- 2 screws [6]
[1]
[6]
F-10-120
10.5.25.2 Removing the Fixing Side Cooling Fan / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
0014-3449
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 1) Remove the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
1) Remove the delivery contact fan mount [1].
- 1 connector [2] 10.5.26.2 Removing the Secondary Transfer Cooling Fan
- 1 cable clamp [3] 0014-3451
10-30
Chapter 10
[5] [5]
[2] [1]
F-10-127
F-10-124 2) Remove the toner filter [1].
2) Remove the fan duct [1].
- 1 claw [2] [1]
[1] [2]
F-10-128
1) Detach the rear upper cover. (page 10-14)[Detaching the Rear Upper
F-10-125 Cover]
2) Detach the rear lower cover. (page 10-15)[Detaching the Rear Lower
3) Remove the secondary transfer cooling fan. Cover]
- 1 connector [2]
3) Remove the DC driver PCB. (page 10-25)[Removing the DC Driver
PCB]
[2] [3]
[2] [1]
F-10-126
1) Remove the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
2) Remove the fixing unit. (page 9-12)[Removing Fixing Unit]
10-31
Chapter 10
[1]
[1]
[5] [5]
[2]
F-10-130
2) Remove the fan shutter motor [1].
- 1 cable clamp [2]
- 1 connector [3]
- 2 screws [4]
[4] [1]
F-10-131
1) Remove the rear right cover. (page 10-13)[Detaching the Rear Right
Cover]
[3]
[4]
[4]
[4]
[2]
[2]
[3]
[1]
F-10-132
F-10-135
10-32
Chapter 11 MEAP
Contents
Contents
11.1 MEAP.........................................................................................................................................................................11-1
11.1.1 Checking the Operating Environment. .................................................................................................................................... 11-1
11.1.2 Setting Up the Network ........................................................................................................................................................... 11-2
11.1.3 Setting the method to login to SMS ......................................................................................................................................... 11-3
11.1.4 Login to SMS ........................................................................................................................................................................... 11-7
11.1.5 Checking Application List ....................................................................................................................................................... 11-8
11.1.6 Starting and Stopping a MEAP Application ............................................................................................................................ 11-9
11.1.7 Checking the Platform Information ....................................................................................................................................... 11-10
11.1.8 MEAP Specifications............................................................................................................................................................. 11-11
11.1.9 Checking the System Information of a MEAP Application with SMS ................................................................................. 11-12
11.1.10 Printing the System Information of a MEAP Application................................................................................................... 11-13
11.1.11 Reference (Application System Information) ...................................................................................................................... 11-13
11.1.12 Installing an Application...................................................................................................................................................... 11-14
11.1.13 MEAP Enterprise Service Manager..................................................................................................................................... 11-16
11.1.14 Adding a License File .......................................................................................................................................................... 11-16
11.1.15 Disabling a License File (suspending a license) .................................................................................................................. 11-18
11.1.16 Downloading/Removing an Invalidated License File.......................................................................................................... 11-20
11.1.17 Reusable license................................................................................................................................................................... 11-22
11.1.18 License for forwarding......................................................................................................................................................... 11-23
11.1.19 Uninstalling an Application ................................................................................................................................................. 11-25
11.1.20 Changing Login Services ..................................................................................................................................................... 11-26
11.1.21 Initializing the Password...................................................................................................................................................... 11-30
11.1.22 Creating a Backup for MEAP Application Area, Formatting the Hard Disk, Restoring the MEAP Application Area with the
Backup, Using the SST (Service Support Tool)........................................................................................................................... 11-30
11.1.23 Replacing the Hard Disk Drive............................................................................................................................................ 11-32
11.1.24 MEAP Safe Mode ................................................................................................................................................................ 11-32
11.1.25 Setting HTTP port for MEAP application (level 2)............................................................................................................. 11-33
11.1.26 Reference material ............................................................................................................................................................... 11-36
11.1.27 Option for exclusive individual measure ............................................................................................................................. 11-37
Chapter 11
11.1 MEAP
This section lists the requirements on the operating environment for the maintenance.
Memo:
Java Script must be enabled in every environment.
Important:
For the following operations in the combined environment of Windows XP and Internet Explorer6, Java2 Runtime Environment Standard Edition 1.3.1 or later
is required.
- User registration / edit in SDL
- User registration / edit in SSO local device
- Use of SSO remote login in SSO
Remote Login of Default Authentication or Simple Device Login (SDL), Remote UI, and Portal Services
Remote Login of Default Authentication or Simple Device Login (SDL), Remote UI, and Portal Services guarantee operation under the following system environ-
ment.
T-11-1
Remote UI (RUI)
RUI guarantees operation under the following system environment.
T-11-2
SMS
SMS guarantees operation under the following system environment.
T-11-3
SDL and SSO with Local Devoce Authentication (user registration/edit functions)
For user registration / edit in SDL and SSO(with Local Authentication), following system requirements must be satisfied.
System environment for administrator
T-11-4
11-1
Chapter 11
T-11-5
Memo:
For use of Domain Authentication in SSO, access privilege for Windows 2000 Domain Name System (DNS) and access privilege for domain controller are
required.
Operating System
Microsoft Windows 2000 Professional
Microsoft Windows 2000 Server
Microsoft Windows XP Professional
Microsoft Windows Server 2003
To allow a MEAP device to accept accesses through the network, for example you operate a device with SMS, the On option must be selected on Use HTTP screen.
The option is selected by default. The setting can be changed on the control panel of the MEAP device.
1) Make the following selections: Ad Func button > System Settings button> Down-arrow button.
Memo:
If the System manager ID and system password have already been assigned, ID Entry dialog appears after System Settings button is pressed. Enter the system
manager ID and the password, and click ID key to go into System Management Mode.
F-11-1
2) Make the following selections: MEAP Settings button > Use HTTP button> On button > OK button .
11-2
Chapter 11
F-11-2
Memo:
When using SSL, set [Use SSL] ON.
(This setting is also applied to the SSL setting of RUI. Same is true in the case of setting SSL ON on the side of RUI.)
Setting [Use SSL] ON displays the message dialogue 'Changes effective after the main power switch is turned OFF and ON' . Press [OK].
F-11-3
3) Press Done button as many times as necessary until the Basic screen appears.
4) Turn off the device's main power; wait for 10 sec, and then turn the power back on.
- The setting [Use HTTP] is not actually enabled/disabled until you have turned off and then on the device's main power switch.
- You cannot make a connection through a proxy server. If a proxy server is in use, enter the IP address of the MEAP device in the Exceptions field for the
browser. Open Internet Options dialog of Internet Explorer and select Connections tab, LAN Settings button, Use a proxy server option, and Advanced button
of Proxy server group. Proxy Settings dialog will opens. The Exceptions field is in the dialog. As network settings vary among environments, consult the
network administrator.
- If Cookie and JavaScript are not enabled in the Web browser, you will not be able to use SMS.
- To type text using the Web browser, use the characters compatible with the MEAP device's touch panel display. The MEAP device may not properly recognize
some characters.
- When [se SSL] is made available, it is necessary to set the key and the certificate necessary for the SSL communication. Set the key and the certificate by SSL
with [Certificate Settings] that exists in [System Settings] > [Network Settings] > [TCP/IP Settings] on the iR device.
Memo:
If Default Authentication is selected as the device authentication method, 'RLS Authentication' is not selectable as SMS Login method. Also, if 'RLS
Authentication' is selected, the device authentication method (Default Authentication, SDL, SSO) cannot be changed.
Setting of login method to SMS (Start/Stop) must be made after logging-in by the other login method. In other words, setting for Start/Stop of Password Authenti-
cation is made after logging-in with RLS Authentication, and setting for Start/Stop of RLS Authentication is made after logging-in with Password Authentication.
The table below shows the setting methods for each combination of login method and Start/Stop.
T-11-8
11-3
Chapter 11
When only RLS Authentication is enabled, there may be a case you cannot login to device for the following reasons.
- Authentication server down
- Disconnection with authentication server due to network failure
In these cases, boot the device as MEAP SAFE mode from device service mode.
By booting the device as MEAP SAFE mode, login to SMS becomes available as Default Authentication is enabled. After login to SMS, set RLS Authentication
as Started, return the device to normal mode, and then login by RLS Authentication.
F-11-4
2) Select 'System Management' tab > 'Utility' tab > 'Application Management Function' tab.
F-11-5
3) In order to enable login by Password Authentication, tick SMS Installer Service (Password Authentication) radio button and then click [Start]. On the other hand,
in order to disable login by Password Authentication, clear the tick of SMS Installer Service (Password Authentication) radio button and click [Stop].
11-4
Chapter 11
F-11-6
4) Logout once and login again to check to see that the setting is applied properly. In case the setting is changed from 'Stop' to 'Start', login screen that was not seen
before is displayed. In case the setting is changed from 'Start' to 'Stop', access to login screen leads to the screen below and login becomes unavailable.
F-11-7
F-11-8
2) Select 'System Management' tab > 'Utility' tab > 'Application Management Function' tab.
11-5
Chapter 11
F-11-9
3) In order to enable Login by RLS Authentication, tick SMS Installer Service (Remote Login Service Authentication) radio button and then click [Start]. On the
other hand, in order to disable login by RLS Authentication, clear the tick of SMS Installer Service (Remote Login Service Authentication) radio button and click
[Stop].
F-11-10
4) Logout once and login again to check to see that the setting is applied properly. In case the setting is changed from 'Stop' to 'Start', login screen that was not seen
before is displayed. In case the setting is changed from 'Start' to 'Stop', access to login screen leads to the screen below and Login becomes unavailable.
F-11-11
11-6
Chapter 11
Memo:
- The default password is "MeapSmsLogin." (The password is case-sensitive.)
- When you want to change the display original language, change in the box in the right of the screen. This setting is not affect by the setting of the language of
the device.
F-11-12
2) The following screen appears if the password has been changed by the user's system administrator. If so, check with the system administrator for the new
password. Keep in mind that there is no special password offered for service work.
F-11-13
Memo:
- In case the device authentication method is SSO and login to domain, enter User Name, Password, and Login Destination registered in Active Directory, and
click 'Log in'.
- In case the device authentication method is SDL or SSO and login to 'this device', enter User Name and Password registered in the device and click 'Log in'.
11-7
Chapter 11
F-11-14
In the case the device authentication method is SDL
F-11-15
The page of Application List is designed to show resources arranged according to applications. The page gives you a good idea of how much of the device's memory
is being used by the applications (both in absolute and relative terms) as well as how much memory still remains. Check this page before adding an application.
The information is collected from the manifest (headers) - in other words, the size of a resource represents the size as it is declared by the application in question,
not necessarily the size of resources actually used by the application. The items of information include the following:
- hard disk
- memory
- thread
- socket
- file descriptor
You will not be able to install an application if the size of the remaining memory falls short of the size declared by the application. Moreover, the specifications
have been designed so that an application will not be able to start up if there is a shortage of memory for any of the foregoing items (i.e., memory, thread, socket,
file descriptor). To find out if there is enough memory, go through the following steps:
1) Log in to SMS.
a. Information on Applications
- Name (of the application)
- Installation (date)
- Application ID
- Status
- License
- Resources Used
b. Resource Information
- Amount Used
- Remaining
- Percent Used
11-8
Chapter 11
F-11-16
F-11-17
4) Check to see that the status of the MEAP application in question is either "Started" or "Stopped."
11-9
Chapter 11
F-11-18
You can check the versions of MEAP Contents, MEAP Specifications, and Java Virtual Machine of the device.
Some applications may not be installed to some MEAP devices of specific specifications. (See 'MEAP Specifications').
1) Log in to SMS.
F-11-19
3) Click System Info tab.
11-10
Chapter 11
F-11-20
Device Specification ID shows information such as the original functions of MFP (including print, scan, and copy), and one that differs by model such as maximum
copy number, thus each model has a different ID. (It is easy to determine the IDs for this reason.) MEAP application declares 1 or more Device Specification ID
required for its execution. Declaration of multiple Device Specification IDs means that the application is operable in all the models declared. Upon installation of
MEAP application in (using) SMS or MEAP Enterprise Service Manager, matching of Device Specification ID is executed on the side of MEAP platform machine.
The machine which doesn't support the ID declared by the application rejects installation of such an application.
Meanwhile, MEAP Specifications shows other information than defined by Device Specification ID above, including network and security. Thus each model does
not always have the same version.
MEAP application declares 1 or more MEAP Specifications required for its execution. Declaration of multiple Device Specification IDs means that the application
is operable in all the environments declared. Upon installation of MEAP application in SMS or MEAP Enterprise Service Manager, matching of MEAP Specifica-
tions is executed on the side of MEAP platform machine. The machine which doesn't support the version declared by the application rejects installation of such an
application.
T-11-10
11-11
Chapter 11
1) Log in to SMS.
F-11-21
5) When the following status information of MEAP applications (including the system application) appears in a different window, copy and paste all information
to create an attachment (text information) for preparing a problem report. You can also use this function whenever you want to check the status of any particular
application.
F-11-22
11-12
Chapter 11
1) Make the following selections: Additional Functions button > System Settings button> the down-arrow button.
Memo:
If the System manager ID and system password have already been assigned, ID Entry dialog appears after System Settings button is pressed. Enter the system
manager ID and the password, and click ID key.
F-11-23
2) Make the following selections: MEAP Settings button > Print System Information button >Yes button.
F-11-24
3) Press Done button as many times as necessary until the Basic screen appears.
4) Turn off the MEAP device's main power; wait for 10 sec, and then turn the power back on.
Important:
The previous version of printing function for MEAP application status information (system information) was depended on PDL. However, current version of
function is not dependent on PDL. So even device for which PDL is not available can print it. (Since iRC3220)
You can check all applications installed to the device at a glance with the MEAP application status information and, thus, it is important for you to provide it when
you are reporting a problem.
The following items of information will be indicated or printed for individual applications:
Memo:
The system information shown on the screen and the system information printed in the MEAP device's user mode are exactly the same.
11-13
Chapter 11
Application Name
It is the name (bundle-name) declared in a statement within the application program. It may not necessarily be identical to the name of the program.
Application ID/System Application Name
In the case of a system application, it will be the file name. If a general application, it is the application ID (application-ID) declared in a statement within the ap-
plication program. Within the device, the applications are set apart by means of their application IDs.
Application Version
It is the version of the application (bundle-version) declared in a statement within the application program.
Status
It indicates the status of the application in question; specifically,
Installed: the application has been installed.
Active: the application is being in use.
Resolved: the application is at rest.
Installed On
It indicates the date on which the application was installed.
Vendor
It is the name of the vendor that developed the application, and is the name (bundle-vendor) declared in a statement within the application program.
License Status
It indicates the status of the license; specifically,
None: no license is needed.
Not Installed: no license has been installed.
Installed: the appropriate license has been installed.
Invalid: the license has been invalidated.
Overlimt: the license has been used beyond its permitted limit.
Counter Value
It is the current counter reading of a specific counter. If the status of the license is 'none', this item will not be printed.
Registered Service
It is a list of services that have been registered by the application with the MEAP framework. Some services may not have printable data.
Important:
- To install an application, the user needs to use the following URL when accessing the license control system to obtain a license file. In doing so, he/she needs
to register the license access number of the application and the serial number of the device.
http://www.canon.com/meap/
- To install an application, the user needs to use the following URL when accessing the license control system to obtain a license file. In doing so, he/she needs
to register the license access number of the application and the serial number of the device.
- The applications that can be installed are 20 pieces or less. (In iR5020/iR6020/iR2220/iR3320/iR3320, one is the Portal Service already installed at time of
shipment from the factory.)
- The following list shows the resources and their sizes or numbers that the MEAP functions can use. The values are for reference purpose only and actual values
vary among system configurations, login or authentication services, and device models.
T-11-12
1) Long on to SMS.
11-14
Chapter 11
F-11-25
3) Check that Install Application/License page appears.
4) Click Browse button, and select the application file and the license file of the application; then, click OK button.
Memo:
Application File: identified by the extension "jar".
License File: identified by the extension "lic".
F-11-26
5) See the message "Installing...Please wait a moment."
F-11-27
Important:
- You cannot install only the license.
- You will not be able to install the application without using the appropriate license. Be sure to select its license file.
- If you are adding a license to an existing application, see 1.3.10 Adding a License File.
11-15
Chapter 11
- If you are updating an existing application, stop the application; then, install the new application or its license file. You will not be able to update an application
while it is running.
F-11-28
7) Some applications show a screen to indicate the terms of agreement. Read the terms, and click OK.
8) Check the message "Installing...Please wait a moment." appears, beginning the installation.
9) Check Application List page appears when the installation is completed.
Important:
To use the application that you have just installed, you must make sure that the application status is Started.
Outline
MEAP Enterprise Service Manager is the PC application utility to perform batch installation, unistallation and management of MEAP application and license files
required for installation of applications, on several MEAP-available devices on network.
The main targets are system administrators in big companies and CANON service engineers (end users of devices do not use).
It is used when customized applications delivered to a certain company needs to be managed collectively.
Previous SMS can manage only one device at a time. This utility reduces the management cost of devices and TCO.
Major functions
Discovery of devices available for MEAP
Discovery of devices available for MEAP on network
Storage of the serial number list of discovered device
Installation of application and license file
Management of application (starting / stopping)
Uninstallation of application
Others
System configuration
MEAP Enterprise Service Manager (MEAP ESM) functions in combination with DIS (DSL Installer Service) installed on the MEAP platform side of the device.
This system can be used only for MEAP-available device with appropriate DIS installed.
(*) When using this system on the firmware for version upgrading on October 2003 or older, version upgrading of the system software on the field device is nec-
essary.
When installing MEAP Enterprise Service Manager (MEAP ESM) of master CD on PC, Microsoft '.NET Framework' v1.0 or v1.1 is necessary. The user should
download it from the Web site of Microsoft.
1) Log on to SMS.
2) On Application List, click the name of the application to which you want to add a license file.
11-16
Chapter 11
F-11-29
3) Check appears.
4) On Application/License Information page, click License Management button.
F-11-30
5) Click Browse button, and select the license file you want to install.
11-17
Chapter 11
F-11-31
6) Click Install button.
F-11-32
Important:
- To invalidate (or suspend) a license, you must first stop the application in question.
- Once suspended, the status of the license will be 'Not Installed', and its application will no longer be available for use.
- You can later restore a suspended license file as long as you are doing so on the same iR, the device with the same device serial number.
- When replacing the device due to lease up or trouble, use the license for forwarding (See 'License for forwarding').
11-18
Chapter 11
F-11-33
2) Click the name of the application that you want to disable.
F-11-34
3) License File Management page appears. On Application/License Information page, click License Management button.
11-19
Chapter 11
F-11-35
4) Click Disable button.
F-11-36
5) Click OK.
You must remove the invalidated license file before uninstalling an application. If re-installation is a possibility, you may download the license file to a PC for
storage. To download or delete a license file, first disable it.
Important:
- Once you have removed an invalidated license file, you will no longer be able to download it form the MEAP device.
1) Login to SMS.
3) On Application List page, click the name of the application you want.
11-20
Chapter 11
F-11-37
4) Check Application/License Information page appears.
F-11-38
6) License File Management page appears. To download, click Download button.
11-21
Chapter 11
F-11-39
7) When you have selected Download button, specify where you want to store the file by following the instructions on the screen.
8) To delete, click Delete button.
F-11-40
Important:
- Without the license file, an application cannot be reinstalled even to the MEAP device that the application had been installed last time. Download and save
the license file before deleting the application.
Reinstallation was not able to perform for all license files. When reinstalling, Disable License file should be downloaded (see 'Disabling a License File' and 'Down-
loading / Removing an Invalidated License File' in this manual) or a license for reinstallation should be obtained from LMS, before reinstallation.
This specification aims to prevent misuse of applications.
To increase convenience of users, only application with unlimited validity date and application counter (e.g. Portal Service, SDL, SSO) has been made to be able
to install as many times as needed by the same license file. This kind of license is called 'Reusable license'.
Memo:
For devices for System version of 33.01, 54.02 (iR 2220 series / iR5020 series) or older, version upgrading is required. It is already installed in the model with
iR C3220 or newer.
11-22
Chapter 11
When the device is replaced due to lease up or trouble, it is possible to continue using the current license information of MEAP application by forwarding it to a
new device. The license is forwarded by CE because the hidden page of SMS is used.
1) Log in to SMS, stop the application to be forwarded (see 'Starting and Stopping a MEAP Application' in this manual).
F-11-41
2) Move to the download page of license forwarded for the device as sender (http:// IP address of device: 8000/sms/ForwardLicense).
F-11-42
F-11-43
11-23
Chapter 11
F-11-44
F-11-45
6) Icon of license file for forwarding is displayed in the box of license file downloading. Click 'Download'.
F-11-46
11-24
Chapter 11
F-11-47
F-11-48
9) After downloading the license file for forwarding, click 'Delete' to display the confirmation screen and click 'OK' to delete the file (in consideration of breakage
of license for forwarding, deleting disabled license can be executed after all steps have been completed).
F-11-49
Memo:
When requesting issuance of license for forwarding, inform the sales company of the name of product name and serial No. of the device as sender, and of the
name of product name and serial No. of the forwarding destination.
12) Install application using the license for forwarding issued by the sales company.
3) On the application list, select the radio button of the application you want to uninstall, and click 'Uninstall' button.
Memo:
Dimmed Uninstall button shows that the selected application cannot be removed.
11-25
Chapter 11
F-11-50
4) Check the screen to make sure that what is shown is the application you want to uninstall; then, click OK button.
In response, the system runs an uninstall sessions.
Important:
- The status of the license must be 'Not Installed' or 'Unnecessary' for its application to be uninstalled. As necessary, go to License File Management page, and
disable the license file before starting to remove it.
- A license file may be invalidated only when its application is not active.
- If the application you are uninstalling is associated with another application, a message will appear to indicate that the package exported by the application will
no loner be available. Uninstalling such an application may also disable its associated applications.
At time of shipment, the login service offers the following 3 modes of authentication:
- Default authentication
- SDL (Simple Device Login)
- SSO (Single Sign-On)
Important:
- To set SDL, the registered information in SDL and the registered user data (Department ID and Password) in Department ID Management of the machine have
to match.
- To set up SDL or SSO, Department ID Management must be set to Off in advance. To use SDL and Department ID Management simultaneously, set
Department ID Management to On after switching the login service to SDL.
- If SSO is set as the login service, NetSpot Accountant is necessary for using Department ID Management.
- If SSO is set, you cannot use an optional card reader.
- To set to SSO, first adjust the current time for the PC where Active Directory is running, the iR, and the PC where users log on. If there is more than a 30-
minute difference among them, an error occurs at logon.
- If SSO or SDL is set as login service, it takes time until the iR is ready to start up.
- When the SEND function is used in the environment of SDL and SSO, it is necessary to set each user's mail address to transmit E-mail. When the mail address
is not set, E-mail cannot be transmitted. However, when i-Fax is transmitted, the mail address set to the device is used.
a. it brings up the Login screen on the MEAP device's touch panel display for user authentication.
b. it brings up the Login page when you access the MEAP device from Web browser to manage the numbers of printed and scanned sheets for each department ID
working with the department ID management function. it operates in conjunction with the group ID control mechanisms to keep track of the number of print
pages or scan pages according to group IDs.
c. it enables register/editing of user authentication information through a Web browser.
11-26
Chapter 11
F-11-51
- The three user authentication systems can be changed at Web browser (See 'Setting the User Authentication System' on MEAP Administrator Guide).
- The default setting is 'Domain Authentication + Local Device Authentication'. To increase security, set 'Domain Authentication' as user authentication system
or change the user name and password of the administrator of Local Device Authentication from the default ones, just after starting to use SSO.
Domain Anthentication
This is the authentication of the domains on network simultaneously with log-in to iR device, in combination with the domain controller on Active Directory envi-
ronment network. It authenticates up to four domain users (multi domain) with trusts as well as the domain with iR device installed. Users select the domain name
of log-in destination when they log in.
Optional NetSpot Accountant or imageWARE Accounting Manager enables analysis / management of the usage of iR device.
Domain A Domain B
Domain Domain
NetSpot Security Agent Controller Controller
Accountant (Active Directory) (Active Directory)
F-11-52
- Optional NetSpot Accountant or imageWARE Accounting Manager is necessary to use Domain Authentication and department ID management
simultaneously. When Domain Authentication is set without combination with NetSpot Accountant or imageWARE Accounting Manager, log-in is impossible.
11-27
Chapter 11
Therefore, department ID management should not be 'ON'. If department ID management is set to 'ON' while using Domain Authentication and log-in becomes
impossible, change the log-in service to Default Authentication and turn department ID management to [OFF].
- For combination with NSA / iWAM, it is necessary to set the user with administrative privilege of the domain on the SA service account.
- When the print count and scan count for each department ID needs to be managed in conjunction with Local Device Authentication and department ID
management, turn department ID management to [ON]. To use simultaneously Local Device Authentication and department ID management, the information
registered with Local Device Authentication should be matched with the user information of department ID management (department ID and password).
- The user information registered by SDL and the one by Local Device Authentication are managed separately in the iR device. The user information registered
in one system is not reflected to the other.
- The card reader for optional control card cannot be used for Local Device Authentication. When using the card reader for control card, set SDL.
- Security Agent is necessary only for Domain Authentication.
- Security Agent should be installed on the computer in the domain with iR device installed.
- Installation of Security Agent is included in MEAP Administrator CD-ROM.
Operating Environment
The operation is guaranteed for SDL or SSO if the system environment is in keeping with the following requirements:
Important:
- If you use Internet Explorer 6 on Windows XP, you will need Java 2 Runtime Environment Standard Edition 1.3.1.
SSO
To use SSO, you must have a Widows server to which Active Directory has been installed as well as Security Agent.
Operating System
Microsoft Windows 2000 Professional
Microsoft Windows 2000 Server
Microsoft Windows XP Professional
Microsoft Windows Server 2003
When using SA on WindowXP SP2, it is necessary to exclude Security Agent from the targets of firewall at the setting of the firewall.
b. Others
Access right to Windows 2000 domain Name System (DNS)Access right to domain controller
For combination with NetSpot Accountant / iW Accounting Manager, and department ID management is turned on to use it, it is necessary to set the user with
administrative privilege of the domain on the SA service account.
b. Others
Access right to Windows 2000 Domain Name System (DNS)
Access right to Domain Controller Client
11-28
Chapter 11
F-11-53
2) A page will appear showing the various selections you can make for the login service. Select the radio button of the login service mode you want to use; then,
click Select button.
F-11-54
3) When login service application you have selected turns to Start after Restart, turn off the device's main power, and turn it back on after 10 seconds.
F-11-55
11-29
Chapter 11
2) Click Login button leaving Password field blank or entering incorrect password. The Return to install Password Settings area appears. Click Browse button
and select the switch license file prepared in advance.
F-11-56
3) When you click Initialize button, the confirmation message appears. Click OK button. Then Login page opens. Enter the default password 'MeapSmsLogin' to
log in. The password is case-sensitive.
If you click Cancel button, the Login page opens without initializing the password.
11.1.22 Creating a Backup for MEAP Application Area, Formatting the Hard Disk, Restoring the MEAP Application Area with
the Backup, Using the SST (Service Support Tool)
0014-8088
If you use the SST's backup function, you will be able to temporarily put aside the area of MEAP applications, thus being free of the foregoing extra work. This
function, however, is limited to a specific MEAP device (serial number), and cannot be used for illegal copying of applications.
You must not perform any other work (including checking operation) until the HDD has been backed up. This arrangement is to prevent a mismatch of MEAP
counter readings and the HDD contents, and any fault in operation arising as the result of failure to observe this will not be covered by the guarantee of operation.
Memo:
The application that is installed with a reusable license can be reinstalled by using the same license.
The following list shows the details of area that SST backs up;
Jar files of MEAP applications
Settings set with MEAP applications.
Note that SST does not back up images in Mailboxes that MEAP applications use.
User information data registered with SDL
2) SST Version
Version 1.81 or later. An earlier version will not permit the use of the function. If needed, upgrade the SST.
11-30
Chapter 11
To back up the HDD of the iR, the PC must have approx 300 MB of free space at maximum.
Making a Backup and Formatting Hard Disk Drive with Service Support Tool
1) If SDL or SSO is used for the login service, switch to default authentication before backing up the user information. Although SST will back up SDL user
information, it is recommended to export the user information just in case. For SDL user information backup, go to User Management page of Simple Device
Login site and export the data. (The SDL login page opens with the URL "http://<device IP address>:8000/sdl/").
If a hard disk of a system that uses SDL or SSO is formatted without changing the login service to the default authentication, the error message "The login service
must be set again with SMS" appears and the system cannot start up when you attempt to restart the system after formatting. If this problem occurs, change the
login service to SDL or SSO with SMS. If you cannot access to SMS since you do not have the IP address of the device, start the system with FIXIP mode -
hold down the numeric keys 1 and 7 and turn the power switch on. The IP address "172.16.1.100" will be automatically assigned for the device. Then log in to
SMS specifying the address.
2) While holding down the 2 and 8 buttons, start up the device in download mode.
As in the case of Sramimg.bin, the function is available only when the device is in Download Mode.
3) Connect the PC to the device and start the Service Support Tool.
4) In Download/Upload session of SST, select the appropriate device model, System in the tree view, and take necessary steps to connect to the device.
6) Click the option "Meapback.bin" from Name list of Backup Data Available for Selection, and click Start Storing button.
Selecting Meapback.bin
F-11-57
7) When the data has been generated, enter an appropriate name in File name field and click Save button; then, click OK button to end the backup session.
8) In Selecting Model/Unit screen, select HDFormat and start formatting. All the partitions in the hard disk drive will be formatted.
2) To restore the backup "Meapback.bin," click Download the Backup Data button.
3) Select the backup data file and click Start Writing button to download the backup data. Note that SST cannot restore backup data created with a different version.
F-11-58
4) When the screen with OK button appears, the restoration of backup data finishes. Click OK button.
11-31
Chapter 11
5) Reboot the main power and access the device with SMS and check that the MEAP applications are restored.
6) Restore non-MEAP backup data and settings that are saved before formatting the hard disk drive. The SDL user information is included in the backup data. You
do not have to restore it.
If you must replace the hard disk drive because of a fault, all MEAP application files stored on it will also be lost, requiring you to re-install the applications and
their license files in addition to performing the normal work associated with the replacement of the hard disk.
Like other counter information, MEAP counter information will remain after replacement. Reinstallation of MEAP applications calls for special license files de-
signed to continue with the current counter readings, thus enabling the use of the applications until the date of their expiration. These special licenses are service
tools, and are not offered to general users.
If you cannot make a backup of the license files as hard disk suffers a fault, contact the support staff of the regional headquarters of Canon telling the device serial
number and the names of MEAP applications installed to the device to obtain the necessary special license files.
In the support departments of regional headquarters of Canon, all license files of the applications that have been issued are filed according to device serial numbers,
enabling you to obtain a series of license files through a single screen as long as you can identify the serial number of the device in question.
The following shows the steps to follow after you have obtained a special license from the support staff of the regional headquarters of Canon.
1) Copy the set of special license files on the PC you are using for service work.
Register the following with the Service Support Tool (SST): system file, language file, remote UI file, hard disk drive format file, MEAP contents file. (Be sure
to pay attention to the version compatibility of individual files.)
2) Have the new hard disk drive at hand and replace it on site.
While holding down the 2 and 8 keys at the same time, turn on the main power so that the machine will start up in download mode. The IP address 172.16.1.100
will automatically be used, which enables you to download files in high speed through a network.)
3) Using the SST, format the new HDD, and install the System, MEAP Contents, Language, and Remote UI files.
4) When the device has started normally, obtain the jar files of the MEAP applications from the user, and install them using the license files of the applications in
the same way as you would when installing them for the first time.
5) As necessary, make login service selections and import user information.
Memo:
If you format the hard disk without uninstalling MEAP applications, always reinstall the applications previously installed. Unless reinstalling them, lots for the
MEAP counters the applications use will not be released. The message "The number of applications that can be installed has exceeded the limit. Try to install
this application after uninstalling other applications." may appear and the device does not accept to install new application. To install new applications, once
reinstall the applications installed before formatting and uninstall unnecessary applications.
If default authentication has been selected, the mode of authentication remains valid; otherwise, the message "The login service must be set again with SMS" ap-
pears. Change the login service as necessary.
4) Press USER.
6) Press MEAPSAFE.
11-32
Chapter 11
F-11-59
7) Press the 1 key on the control panel keypad to change the setting to '1'; then, click OK button.
F-11-60
8) Check that the notation 'MPSF' has appeared in the lower right corner of the screen; then, turn off and then on the main power.
F-11-61
If you want to end safe mode, repeat the steps but change '1' to '0' in step -7 and turn off and then on the main power.
For the ports in which the MEAP application uses, the default is 8000 for the port on HTTP server, and 8443 for the port on HTTPS server. In the case that these
ports have already used by the customer who is to introduce this application, the MEAP application cannot use the HTTP (or HTTPS) server(s).
By changing the following ports to use, however, the MEAP application can be used as well as the existing system.
HTTP server
Setting value is 0 through 65535 [the value at factory shipment/after clearing RAM: 8000]
HTTPS server
Setting value is 0 through 65535 [the value at factory shipment/after clearing RAM: 8443]
Memo:
-As for port on HTTPS server, it only applies to the device that supports SSL function.
-Make sure not to use 1 through 1023 other than 80 (HTTP) as a port for MEAP. Because the ports in this range are used by general servers, there is a possibility
that the ports in this range will be duplicated in the future.
11-33
Chapter 11
F-11-62
8) Press the port number to specify on the control panel (the numerical value input in the field is displayed), and press [OK] button.
F-11-63
9) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and turn off the main power, and then, turn on the main power.
F-11-64
11-34
Chapter 11
F-11-65
8) Press the port number to specify on the control panel (the numerical value input in the field is displayed), and press [OK] button.
F-11-66
9) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and turn off the main power, and then, turn on the main power.
F-11-67
11-35
Chapter 11
Glossary
T-11-17
11-36
Chapter 11
LicenseFile-Version: 1
License File ID
LicenseFile-Id: f6489a8c-8c7e-4d74-bd12-b031ea6a62a5
Application-Id: e92b0b91-7c42-45b1-96b3-295d5d1b5877 Application ID
Serial-No: XYZ00123
Serial No
Validated-Period: 100
MaximumBWScan1: 1000, stop Validated Period
MaximumBWScan2: 900, stop
MaximumBWScan3: 800, stop
MaximumBWScan4: 700, stop
MaximumPrintedImpressions: 1000, stop
MaximumPrintedImpressions-BW: 800, stop Counter information
MaximumPrintedImpressions-BW-Large: 200, stop
MaximumPrintedImpressions-BW-Small: 600, stop
MaximumScannedImpressions: 2000, stop
MaximumScannedImpressions-BW: 1200, stop
IxQvZ/A8O0aDsUBdMeu5XrxqIsqLzq7JAjHAD/ZMnNxVMsR7RGcuI2c6RRdU7mlW
ht2VF8LA3SH6n4kxvZYmEQZ8pBhu67wliysAJ0gHS0l6WsMqX6WI5ZAQeD8TZnnf
344VXYG4
F-11-68
Default value
1: display
Setting Procedure
1) Startup [SERVICE MODE] (After pressing [USER MODE] button of MEAP device, press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel. Then by
pressing [USER MODE] button again, [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed).
2) Press [COPIER] button.
3) Press [Option] button.
4) Press [BODY] button.
5) Press [<-]or[->] (arrow) button.
6) Press [UI-COPY] button.
7) Press either 0 (hide) or 1 (display) on control panel (the numerical value input in the field is displayed), and press [OK] button.
8) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and turn off the main power, and then, turn on the main power.
Memo:
Part of the warning screens is displayed if shifting to the device screen.
- As for the screens for jam and no-toner, the warning screen (animation) can be displayed by pressing the followings: [Device Screen] > [Recovery Procedure]
- As for the screen for door opening, the warning screen cannot be displayed because there is no display for [[Device Screen] > [Recovery Procedure]
Default value
1: No activation of warning display
Setting Procedure
1) Startup [SERVICE MODE] (After pressing [USER MODE] button of MEAP device, press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel. Then by
pressing [USER MODE] button again, [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed).
2) Startup level 2 of [SERVICE MODE] (After starting up [SERVICE MODE] in step 1, press [USER MODE] button again. Then, by pressing [2] button on control
panel, the screen is displayed.
3) Press [COPIER] button.
4) Press [Option] button.
5) Press [BODY] button.
6) Press [<-]or[->] button.
11-37
Chapter 11
Default value
0: OFF (transit to Native screen)
Setting Procedure
1) Startup [SERVICE MODE] (After pressing [USER MODE] button of MEAP device, press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel. Then,
by pressing [USER MODE] button again, [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed).
2) Startup level 2 of [SERVICE MODE] (After starting up [SERVICE MODE] in step 1, press [USER MODE] button again. Then, by pressing [2] button on control
panel, the screen is displayed.
3) Press [COPIER] button.
4) Press [Option] button.
5) Press [BODY] button.
6) Press [<-] (arrow) button.
7) Press [ANIM-DSP] button.
8) Press either 0 (transit to Native screen) or 1 (no-transition to Native screen) on control panel (the numerical value input in the field is displayed), and press [OK]
button.
9) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and turn off the main power, and then, turn on the main power.
11-38
Chapter 12 RDS
Contents
Contents
12.1 RDS
Serviceman selects the operation mode of OFF/ON by the setting in e-RDS setting screen of the service mode. (Menu Screen: E-RDS)
- OFF (default): e-RDS doesn't operate.
- ON: e-RDS operates every function.
The URL and the port number of the equipment information destination can be specified as follows.
- Default (specified beforehand)
- Specified by the service mode. (Menu Screen: RGW-ADR, RGW-PORT)
Serviceman can distinguish the communication status with the UGW by executing the communication test in the service mode (Menu Screen: COM-TEST), and
referring to the communication log
Error information is displayed in the latest communication log at communication error.
The list of the log of the communication error (proxy server error etc.)(For 30) can be displayed in display panel in the service mode. (Menu Screen: COM-LOG)
The following processing is achieved by the SOAP communication (SSL client communication).
e-RDS does the host authentication by using the CA*1 certificate of the VeriSign Co..
When the host certificate or the CA certificate is expired, e-RDS doesn't connect to UGW.
*1: CA: Certificate Authority: Organization that issues electronic certificate used by electronic commerce etc
(3) When jam or alarm/service call error is detected from the device, e-RDS transmits to UGW.
- Transmission of alert code(Counter information is transmitted at the same time. )
When the state of the device changes, e-RDS sends the alert code list.
The main alert codes used are Toner LOW/OUT, Jam, and Door open.
When recovering from an error, e-RDS transmits data that shows the recovering from an error again.
- Transmission of Jam log (Counter information is transmitted at the same time.)
- Transmission of Alarm log (Counter information is transmitted at the same time.)
- Transmission of Service Call (Error code) log (Counter information is transmitted at the same time.)
List of Transmissions:
Content of transmission Transmission timing
Communication test When Service mode of device is executed
Copy counter collection/transmission Every 6 hours
Service mode counter collection/transmission Every 6 hours
Mode counter collection/transmission Every 6 hours
Parts counter collection/transmission Every 6 hours
ROM version transmission Every 6 hours
Application log When the log file size exceeds 10kbytes
12-1
Chapter 12
When SOAP send error is generated by the trouble on UGW side etc. at the transmission of an alert code, the latest three batches of data that failed in the transmission
are stored in HDD, and e-RDS resends it at prescribed intervals.
Menu Screen
F-12-1
Setting screen of e-RDS. The form and the initial value of each setting item are as follows.
Item(meaning) Explanation
E-RDS Turning OFF/ON e-RDS. 0:OFF / 1:ON
(Embedded-RDS) Counter information and error information are transmitted to the host at ON.
Initial value: 0: OFF
RGW-ADR URL of the host (When the input area is selected (touched), shift to the keyboard screen)
(RDS-Gateway ADDRESS) Initial value: URL of an actual host.
Length: 129 characters (NULL is contained)
RGW-PORT Port Number of the host
(RDS-Gateway PORT) Initial value: 443
Range of available number: 1-65535
COM-TEST Execution of Communication test
(Communication Test) Communication test starts when you select (touch) this and press the [OK] key.
e-RDS tries the connection with the host, and displays the result by "OK!" or "NG!". (NG: No Good, the
communication test is failed)
12-2
Chapter 12
Item(meaning) Explanation
COM-LOG The result of communication test
(Communication Log) When this is selected (touched), and the blank rectangle on right side is selected, it switches to "Log list
screen".
F-12-2
History list of communication test error (error generation date, error code and error information) is displayed.
When the each line is selected (touched), it shifts to "Log detailed screen".
It shifts to "Menu screen" by the [Function] > [INSTALL].
The list screen changes by a right arrow or a left arrow.
Maximum log number: 30
Notes: Only the first part of error information is displayed.
12-3
Chapter 12
F-12-3
Detailed information of individual communication test error is displayed.
Refer to the displayed message to "Error message list".
It shifts to "Log list screen" by the [OK] button pressing.
Maximum length of error information: 128 characters (not include NULL)
When there is a method that should be transmitted while e-RDS is operating (ON), e-RDS wakes from the state of sleep and begins transmitting.
You should do the network setting of Device appropriately before the e-RDS setting.
A. Display the Additional Functions screen.
- Press [Additional Functions (*)] key.
- Input ID code.
B. Display the TCP/IP Settings screen.
- Select (touch) [System Settings] > [Network Settings] > [TCP/IP Settings] on the Touch Panel Display.
C. Setting of items related to IP address
- Select (touch) [IP Address Settings] => IP Address Settings screen is displayed.
- Set each items such as IP Address, Subnet Mask, Gateway Addresses, and DHCP, etc.
- Return to the TCP/IP Settings screen by pushing the [OK] button after the setting ends.
D. DNS Settings
- Select (touch) [DNS Settings] => DNS Settings screen is displayed.
- Set necessary items.
- Return to the TCP/IP Settings screen by pushing the [OK] button after the setting ends.
E. Proxy Settings
- Select (touch) [Proxy Settings] (Press Down arrow button until [Proxy Settings] is displayed on the TCP/IP Settings screen.) => Proxy Settings screen is
displayed.
- Set necessary items.
- Return to the TCP/IP Settings screen by pushing the [OK] button after the setting ends.
F. Display the normal screen.
- Press [Additional Functions (*)] key pressing or press [Done] button to a necessary frequency.
12-4
Chapter 12
F-12-4
B. Set 1 in [E-RDS].
C. Input the URL of UGW in [RGW-ADR]. (Select the input area to shift to the keyboard screen, and Input URL.)
D. Input the port number of UGW in [RGW-PORT].
E. Select [COM-TEST] and push [OK] button to start the communication test with UGW.
F. While the result is "NG!", repeat to correct the setting and try [COM-TEST] until the result becomes "OK!". You need checking the setting of the network of the
device and the connection of the network if necessary.
Notes: In the environment with the proxy server, you should set the proxy server. Refer to the proxy setting in the network guide of the device for details.
1-1
Q. There is no setting item.
A. Confirm the network setting.
Confirm the model
1-2
Q. The communication test fails.
A. Confirm the firmware version.
Confirm the network setting.
Confirm the communication test result.
Error information displayed in "Log list screen" or "Log detailed screen" is as follows.
Notes: Only the first part of error information is displayed in "Log list screen". Maximum length of error information in "Log detailed screen": 128 characters (not
include NULL)
When the communication test is not completed end e-RDS is 1 (ON), following string is displayed:
"SUSPEND: Communication test is not performed."
Moreover, when it fails in the event waiting in the device and either of a Jam notification, an Alarm notification, and a Service call notification or an Alert notifi-
cation is specified, following string is displayed.
12-5
Chapter 12
[*]:
*(asterisk) is added to the head of the string only at the communication test.
[Error string]:
As for number 1 and 2 of the following Error string lists, only the Error string is displayed. Besides, it is displayed as "[*] [Error string]: [Method name]
[Server side detailed error]". ([Server side detailed error] might not go out.)
12-6
Chapter 13 Maintenance and Inspection
Contents
Contents
13.1.1 Overview
0014-3050
Some parts of the machine must be replaced on a periodical basis so as to ensure a specific level of performance. They may be free of external changes or damage,
but they can significantly affect the machine performance once they lose their function.
It is best if replacement work is scheduled to coincide with a scheduled visit to the user's.
The values indicated herein are estimates only and are subject to change depending on the site environment and how the machine is used.
The machine's reader unit does not have parts that must be replaced on a periodical basis.
The machine's printer unit does not have parts that must be replaced on a periodical basis.
13.2.1 Outline
0014-3053
Some parts of the machine may require replacement once or more over the life of the product because of deterioration or damage. Replace them as needed by re-
ferring to the guide.
Find Out When to Replace
Use the following service mode to find out when it is best to replace a specific durable part.
- Copier
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1
- Option
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
The reader unit does not have parts that are designated as "durables."
T-13-1
Replacement
No. Parts name Parts Number Quantity
Timing
Fixing Film Unit (100V) FM3-1992 1 150,000
1 Fixing Film Unit (120V) FM3-1993 1 150,000
Fixing Film Unit (230V) FM3-1994 1 150,000
2 Pressure Roller FC7-4453 1 150,000
3 bearing XG9-0172 2 150,000 Pressurizing roller and exchange
simultaneously
4 ITB Unit FM2-5522 1 300,000
5 Transfer Cleaner Unit FM2-5523 1 150,000
6 Secondary Transfer Roller FC7-7387 1 300,000
7 Transfer Separation Guide FM2-9971 1 300,000
8 Cassette Feed Roller FF6-2058 1 120,000
9 Cassette Separation Roller FC6-6661 1 120,000
10 Manual Feed Pickup Roller FB1-8581 1 240,000
11 Manual Feed Separation Pad FL2-4453 1 240,000
12 Waste Toner Box FM2-5533 1 200,000 5% image ratio and 100% color image
ratio.
13 Dust-blocking glass cleaning pad FL2-4425 1 125,000
14 Dust-proofing filter FC6-9549 1 100,000
MEMO:
The estimated life is in terms of the median value found in the evaluation data. The parts number, further, is subject to change to reflect design changes.
13-1
Chapter 13
[3]
[4]
[2]
[3]
[10]
[1]
[5]
[11]
[7]
[14]
[6]
[8]
[12] [13]
[9]
F-13-1
13-2
Chapter 13
[3]
[4]
[2]
[3]
[10]
[1]
[5]
[11]
[7]
[14]
[6]
[8]
[12] [13]
[9]
F-13-2
<Work Procedure>
1) Report to the person in change, and have an understanding of the situation.
2) Record the counter reading, and check the faulty prints.
3) Check the following items, and adjust or clean the parts as needed.
T-13-2
Item
Test copy image density
background (for soiling)
characters (for clarity)
margin
fixing misregistration, soiled back
margin (single-sided) leading edge:2.5±1.5mm
left:2.5±1.5mm
margin (double-sided) leading edge:2.5±2.0mm
left edge:2.5±2.0mm
Laser exposure system dust-blocking glass (cleaning)
Feeding system toner/feed guide
fixing inlet guide
13-3
Chapter 13
Item
Developing system developing butting spacer
- When disposing of the waste toner, be sure to follow all applicable regulations of the local government.
- Do not dispose of waste toner in fire. (Doing so can cause an explosion.)
The machine's reader unit does not have items that must be serviced on a scheduled basis.
Be sure to clean the copyboard glass and the ADF reading glass during each visit you make for scheduled servicing.
T-13-3
[1]Feed guide
[2]Secondary transfer
iner delivery roller guide
13-4
Chapter 13
[2]
Clean the part only when dirt is conspicuous.
1) Slide the sensor shutter unit [1] in the direction of the arrow.
2) Wipe after extracting firmly the cloth which wet the sensor [2] with water.
13-5
Chapter 13
[1]Feeding roller
[2]scraping ring
The above values are estimates only, and are subject to change according to future data.
13-6
Chapter 14 Standards and Adjustments
Contents
Contents
Be sure to enter the values indicated on the CIS label attached to the contact
image sensor (CIS) using the following service mode items:
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>CCDU-RG
(offset value against color displacement caused by CIS)
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>MTF-MG
(MTF correction value for main scanning direction)
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>MTF-SG
(MTF correction value for sub scanning direction)
-04
BOOK-RG
F-14-3
Enter the value indicated by the bar code found on the ADF reading glass
using the following service mode item:
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>DF-RG
(offset value against color displacement caused by stream reading glass)
-012 72 70
CCDU-RG MTF-SG
MTF-MG
F-14-1
Also, be sure to update the values indicated on the service label attached be-
hind the reader left cover by the values indicated on the CIS label.
Reference: 002
The machine is not shipped out of the factory with the CIS label attached to
it.
DF-RG
14.1.2 After Replacing the Copyboard Glass
0014-3111
- Before replacing the reader controller PCB, be sure to generate the latest P-
PRINT printout.
- If you carry out the power ON and the copier returns to the standby
condition after the controller circuit PCB replacement, turn ON/OFF the
power supply once again.
<if you are initializing the RAM of the reader controller without replacing
the PCB>
- Using the SST, upload the reader controller backup data; after initializing
the RAM, download the data, thus eliminating the need for the following
adjustment.
14-1
Chapter 14
DF-RG BOOK-RG
F-14-6
When replacing the laser scanner unit, register the values described on the
label which is included in the package in the service modes below. After reg-
istration, attach the label onto the front cover.
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-Y1 to 8
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-M1 to 8
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-C1 to 8
COPIER > FUNCTION > LASER > FSLUT-K1 to 8
W- P LT- X W- P LT- Z Registration of the main scanner reproduction ratio correction value
W- P LT- Y
F-14-5 14.3 Image Formation System
d. service label (behind reader unit left cover) values
14.3.1 After Replacing the Secondary Transfer Roller
d-1. CIS read position adjustment (fixed reading) 0014-3128
1) Enter the values indicated in the P-PRINT printout you have previously / / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880
generated for the following:
a. main scanning direction position adjustment (stream reading) Executed the following item of the service mode, and measure the nip width.
COPIER>ADJSUT>ADJ-XY>ADJ-Y-DF COPIER>FUNCTION>FIXING>NIP-CHK
b. original stop position adjustment *:The sheet stops temporarily at the fixing unit and it is delivered.
FEEDER>ADJSUT>DOCST
c. original feed speed (magnification) adjustment Standard of the nip width
FEEDER>ADUST>LA-SPEED Center part: 8mm or more
Difference of right and left edge: 1mm or less
14-2
Chapter 14
<if you are initializing the RAM of the reader controller without replacing b. original stop position adjustment
the PCB> FEEDER>ADJSUT>DOCST
- Using the SST, upload the reader controller backup data; after initializing c. original feed speed (magnification) adjustment
the RAM, download the data, thus eliminating the need for the following FEEDER>ADUST>LA-SPEED
adjustment.
DF-RG BOOK-RG
F-14-8
After mounting the main controller PCB (main), mount each PCB that is re-
moved before the replacement.
[1] Main Controller PCB (Sub R-A)
[2] Main Controller PCB (Sub PDEM-EF-A)
[3] Main Controller PCB (Sub SJ-A)
[4] Main Controller PCB (Sub LANBAR-C)
[5] Storage of program for BOOT ROM BOOT
[6] SRAM PCB
[7] DDR-SDRAM
[8] Main Controller PCB (Sub RB-A)
[9] HDD
W- P LT- X W- P LT- Z
W- P LT- Y
F-14-7 [1]
d. service label (behind reader unit left cover) values [2]
d-1. CIS read position adjustment (fixed reading) [2]
COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY>ADJ-X
d-2. main scanning direction position adjustment (fixed reading) [3]
COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY>ADJ-Y
d-3. shading position adjustment (fixed reading) [9]
COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY>ADJ-S
d-4. sub scanning direction color displacement correction
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>CCDU-RG [4]
d-5. main/sub scanning direction MTF value
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>MTF-MG,SG
d-6. auto gradation correction target value
COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL>OFST-P-Y,M,C,K [5]
If the value of the following was not 0 before the replacement of the
reader controller PCB: COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CCD-LUT.
Set a value other than '0' once again, and make the following adjustments
using the D-10 Chart.
COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>LUT-ADJ2
2. ADF-Related Adjustment
The machine keeps ADF-related service mode data in the RAM of the [8] [7] [6]
reader controller; as such, you will have to make the appropriate F-14-9
adjustments if you have replaced the reader controller or initialized the
RAM. 14.5.3 When Replacing the SRAM PCB
0014-3121
14-3
Chapter 14
When the SRAM PCB is replaced, all data in its memory will be lost (file-
related, user mode-related, service mode-related, history-related files). There
will be no error operation, and initialization will take place automatically. (–) (+)
If you pull out the SRAM PCB from machine B and mount it to machine A,
the PCB will be initialized and be rendered useless for machine A or B. Take
full care.
1) When you turn on the power after replacing the SRAM PCB, the machine
will perform automatic initialization and will indicate a message on its 0
panel to the effect that you are to turn off and then on the power switch 2
found on its right side. Follow the message and turn off and then on the
machine. 4
2) Using service mode, initialize the RAM.
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>MN-CON 6
8
Before starting the work, be sure to inform the user that all image data stored 10
in the Box will be lost and obtain his/her consent.
2.5±1.5mm
F-14-10
14.5.4 When Replacing the HDD <In the case that the cassette 1, or the cassette 2 is out of specification>
0014-3123
/ / / / iR C3380i / iR C3380 / iR C2880i / iR C2880 1) In the case of the device with the 2-cassette pedestal, detach the cassette
lower right cover [1].
1. If NetSpot Accountant (NSA) Is Not Used 2) Open the cassette upper right cover [2].
1) Formatting the HDD
While holding down the 2 and 8 keys on the control panel, turn on the
power to start up. Using the HD formatting function of the SST, format
all partitions.
2) Downloading the Software
Using the SST, download the various software (system, language, RUI).
The machine will take about 10 min to start up after downloading.
14-4
Chapter 14
F-14-13
F-14-16
A. Making Adjustments for the Cassette 1
A-1) Free the 2 claws [1], and pull the grip (right front) [2] in the direction B-3) Tighten the fixing screw.
of the arrow to detach. B-4) Slide back the cassette 2.
B-5) Make a copy using the cassette 2 as the source of paper; then, check
to see that the margin in the image front direction is 2.5 +/-1.5 mm.
3) Mount back the machine's cassette front right cover.
4) Close the cassette lower right cover and the cassette upper right cover.
(–) (+)
0
2
F-14-14
A-2) Loosen the fixing screw [2] of the adjusting plate [1]. 4
A-3) By referring to the index you took note of in step 5), move the
adjusting plate back and forth. Moving it toward the rear of the machine 6
will increase the margin on the image front.
8
10
2.5±2.0mm
F-14-17
2) If the margin is as indicated, change the adjustment value of the horizontal
registration for the 2nd side for the cassette 1.
- COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C1RE
An increase by '1' will decrease the margin on the front side by 0.1 mm.
3) Enter the adjustment value for the horizontal registration of the 2nd side
for the cassette 1 as the adjustment value for the horizontal registration of
the 2nd side of the cassette 2.
- COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C2RE
4) Make a copy using the cassette 2 as the source of paper; then, check to
make sure that the margin on the front side is 2.5 +/-2.0 mm.
5) If the value is not as indicated, change the adjustment value of the 2nd side
for the cassette 2.
F-14-15 - COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C2RE
An increase by '1' (for DJ-C2RE) will decrease the horizontal registration
A-4) Tighten the fixing screw. on the front side by 0.1 mm.
A-5) Slide in the cassette 1. 6) Record the new values on the service label.
A-6) Make a copy using the cassette 1 as the source of paper; then, check - ADJ-C1RE
to see that the margin in the image front direction is 2.5 +/-1.5 mm. - ADJ-C2RE
A-7) Mount back the grip (front right). 7) Press the Reset key twice to end service mode.
B. Making Adjustments to the Cassette 2
B-1) Loosen the fixing screw [2] of the adjusting plate [1]. 14.6.2 Adjust the Horizontal Registration for the Manual
B-2) By referring to the index you took note of in step 5), move the
adjusting plate back and forth. Moving it toward the rear of the machine Feed Tray
will increase the margin on the image front side. 0014-3126
1. Adjusting the Margin for the Manual Feed Tray (1st side; mechanical
adjustment)
1) Place paper in the manual feed tray. For instructions, see the label attached
to the manual feed tray.
2) Make a copy using the manual feed tray as the source of paper; then, check
to make sure that the margin on the front side is 2.5 +/-1.5 mm.
14-5
Chapter 14
0 0
2 2
4 4
6 6
8 8
10 10
2.5±1.5mm 2.5±2.0mm
F-14-18 F-14-21
- If the value is not as indicated, make the following adjustments: 2) If the value is not as indicated, change the horizontal registration
3) Remove the paper from the manual feed tray. adjustment value for the 2nd side for the manual feed tray.
4) In case the MP side guide plate stopper [1] is attached, slide the knob [2] - COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-MFRE
in the direction of the arrow and unlock the stopper. An increase by '1'(ADJ-MFRE) will decrease the margin on the front side
by 0.1 mm.
3) Record the new adjustment value on the service label.
- ADJ-MFRE
4) Press the Reset key twice to end service mode.
L1
[2]
F-14-19
5) Loosen the 2 fixing screws [1] on the manual feed tray upper cover.
6) With reference to the value you took note of in step 2), move the manual
feed upper cover [2] back and forth. Moving it toward the rear of the image
machine will increase the margin on the front side.
[2]
F-14-22
An increase in REGIST will shift the image toward the leading edge of
the paper.
F-14-23
An increase in RG-REFE will shift the image toward the leading edge of
paper (toward the trailing edge of feed).
14-6
Chapter 15 Correcting Faulty Images
Contents
Contents
- The voltage of the source of power must be as indicated (+/-10%), and the power plug must remain connected day and night. (if the cassette heater is installed.)
- The temperature and humidity of the site must be as indicated, and the site must be away from a water faucet, water boiler, humidifier; moreover, the machine
must not be near a fire or subjected to dust.
- The site must be free of ammonium gas.
- The machine must not be subjected to the direct rays of the sun. As necessary, curtains must be furnished.
- The site must be well ventilated, and its floor must keep the machine level.
- The machine must remain connected to the wall outlet at all times.
- Check if the paper is dry. If moist, try paper fresh out of package.
- Check that the amount of paper placed in the cassette and the manual feed tray is as indicated.
- If transparencies are used, check to see if they are placed in the correct orientation.
- Check the Durables Table, and replace those parts that have reached the end of the indicated lifetimes.
1. Reader Unit
- Check the optical system (contact sensor, white plate, copyboard glass, reading glass) for a scar, dirt, and foreign matter.
- Check the contact sensor unit to see if it moves smoothly. Check its rail for dirt.
- Check the contact sensor for flickering.
- Check the scanner for condensation.
2. Process
- Check the drum unit to see if it is attached properly.
- Check the photosensitive drum for a scar and dirt.
- Check the patch image read sensor window for dirt.
3. Transfer
- Check the secondary transfer outside roller for wear, scar, dirt, and deformation.
- Check the blade of the cleaning unit for a tear, warping, deformation, and stray toner.
4. Fixing
- Check the fixing film/ pressure roller for wear, scar, dirt, and deformation.
- Check the fixing thermistor for an open circuit.
- Check the thermal switch for electrical continuity.
5. Paper Movement
- Check if there is foreign matter such as paper lint.
- Check the pickup/feed/separation roller for a buildup of paper powder, wear, scar, dirt, and deformation.
- Check the registration roller (middle, outside)/paper path roller for wear, scar, dirt, and deformation.
- Check the feed guide for wear, scar, dirt, and deformation.
- Check the paper for a bent leading edge, curling, waving, and moisture.
- As necessary, try transparencies of a type recommended by Canon to see if the problem, if any, is corrected.
6. Machine
- Check if an excess load is imposed on the drive system.
- Check the gears for wear and chipping.
7. Cassette
- Check if the cassettes are fitted properly. Check also to see that the dial is set an appropriate paper size . As necessary, try a normal cassette if the problem, if any,
stops.
- Check the movement of the cassette holding plate is smooth. Check also to see that the holding plate is free of deformation.
- Check if the side guide plate/trailing edge plate inside the cassette are set correctly.
- Check if the cassette heater switch is at the ON side (if a cassette heater is fitted).
8. Service Mode
- Check that the various CCD adjustment values are as indicated on the service label.
(COPIER>ADJUST>CCD>all items)
- Check if registration adjustment is correct.
(COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ>REGIST)
- Check if the machine inside temperature/humidity is the correct reading.
(COPIER>DISPLAY>ANALOG>TEMP/ABS-HUM)
- Check the image read position adjustment is correct.
(COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY>ADJ-X/ADJ-Y)
- Check if the value for ADJUST/OPTION is as indicated on the service label.
- Check if error initialization has been executed.
(COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR)
9. General
- Check the power plug is connected properly.
- Check there is the rated AC voltage at the power outlet.
- Check the sensors, clutches, motors, and solenoids operate normally. Check the connectors for poor contact.
(Be sure to check with the General Timing Chart for reference to power/signal routes.)
- Check the leakage breaker/circuit breaker operates normally.
- Check the wiring for trapping and loose screws.
- Check the external cover are all fitted properly.
- Check the main power switch/control panel power switch are at the ON side.
- Check the power cable/signal cable to accessories are correctly routed.
- Check the cover switch operates normally.
- Check the fuses on the PCBs to see if they have blown.
- Check the user knows how to use the machine correctly.
15.1.5 Others
0014-3018
15-1
Chapter 15
If a machine is brought in from a cold to a warm place, its inside can develop condensation, which will lead to various problems.
(1) condensation on the BD sensor can cause faults associated with E100.
(2) condensation on the dust-blocking glass can cause the images in sub scanning direction to be too light.
(3) condensation on the contact sensor of the reader unit or the copyboard glass can lead to light images.
(4) condensation on the pickup/feed guide can cause faulty paper movement.
If (4) above is noted, be sure to dry wipe the units involved in the feed system.
The same is true of toner cartridges and drum units, i.e., when they are unpacked after being brought in from a cold place. To prevent condensation, advise the user
to leave the package alone (for about 1 to 2 hr) before opening it.
15.2.1 Overview
0013-8865
The machine offers the following 6 types of test prints (TYPE), each designed for identification of a specific type of image fault. The data for these test prints is
prepared by the main controller: if the output of a test print is free of the fault in question, suspect a fault on the BDL/PCL/PS input or the reader unit.
T-15-1
15-2
Chapter 15
Use this test print to check gradation, fogging, white line, and uneven density at the front/rear.
- Gradation
If the 16-gradation[1] is not properly produced, suspect a fault in the drum unit or the laser exposure system.
- Fogging
If fogging is found only in the white area[2], suspect a fault in the drum unit or the laser exposure system.
- White Line
If a white line is found in the image, suspect a fault in the developing system.
- Uneven Density at the Front/Rear
If uneven density is found at the front/rear, suspect a fault in the drum unit, laser exposure system, or transfer system.
[1]
[2]
F-15-1
MEMO:
- You can print out test prints for individual colors by making the following selections in service mode: COPIER>TEST>PG and then COLOR-Y/M/C/K.
- You can also change the density of the test prints by making the following selections in service mode: TEST>PG>DENS>Y/M/C/K.
COLOR-M=1, COLOR-Y/C/K=0
F-15-2
15-3
Chapter 15
Use this text print to check color displacement, right angles, and straight lines.
- Color Displacement
If color displacement is found, suspect a scar in the ITB and a fault in the drum unit.
F-15-3
2.5 1.5mm
2.5 1.5mm
F-15-4
15-4
Chapter 15
F-15-5
Use this test print to check the gray balance, gradation of individual colors (YMCBk), and fogging.
- Gray Balance
Check the grayscale area to see if the densities of all colors are even.
- Gradation
Check the gradation of individual colors (YMCBk) and for any difference in color.
- Fogging
If fogging is found in the white area, suspect a fault in the developing system, a fault in the drum, and poor adjustment of the laser exposure system.
4 colors (YMCK)
3 colors (YMC)
Light area
White White
F-15-6
15-5
Chapter 15
15.3.1 Clutch/Solenoid
<Reader Unit>
The reader unit does not have clutches or solenoids.
<Printer Unit>
SL3A
CL5 SL2A
CL6 SL1A
SL4
SL1
SL2
SL3
CL4
CL3
CL2
CL1
F-15-7
T-15-2
15-6
Chapter 15
15.3.2 Motor
<Reader Unit>
M501
F-15-8
T-15-3
T-15-4
15-7
Chapter 15
<Printer Unit>
M2A
M1A
M14
M3
M7
M1
M15
M2
M6 M13 M11
M4
M10
M5
M9
M8
M12
F-15-9
T-15-5
15-8
Chapter 15
15.3.3 Fan
<Reader Unit>
The reader unit does not have a fan.
<Printer Unit>
FM2
FM1
FM9
FM5
FM7
FM10
FM8
FM6
FM4
FM3
FM11
F-15-10
T-15-6
15-9
Chapter 15
15.3.4 Sensor
<Reader Unit>
PS508
PS507
PS506
PS502
PS501
PS504
PS505
CIS1
PS503
F-15-11
T-15-7
reader
Parts
Ref. Name Description controller
number
PCB
PS501 CIS HP sensor detects CIS home position FH7-7462 J506
detects the state (open/closed) of the
PS502 copyboard cover open/closed sensor (front) FH7-7312 J506
copyboard cover
detects the state (open/closed) of the
PS503 copyboard cover open/closed sensor (rear) FH7-7312 J506
copyboard cover
CIS1 CIS reads originals FM2-1563
SIZE1 original size sensor identifies the size of originals FH7-7569 J511
15-10
Chapter 15
<Printer Unit>
PS30
PS16
PS2
PS10
PS9 PS14
PS7
PS12
PS11
PS4
PS6
PS5
PS3
PS3A PS5A
PS2A
PS1A
PS4A
PS15 PS27
PS28
PS29
PS13
PS1
PS25 PS18
PS8 PS26
PS17 PS19
PS20
PS22
TS4
PS21 TS3
PS23 TS2
PS24 TS1
F-15-12
T-15-8
Parts
DC controller PCB Jam code/ error code
Ref. Description number
PS1 Inner delivery sensor WG8-5772 J223-9 to 11 0103/ 0203/ 0A03/ 0B03
PS2 Loop detection sensor WG8-5772 J217-1 to 3 0104/ 0204/ 0A04/ 0B04
PS3 Toner rotation volume sensor (Y) WG8-5772 J2016 -
PS4 Toner rotation volume sensor (M) WG8-5772 J2011 -
PS5 Toner rotation volume sensor (C) WG8-5772 J2009 -
PS6 Toner rotation volume sensor (K) FK2-0149 J2007 -
PS7 Pre-registration sensor FK2-0149 J216-4 to 6 0210/ 0A10
PS8 Cassette 1 paper absent sensor FK2-0149 J219-A1 to 3 -
PS9 Multi feeder paper absent sensor FK2-0149 J222-A4 to 6 0105/ 0205/ 0A05/ 0A05
PS10 Duplexing paper absent sensor FK2-0149 J222-A7 to 9 0101/ 0201/ 0A01/ 0B01
PS11 Waste toner container absent sensor WG8-5772 J223-12 to 14 0102/ 0202/ 0A02/ 0B02
PS12 Waste toner open/ closed sensor WG8-5772 J2006-1 to 3 -
Fixing pressure releasing home position
PS13 sensor WG8-5772 J2006-4 to 6 0107/ 0207/ 0A07/ 0A07
PS14 Fixing inlet sensor WG8-5772 J217-7 to 9 0108/ 0208/ 0A08/ 0A08
PS15 Delivery tray full detection sensor FK2-0149 J225-B8 to 10 -
15-11
Chapter 15
Parts
DC controller PCB Jam code/ error code
Ref. Description number
PS16 Loop detection sensor 2 WG8-5772 J217-4 to 6 -
PS17 Front door sensor WG8-5772 J213-4 to 6 010D/ 020D/ 0A0D
PS18 Lower right door sensor FK2-0149 J222-B8 to 10 -
PS19 Right door sensor WG8-5772 J213-1 to 3 -
PS20 Cassette 2 paper absent sensor FK2-0149 J219-B1 to 3 -
PS21 Cassette 1 paper level sensor A FK2-0149 J219-A4 to 6 -
PS22 Cassette 1 paper level sensor B FK2-0149 J219-A7 to to 9 -
PS23 Cassette 2 paper level sensor A FK2-0149 J219-B4 to 6 -
PS24 Cassette 2 paper level sensor B FK2-0149 J219-B7 to 9 -
PS25 Cassette 1 re-try sensor FK2-0149 J219-A10 to 12 -
PS26 Cassette 2 re-try sensor FK2-0149 J219-B10 to 12 -
PS27 No. 1 delivery sensor FK2-0149 J225-B5 to 7 -
PS28 Fan shutter home position sensor WG8-5772 J223-18 to 20 -
PS29 Fan shutter position detection sensor WG8-5772 J223-15 to 17 -
2/3 delivery door open/ closed detection
PS30 sensor FK2-0149 J212-5 to 7 -
TS1 Toner sensor (Y) FH7-7422 J2015 -
TS2 Toner sensor (M) FH7-7422 J2017 -
TS3 Toner sensor (C) FH7-7422 J2003 -
TS4 Toner sensor (K) FH7-7422 J2004 -
J744-3 to 5(Extension delivery
FH7-7312
PS1A No. 2 delivery sensor controller PCB) 0109/ 0209/ 0A09/ 0A09
J743-1 to 15 (Extension delivery
FH7-7312
PS2A No.2 delivery tray full detection sensor controller PCB) -
J742-4 to 6 (Extension delivery
FH7-7312
PS3A Duplexing paper inlet sensor controller PCB) 010C/ 020C/ 0A0A/ 0A0C
J745 (Extension delivery controller
FH7-7312
PS4A Reverse sensor PCB) 010A/ 020A/ 0A0B/ 0A0A
J742-9 to 11 (Extension delivery
FH7-7312
PS5A No. 3 delivery sensor controller PCB) 010B/ 020B/ 0A0B
15-12
Chapter 15
15.3.5 Switch
<Reader Unit>
The reader unit does not have a switch.
<Printer Unit>
SW6
SW3
SW4
SW5
SW2 SW1
F-15-13
T-15-9
15-13
Chapter 15
<Reader Unit>
H5
H6
LCD1
F-15-14
T-15-10
LCD1 LCD panel FL2-1148 provides visual indications on the control panel (touch panel)
<Printer Unit>
H1
TH1
TH3
TH2
VR1
TP1
ELCB1
VR2
H4
F-15-15
T-15-11
15-14
Chapter 15
15.3.7 PCBs
<Reader Unit>
[1]
[3]
[2] [4]
[5]
[6]
F-15-16
T-15-12
15-15
Chapter 15
<Printer Unit>
[28]
[18]
[26]
[21]
[22]
[19]
[3] [4] [10]
[20]
[5] [23]
[1]
[29]
[2]
[30]
[31]
[32]
[33]
[7]
[34]
[35]
[13]
[16/ 17]
[6]
[14/ 15]
[11/ 12]
F-15-17
T-15-13
15-16
Chapter 15
15-17
Chapter 15
15.3.8 Connectors
15.3.8.1 Connectors
0014-6796
J5007
J5001 J5006
J5002 J5016
J5017
J501
J500
J504
J5003 J510 J5013
J5005 J511
J5009 J512
J503
J502 J5015
J5010 J505
J5018
J506
J5012
J5011
J5019
J2
J1
J1111
J2117
J1015 J1113
J6801
J2116
J6802
J3
J1114 J1110
J1112
F-15-18
15-18
Chapter 15
J2012
J2016
J5001
J1004
J640
J1003
J202
J2110
J210
J1001
J207
J1002 J208
J214
J2111 J106 J1006
J702 J647
J1035
J218
J703 J1004
J1005 J212
J704
J217
J705
J701 J254
J201 J250
J681
J691 J4002
J692 J4001
J693
J209 J252
J203 J251
J302 J303 J301
J114
J105
J351 J352
J202
J104
J106 J1280
J115 J210
J112 J209 J1281
J113
J1105 J1258
J1107 J1103
J1102
J21
J1104 J1100 J531
J15
J1254 J532
J302
J301
J1253 J1189
J1252 J1126
J1251 J1201
J1108 J1101
J1106
F-15-19
15-19
Chapter 15
J1134
J1190
J1287
J1284
J1135
J1192
J1191
J1185
J1163
J1283
J222
J219
J1139 J1138
J218 J1155 J1143
J1154 J1142
J217 J1140
J1124 J1162
J211 J1141
J1130
J1164
J212 J1125 J1186
J1133 J1145 J1144
J1256 J1271 J1149
J1146 J1148
J1127
J1129 J1147
J1273
J1282
J1152 J1159 J832
J1272
J1125 J1138 J12
J1193 J1144
J1137 J1153
J13
J833
J831
F-15-20
15-20
Chapter 15
J3904 J7431
J7423
J7433 J7432 J7424
J743
J231
J742
J741
J744
J212 J7422
J745
J213
J7421
J216
J7451
J1266
J7442
J1187 J7441
J1128
J223 J1274
J1131
J1288
J1132
J1277
J1188 J1122
J1257
J521 J1286
J221
J220
J1165
J1175
J1167
J1166
J1183
J563
J2013 J1285
J1261
J1268
J555 J1267
J2005
J1171
J1262 J1266
J558
J2008 J1263 J554
J1264 J2004
J552
J551 J2002 J556
J1269 J2001 J2006
J564 J560 J557
J2014 J562 J2010 J553 J2007
J2012 J1265 J2003
J1169 J559
J561 J2009
J2011
J567
J566 J2017
J565 J2016
J2015
F-15-21
15-21
Chapter 15
J3904
J230 J229
J231
J227
J3903
J228
J3902
J232
J213
J223
J214
J3062
J3053
J2113 J2202
J3061 J2119 J2120
J3061 J3088 J2121
J3058
J2111 J1019
J1021
J2203 J1020 J1
J2115
J502 J1016
J1017
J1023 J1018
J1014
J1
J101 J2110
J2201 J1051
J1008
J1033 J1010 J1011
J5003
J1302
J5002 J1013
J1002
J2122 J1007
J2121
J1003 J1034
F-15-22
15.3.9 Variable Resistors (VR), Light-Emitting Diodes (LED), and Check Pins by PCB
15.3.9.1 Variable Resistors (VR), Light-Emiting Diodes (LED), and Check Pins by PCB
0014-4630
Of the variable resistors (VR), light-emitting diodes (LED), and check pins used in the machine those needed in the field are discussed.
- Although normal, some LEDs may emit dim light when they remain off becouse of leakege current.
- Keep the following symbols in mind;
---VR that may be used in the field.
---VR that must not be used in the field.
15-22
Chapter 15
LED2 LED5
LED2001
F-15-23
T-15-14
Notation Description
LED2001 in operation
LED2 +3.3V (all-night) being supplied
LED5 +3.3V (non-all night) being supplied
15-23
Chapter 15
LED1
J4001
F-15-24
Code Role
LED1 +3.3V (Non-all night; for ASIC drive) feed is being executed.
J101
J107
J103
J108
J109
F-15-25
15-24
Chapter 16 Self Diagnosis
Contents
Contents
T-16-1
Code Description
***: Finisher-Z1 ****: Finisher-Y1, Saddle Finisher-Y2
*****: Puncher Unit
E001 Abnormality high temperature error of the fixing unit
E003 Low temperature of the fixing unit after standby
E004 Thermistor is not connected
E009 Error in pressure/release of fixing film unit
E012 Drum motor error
E013 Error in the waste toner motor
E014 Error in the registration motor
E020 Error in the developing assembly (Toner fault: ATR error)
E021 Developing motor error
E025 Error in the toner motor
E026 Toner empty error
XX=01:Y XX=02:M XX=03:C XX=04:K
E032 The counter of the NE controller fails to operate.
E045 OHP sensor error
E067 High voltage-related error (Primary transfer)
E069 Error in the relation of high-voltage (Secondary transfer)
E070 ITB HP detection error
E100 BD error
E110 Error in the polygon motor
E193 Error in IMG1 (failure of add-on)
E202 CIS unit HP detection error
E225 CIS light quantity error
E227 Power supply error in the reader unit
E240 Error in communication of controller
E243 Control panel unit error
E248 Backup memory error
E315 Abnormality of image data
E351 Main controller PCB error
E400 Feeder communication error
E490 Model error
E500 Finisher communication error
E503 *** Finisher internal communication error
E505 Finisher backup memory error
E514 *** Stack delivery error / **** End assist motor error
E519 **** Gear change motor error
E530 *** Rear alignment error / **** Front alignment error
E531 Staple error
E532 Staple unit shift error
E535 Swing error
E537 *** Front alignment error / **** Rear alignment error
E540 *** Stack tray up/down error / **** Upper tray up/down error
E542 **** Lower tray up/down error
E577 *** Paddle error
E580 Stack tray up/down error
E584 **** Shutter unit error
E590 ***** Puncher motor error
E591 ***** Puncher dust sensor error
E592 ***** Puncher side registration sensor error
E593 ***** Puncher shift motor error
E5F0 **** Saddle paper positioning error
E5F1 **** Saddle paper folder error
E5F2 **** Saddle guide error
E5F3 **** Saddle alignment error
E5F4 **** Saddle rear side staple error
E5F5 **** Saddle front side staple error
E5F6 **** Saddle paper push-on error
E5F8 **** Saddle connector error
E5F9 **** Saddle switch error
16-1
Chapter 16
Code Description
***: Finisher-Z1 ****: Finisher-Y1, Saddle Finisher-Y2
*****: Puncher Unit
E601 Abnormality of image memory
E602 Hard disk error
E604 The image memory (SDRAM) is faulty/insufficient
E609 Abnormal low temperature of the hard disk
E610 Failure in the hard disk cryptographic key
E611 Error in repeating reboot due to SRAM failure
E674 FAX board communication error
E677 Abnormality of the external controller
E710 IPC initialization error
E711 IPC communication error
E712 Communication error between the ADF and the reader
E713 Communication error between the finisher and the printer
E716 Error in communication with the cassette pedestal and delivery unit 2/3
E717 Communication error with the NE controller
E719 Communication error with the coin vender/card reader
E730 PDL error
E731 UFR PCB error
E732 Reader communication error
E733 Printer communication error
E740 Abnormality of the Ethernet board
E743 DDI communication error
E744 Language file/BootROM error
E745 Token ring board error
E746 Option board error
E747 Main controller PCB error (Image processing ASIC or memory control/communication control ASIC)
E748 Main controller PCB error
E749 Restart in accordance with a change of the product configuration
E803 Door close error
E804 Controller fan error
E805 Fan error
E806 Error in the fan of the machine
E807 Error in the fan of the process cartridge
E808 Error in the low-voltage power circuit (Xerox error)
E811 Error in detecting new parts of the drum unit
E840 Error in the cooling fan of the end
E990 Error in the toner container
T-16-2
16-2
Chapter 16
16-3
Chapter 16
0002 There is no response when 4 sec passed since the main controller had sent the request
for image output to DC controller during printing.
0003 The engine is activated when jam occurs.
E243 Control panel unit error
0000 Communication between the main controller and the control panel unit is abnormal. Check on connection between the main controller PCB
and the control panel unit
E248 Backup memory error
0000 Check error of the SRAM PCB (at start up) Check on connection of the SRAM PCB, Replace the
SRAM PCB
0001 Reader controller EEPROM error at power-on Replace the reader controller PCB
0002 Reader controller EEPROM writing error
0003 Reader controller EEPROM reading error after check error writing
E315 Abnormality of image data
000e Data is corrupt (Abnormality of memory/HDD) Replace the image memory (SDRAM) , Replace the
Soft decode error HDD
E351 Main controller PCB error
0000 Communication error of the main controller PCB occurs at start-up. Check on connection between the main controller PCB
and the main controller PCB (sub) , Replace the main
controller PCB, Replace the main controller PCB (sub)
E400 Feeder communication error
16-4
Chapter 16
16-5
Chapter 16
16-6
Chapter 16
16-7
Chapter 16
16-8
Chapter 16
0003 Board information acquisition/setting is abnormal when the token ring board is
initialized.
0004 Connection error when the token ring driver starts up. Check on connection of the cable, Check on power
supply of the MAU
E746 Option board error
0003 The UFR PCB for other model is detected at start-up. Replace with an appropriate UFR PCB
0004 The main controller PCB (sub) for other model is detected at start-up. Replace with an appropriate main controller PCB (sub)
E747 Main controller PCB error (Image processing ASIC or memory control/communication control ASIC)
XXXX IC12 (image processing ASIC) or IC23 (memory control/communication control ASIC, Turn OFF and back ON the main power, Replace the
CPU) on the main controller PCB is abnormal (such as image data transfer error) main controller PCB (main)
E747 Main controller PCB error
0000-1217 An error occurs in the main controller PCB (Main). Turn the main power off and turn it back on.
Replace the main controller PCB (Main).
2000-3D00 An error occurs in the communication with the main controller PCB (Sub PE). Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
PE), or replace it.
Replace the main controller PCB (Main).
3F00,3F02 When Unmounting of the main controller PCB (Sub PE) is detected. Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
PE), or replace it.
6000-7D00 An error occurs in the communication with the main controller PCB (Sub R) Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
R), or replace it.
Replace the main controller PCB (Main).
7F00 When unmounting of the main controller PCB (Sub R) is detected. Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
R), or replace it.
8000-9C00 A error occurs in the communication with the open interface PCB. Disconnect and connect the open interface PCB, or
replace it.
Replace the main controller PCB (Main).
9F00 When unmounting of the main controller PCB (Sub R) is detected. Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
R), or replace it.
C000-DC00 An error occurs in the communication with the main controller PCB (Sub SJ). Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
SJ), or replace it.
Replace the main controller PCB (Main).
DF00 When unmounting of the main controller PCB (Sub SJ) is detected. Disconnect and connect the main controller PCB (Sub
SJ), or replace it.
FF00 Incorrect main controller PCB (Sub SJ/PE/R) or incorrect open interface PCB is Replace with an appropriate main controller PCB (Sub
detected. SJ/PE/R) or open interface PCB.
16-9
Chapter 16
16-10
Chapter 16
16-11
Chapter 16
E602-XXYY
- if XX='00'
T-16-3
XX YY
YY=10,1
YY=00,0 YY=11,2 YY=13,2 2,14,22,2
YY=03 YY=05 1,02,04 1 5 3,24
16-12
Chapter 16
- if XX='01 to FF'
XX YY
YY=10, HDD formatting
YY=00, YY=11, YY=13, 12,14,22
YY=03 YY=05 01,02,04 21 25 ,23,24
At time of start-up During normal operation
CHK- Partition in
XX Description HDD HDD
TYPE question
HDD formatting formatting
Items formatting by normal by safe
deleted by HD- mode + mode +
Remedy Remedy Remedy Remedy Remedy Remedy (typical) CLEAR SST SST
image data storage
01 FSTDEV area (e.g., Box) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 FSTDEV
possible (3
selected (3
image management partitions
1 partitions
02 IMG_MNG data *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 all stored simultaneo simultaneo
image data storage data (e.g., us)
us)
03 FSTCDEV area (for Chasing) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 Box)
general-purpose data
04 APL_GEN storage area *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 General
APL_GEN
general-purpose data possible (4
selected (4
storage area partitions
2 partitions
05 TMP_GEN (temporary file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 General simultaneo
simultaneo
us)
06 TMP_FAX fax (temporary file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 FAX us)
07 TMP_PSS PSS (temporary file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 PSS
PDL-related file
storage area (font,
registration form,
PDLDEV
3 PDLDEV ICCProfile, PDL possible
selected
function color UserFont
correction information Icc
08 file) *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 Profile
Firmware storage area
(Booktable, MEAP,
Key, certificate, PDF
Not Not
4 BOOTDEV dictionary, RUI
possible possible
content, voice
dictionary (ICC
09 profile, PS test data)) *3 *8 *9 *10 *11 *12 System
10 5 APL_MEAP MEAP *1 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 MEAP possible possible
Not Not
6
11 APL_SEND address book, filter *2 *5 *9 *10 *11 *12 SEND possible possible
HDD full sector fault
0
FF Not identified check and repair *4 *7 *9 *10 *11 *12 - - - -
16-13
Chapter 16
Cause Remedy
Scanning has stopped because the size of the data for the scanned original exceeds the limit. Scanning may be possible if [Data Cmprssn] is set to [High
Ratio], Resolution is lowered, or [Sharpness] is reduced.
Scanning was stopped because the data size of the scanned original exceeded the By selecting [High Ratio] for Data Compression Ratio, lowering the Resolution,
maximum data size that the machine could handle. and lowering the Sharpness setting, scanning may become possible.
Out of resources. Wait for a moment, then perform operation again.
You cannot browse the network. There is a lack of TCP/IP resources because Wait for a while, and try browsing again.
documents have just been continuously sent or are being continuously sent
through FTP or Windows (SMB).
Set the IP Address.
This machine is not set with an IP address. Specify the IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in System
Settings (from the Additional Functions screen), then turn the machine's main
power OFF and back ON again.
No response from the server. Check the settings.
The specified server settings are incorrect, or the server is not turned ON. Wait for a while, and try browsing again. If there is still no response from the
Alternatively, the machine's TCP/IP resources may be low. server, try selecting another server.
NetWare is in use. Wait for a moment, then perform operation again.
You cannot browse the network because NetWare is printing through a Pserver or Wait until printing is complete, then try browsing again.
NDS PServer.
There are too many subdirectories.
You have exceeded the maximum number of subdirectory levels allowed. Specify a different destination because the directory level that you are trying to
access cannot be specified.
No response.
The server was not running when you tried to send. Make sure that the server is ON, and check the destination.
The network connection was lost when you tried to send. (Either you could not Check the status of the network.
connect to the destination, or the connection was lost before the job could be
completed.)
You tried to send through NetWare, but the Tree name was not entered. Enter the Tree name.
A TCP/IP error occurred when you tried to send an e-mail message or an I-fax. Check that the network cables and connectors are properly connected.
Check the TCP/IP.
Cause The machine's TCP/IP connection is not operating. Check the IP Address Settings (IP Address, DHCP, RARP, BOOTP) in TCP/IP
Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions
screen).
Cannot find the selected server. Check the settings.
The IP address that the machine should connect to cannot be determined. 1. Check the DNS Server Settings in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in
System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
2. Check whether the DNS server's DNS settings are correct.
If Login Information in Register LDAP Server in System Settings (from the Check the DNS Server Settings in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in System
Additional Functions screen) is set to 'Use (security auth.)' for the LDAP server, Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
the machine will not be able to determine the host name.
Cannot connect to the selected server. Check the settings.
The machine cannot connect to the specified IP address/port. 1. Check the Gateway Address setting in IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings
in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
2. Check the Server Address and Port Number in Register LDAP Server in System
Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
3. Check whether the LDAP server is operating normally.
4. If Login Information in Register LDAP Server in System Settings (from the
Additional Functions screen) is set to 'Use (security auth.)' for the LDAP server,
check whether UDP (User Datagram Protocol) packages are blocked by the filter.
Check the user name and password or check settings.
When setting Login Information for the LDAP server to 'Use' or 'Use (security Check the User and Password settings when Login Information in Register LDAP
auth.)', the user name or password is incorrect. Server in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen) is set to 'Use' or
'Use (security auth.)'.
16-14
Chapter 16
Cause Remedy
When setting Login Information for the LDAP server to 'Use (security auth.)', the Check the Domain Name setting when Login Information in Register LDAP
domain name is incorrect. Server in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen) is set to 'Use
(security auth.)'.
Cannot complete searching due to timeout. Check the settings.
The search could not be completed within the time specified under <Search Increase the time setting for Search Timeout in Register LDAP Server in System
Timeout>. Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
The number of search results has exceeded limits. Change search conditions and try again.
The number of addresses that meet the search criteria exceeds the specified 1. Narrow down the search criteria, and then search again.
maximum number of addresses to search. 2. Increase the maximum number of addresses to search.
Search condition includes characters that cannot be used with the selected server.
"/" is used in the search criterion. Remove "/" from the search criterion, and search again.
The combination of characters used in the search criterion does not constitute an Make sure that the characters for the search criterion are combined properly, and
acceptable search criterion. search again.
There is an unequal number of "(" and ")".
"*" is not placed within "( )".
If <Server LDAP version and character code> is set to 'ver.2 (JIS)', characters Omit characters that cannot be used, and search again.
other than ASCII Code (0x20-0x7E) are being used.
Cannot start searching because the version setting for the server is incorrect. Check the settings.
Although 'ver. 3' is set as the server LDAP version number in Register LDAP Set Server LDAP version and character code in Register LDAP Server in System
Server in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen), the LDAP Settings (from the Additional Functions screen) to 'ver. 2'.
server is running on version 2.
Cause Remedy
# 001
Paper or originals are jammed. Place the document properly in the feeder or on the platen glass, and remove any
jammed paper or originals.
# 003
Communications that take longer than the preset time (64 minutes) caused the 1. Reduce the resolution, and try sending the document again.
error. 2. When receiving a document, ask the remote party to either reduce the resolution
at which the document is scanned, or divide the document into two or more parts
before sending it.
# 005
The other party did not answer within 35 seconds. Confirm that the remote machine is able to communicate, and try again.
The receiving machine is not a G3 fax. Check the type of receiving machine with the receiving party.
# 009
There is no paper. Load paper.
The paper drawer is not correctly inserted into the machine. Insert the paper drawer properly.
# 011
The document that you are sending is not placed correctly. Place the document properly in the feeder or on the platen glass, and repeat the
whole procedure from the beginning.
# 012
The document could not be sent because the receiving fax machine was out of Ask the receiving party to load paper into their fax machine.
paper.
# 018
The receiving machine did not respond when your machine redialed. Confirm that the receiving machine is able to communicate, and try again.
The documents could not be sent because the receiving machine was engaged. Confirm that the receiving machine is able to communicate, and try again.
The settings on your machine do not match the settings on the receiving machine. Confirm that the receiving machine is able to communicate, and try again.
# 022
Forwarding could not be performed because all of the addresses stored under the Re-enter the forwarding address and try sending again.
specified Group destination have been deleted, or User Inboxes are specified as
the Group destination.
Transmission could not be performed because the specified destination was Re-enter the address in the address book and try sending again.
deleted while the documents were waiting to be sent.
# 037
Documents could not be received because there was insufficient memory Erase unwanted documents and documents with errors from memory to increase
available. the amount of available memory.
# 080
A subaddress is not set in the remote machine. Check the subaddress of the remote machine, and try again.
# 081
A password is not set in the remote machine. Check the password of the remote machine, and try again.
# 099
Sending was interrupted. Try sending again.
# 102
The subaddress and/or password do not match. Check the subaddress and/or password of the remote machine, and try again.
# 107
The document could not be sent because there was insufficient memory available. 1. Resend the document in a lower resolution.
2. Erase unwanted documents to make memory available.
3. If this problem occurs frequently, contact your local authorized Canon dealer.
# 701
16-15
Chapter 16
Cause Remedy
The specified Department ID does not exist, or the password has changed. Enter the correct Department ID or password using 0-9 (numeric keys) on the
control panel, and try sending again.
# 702
The document could not be sent because the memory is full. 1. Wait a few moments, and try again after the other send jobs are complete.
2. Do not send the document to too many recipients at the same time. Send the
document to a smaller number of recipients each time.
# 703
The memory for the image data is full. 1. Wait a few moments, and try again after the other send jobs are complete.
2. Erase documents stored in inboxes. If the machine still does not operate
normally, turn the main power OFF, and then back ON again.
# 704
An error occurred while reading address information from the Address Book. Check the address settings. If the machine still does not operate normally, turn the
main power OFF, and then back ON again.
# 705
The send operation was interrupted because the size of the image data is larger Change the Maximum Data Size for Sending setting in E-mail/I-Fax Settings in
than the Maximum Data Size for Sending set in E-mail/I-Fax Settings in Communications Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions
Communications Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen). Select a lower resolution, or if you are using I-fax, decrease the number
screen). of pages containing images that you are sending each time, so that you do not
exceed the Maximum Data Size for Sending limit.
# 706
The Address Book is being imported or exported from the Remote UI, or it is Wait until the Address Book import/export function from the Remote UI or the
being used by another sending component. other sending component is complete, and try sending again.
# 711
The inbox memory is full. Erase the unnecessary documents stored in the inbox.
# 712
The maximum number of documents is already stored in the inbox. Erase the unnecessary documents stored in the inbox.
# 751
The server is not functioning. The network is down (the server is unable to connect Check the recipient's address.
to the network or was disconnected). Check that the network is up.
# 752
The SMTP server name for e-mail or I-fax is not correct, or the server is not Check the SMTP Server name and E-mail Address in E-mail/I-Fax in Network
functioning. Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
The domain name or e-mail address may not be set. The network is down. Check that the SMTP server is operating properly.
Check the network status.
# 753
A TCP/IP error occurred while sending an e-mail message. (Socket, Select error, Check the network cables and connectors. If the machine still does not operate
etc.) normally, turn the main power OFF, and then back ON again.
# 754
The server is not functioning or the network is down. Check the server and network.
The destination setting is not correct. Check the destination's address settings.
# 755
You cannot send jobs because TCP/IP is not functioning correctly. Check TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the
Additional Functions screen).
The IP address is not set. Check TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the
Additional Functions screen).
When the machine was turned ON, an IP address was not assigned to the machine Check TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the
by the DHCP, RARP, or BOOTP server. Additional Functions screen).
# 756
NetWare in NetWare Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Turn NetWare to 'On'.
Additional Functions screen) is set to 'Off'.
# 801
A timeout error occurred while the machine was communicating with the SMTP 1. Check that the SMTP server is functioning normally.
server to send an e-mail message or send/receive an I-fax. 2. Check the network status.
The SMTP server returned an error while trying to connect. The destination is not 1. Check that the SMTP server is functioning normally.
correct. An error occurred on the server side during transmission to a file server. 2. Check the network status.
3. Check the destination setting.
4. Check the status and setting of the file server.
You are sending a file to a destination to which you have no write permission. Check the destination setting.
When the machine tried to send a file to the server, a file with the same name Change the setting on the file server to enable the file to be overwritten.
already exists on the FTP server and that file cannot be overwritten.
When the machine tried to send a file to the server, either the folder name is Check the destination setting.
incorrectly specified or the password is incorrect.
# 802
The name of the SMTP Server in E-mail/I-Fax settings in Network Settings in Check the name of the SMTP Server in E-mail/I-Fax and DNS Server Settings in
System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen) is incorrect. The DNS TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional
server name in DNS Server Settings in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in Functions screen).
System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen) is incorrect. Connection Check that the DNS server is functioning normally.
to the DNS server failed.
# 803
The connection was interrupted due to reasons on the recipient's side before all of Try sending again.
the pages could be sent.
# 804
Unable to match the specified directory name when sending data to a file server. Check the destination.
You have no permission to access the folder. Change the setting on the server to enable access to the folder.
# 806
16-16
Chapter 16
Cause Remedy
An incorrect user name or password was specified for the sending of a file to a file Change the user name or password.
server.
An incorrect destination was specified for the sending of an e-mail message or I- Check the e-mail or I-fax address.
fax.
# 810
A POP (Post Office Protocol) server connection error occurred while receiving an Check the POP Server name in E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System
I-fax. Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
Confirm that the POP server is functioning normally.
Check the network status.
The POP server returned an error during the connection. Check the POP Server name in E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System
Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
Confirm that the POP server is functioning normally.
Check the network status.
A timeout error occurred on the server while connecting to the POP server. Check the POP Server name in E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System
Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
Confirm that the POP server is functioning normally.
Check the network status.
# 815
You cannot log on to the file server because the machine is printing a document Wait for a few moments before trying to send the data again, or change the
sent to that server. Simultaneous connections are not possible. NetWare server to which you are sending your documents. Alternatively, stop the
Pserver.
# 818
The received data is not in a printable file format. Ask the sender to change the file format and resend the data.
# 819
You have received data that cannot be processed (MIME information is incorrect). Check the settings, and ask the sender to resend the data.
# 820
You have received data that cannot be processed (BASE 64 or uuencode is Check the settings, and ask the sender to resend the data.
incorrect).
# 821
You have received data that cannot be processed (TIFF analysis error). Check the settings, and ask the sender to resend the data.
# 822
You have received data that cannot be processed (image data cannot be decoded). Check the settings, and ask the sender to resend the data.
# 827
You have received data that cannot be processed (contains MIME information that Check the settings, and ask the sender to resend the data.
is not supported).
# 828
You have received HTML data. Ask the sender to use a file format other than HTML, and resend the data.
# 829
Data that contains more than 1,000 pages is received. This machine can print or store up to 999 pages of data in memory, but will delete
any data that exceeds this limit. Ask the sender to resend the remaining pages.
# 830
A DSN (Delivery Status Notification) error notification is received because of an 1. Check the I-fax address or destination setting.
incorrect I-fax address or destination setting, or the data size of the sent documents 2. Set Maximum Data Size for Sending in E-mail/I-Fax Settings in
exceeds the mail server capacity. Communication Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions
screen) so that it is less than the mail server capability.
3. Check the status of the mail server, DNS server, and network.
# 831
An I-fax document could not be received using SMTP because of the RX/Print Reset the RX/Print Range setting in IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings in
Range setting in IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen).
# 832
DSN (Delivery Status Notification) mail was not sent because TCP/IP Settings or 1. Check the DNS Server Settings and IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings, and
E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional
Functions screen) have not been set, or trouble has occurred in the mail server. Functions screen).
2. Check the status of the mail server and DNS server.
# 833
MDN (Mail Delivery Notification) mail was not sent because TCP/IP Settings or 1. Check the DNS Server Settings and IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings, and
E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional
Functions screen) have not been set, or trouble has occurred in the mail server. Functions screen).
2. Check the status of the mail server and DNS server.
# 834
An MDN error notification is received because of an incorrect I-fax address or Check the I-fax address and destination settings.
destination setting, or trouble has occurred in the network or mail server.
Alternatively, the memory of the receiving machine is full.
# 835
The maximum number of text lines for receiving an I-fax has been exceeded. Ask the sender to reduce the amount of text data in the body of the document, and
resend the data.
# 837
A connection request was received from a host whose connection is restricted by Check the settings in IP Address Settings in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings
IP Address Settings, which can be set in TCP/IP Settings in Network Settings in in System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen). Make sure that the
System Settings (from the Additional Functions screen). connection request is made from an authorized host.
# 839
The user name or password for the SMTP authentication (SMTP AUTH) in Check the user name and password for SMTP Authentication (SMTP AUTH) in
Authent./Encryption in E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System Settings Authent./Encryption in E-mail/I-Fax in Network Settings in System Settings
(from the Additional Functions screen) is incorrect. (from the Additional Functions screen).
# 841
16-17
Chapter 16
Cause Remedy
The encryption algorithm that matches the mail server does not exist for sending 1. Set Allow SSL in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional
e-mail or I-fax. Functions screen) to 'Off'.
2. Add the same encryption algorithm as the mail server in the mail server settings.
# 842
Authentication using the client certificate was requested by the mail server for 1. Set Allow SSL in Network Settings in System Settings (from the Additional
sending e-mail or I-fax. Functions screen) to 'Off'.
2. Change the mail server settings so that the client certificate is not requested.
# 843
There is large difference between the current time set in the KDC (Key 1. Change the current date and time in Date & Time Settings in Timer Settings
Distribution Center) server and the one set in the machine. (from the Additional Functions screen).
2. Change the current time set in the KDC (Key Distribution Center) server.
# 851
There is insufficient memory remaining in the system. Check the system's available memory, and delete unwanted documents in the
inboxes.
The scanned document cannot be stored because there are more than 100 Delete unnecessary documents from the specified inbox.
documents in the specified inbox.
# 852
An error occurred because the main power switch was turned OFF while a job was Check to see if the main power switch is turned ON. Try processing the job again,
being processed. if necessary.
# 899
The e-mail message or I-fax has been successfully sent, but reception may be 1. Confirm whether reception was complete.
incomplete because the transmission was relayed via multiple servers. 2. Check if you received an error notification.
# 995
Reserved communication jobs were cleared. Reserve the jobs again, if necessary.
16-18
Chapter 17 Service Mode
Contents
Contents
17.1 Outline........................................................................................................................................................................17-1
17.1.1 Construction of Service Mode ................................................................................................................................................. 17-1
17.1.2 Entering or selecting service modes ........................................................................................................................................ 17-2
17.1.3 Exiting service modes .............................................................................................................................................................. 17-2
17.1.4 Back-up of service mode ......................................................................................................................................................... 17-2
17.1.5 Initial Screen ............................................................................................................................................................................ 17-3
17.1.6 Main/intermediate Item Screen................................................................................................................................................ 17-3
17.1.7 Sub- Item Screen...................................................................................................................................................................... 17-3
17.2 DISPLAY (Status Display Mode)..............................................................................................................................17-4
17.2.1 COPIER ................................................................................................................................................................................... 17-4
17.2.1.1 COPIER Table ............................................................................................................................................................................................17-4
17.2.2 FEEDER ................................................................................................................................................................................ 17-13
17.2.2.1 FEEDER Table..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-13
17.3 I/O (I/O Display Mode)............................................................................................................................................17-13
17.3.1 Overview................................................................................................................................................................................ 17-13
17.3.2 <DC-CON>............................................................................................................................................................................ 17-14
17.3.3 <R-CON>............................................................................................................................................................................... 17-15
17.3.4 <FEEDER> ............................................................................................................................................................................ 17-15
17.3.5 <SORTER>............................................................................................................................................................................ 17-16
17.3.6 <MN-CONT> ........................................................................................................................................................................ 17-20
17.4 ADJUST (Adjustment Mode) ..................................................................................................................................17-22
17.4.1 COPIER ................................................................................................................................................................................. 17-22
17.4.1.1 COPIER Table ..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-22
17.4.2 FEEDER ................................................................................................................................................................................ 17-37
17.4.2.1 FEEDER Table..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-37
17.4.3 SORTER ................................................................................................................................................................................ 17-38
17.4.3.1 SORTER Table .........................................................................................................................................................................................17-38
17.5 FUNCTION (Operation/Inspection Mode)..............................................................................................................17-39
17.5.1 COPIER ................................................................................................................................................................................. 17-39
17.5.1.1 COPIER Table ..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-39
17.5.2 FEEDER ................................................................................................................................................................................ 17-46
17.5.2.1 FEEDER Table..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-46
17.6 OPTION (Machine Settings Mode) .........................................................................................................................17-47
17.6.1 COPIER ................................................................................................................................................................................. 17-47
17.6.1.1 COPIER Table ..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-47
17.6.2 SORTER ................................................................................................................................................................................ 17-80
17.6.2.1 SORTER Table .........................................................................................................................................................................................17-80
17.6.3 BOARD.................................................................................................................................................................................. 17-80
17.6.3.1 BOARD Table...........................................................................................................................................................................................17-80
17.7 TEST (Test Print Mode) ..........................................................................................................................................17-81
17.7.1 COPIER ................................................................................................................................................................................. 17-81
17.7.1.1 COPIER Table ..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-81
17.8 COUNTER (Counter Mode) ....................................................................................................................................17-83
17.8.1 COPIER ................................................................................................................................................................................. 17-83
17.8.1.1 COPIER Table ..........................................................................................................................................................................................17-83
Chapter 17
17.1 Outline
The machine's service mode has a 3-layer screen construction: Initial screen, Level 1/2 screen, and Level 3 screen.
Its mode items are grouped into those used in regular maintenance work (Level 1 items) and those used in response to faults (Level 2 items).
User screen
( )(2,8)( )
Reset key
Initial screen
(Level 1)
Initial screen
( )(2) (Level 2)
(Select an item.)
Main/intermediate
(Select a main item from the top of screen.)
(The corresponding intermediate items are item screen
then displayed and can be selected.) (Level 2)
Previous/next page
F-17-1
The machine's service mode is divided into the following 7 types:
COPIER
FEEDER
DISPLAY status indication mode
SORTER
I/O input/output indication mode
BOARD
ADJUST adjustment mode
17-1
Chapter 17
If you want to execute a machine operation using a service mode item, be sure to disconnect all cables from an external controller or a network before starting
service mode. Particularly, if you are using a FUNCTION (operation/inspection) mode item, the arrival of a print job from an external source can cause the machine
to malfunction, leading to damage.
In response to the foregoing key operations, the machine will bring up the following Initial screen:
If you used service mode (ADJUST, FUNCTION, OPTION), be sure to turn off and then on the main power switch after ending service mode.
At time of shipment from the factory, all machines are adjusted individually, and adjustment values are recorded in their respective service labels.
If you have replaced the reader controller PCB or the DC controller PCB, or if you have initialized the RAM, the adjustment values (for ADJUST and OPTION)
will return to their default settings. If there has been any change in a service mode item, be sure to update its setting indicated on the service label. As necessary,
make use of the space in the service label (as when recording an item not found on the label).
- Service Label for the Reader Controller PCB (behind the left cover [1] of the reader unit)
[1]
F-17-4
- Service Label for the Main Controller PCB/DC controller PCB (behind the front cover of the printer unit)
17-2
Chapter 17
COPIER
Initial item FEEDER
Touch to select
an item.
SORTER
FAX
BOARD
F-17-5
ACC-STS
ANALOG
Intermediate items
CST-STS
Touch an item to
select it. JAM
ERR
F-17-6
Number of pages
17-3
Chapter 17
17.2.1 COPIER
1. VERSION
T-17-1
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
Sub item Description level.
Use it to check the ROM version of individual PCBs (host machine and accessories).
- for example, in <R-CON XX.YY>, XX indicates the version and YY indicates R&D number.
- if no PCB is connected, the indication will be <--.-->.
DC-CON ROM version of DC controller PCB. 1
R-CON ROM version of reader controller PCB. 1
PANEL ROM version of control panel CPU PCB. 1
ECO ROM version of ECO PCB. 1
FEEDER ROM version of DADF controller PCB. 1
SORTER ROM version of finisher controller PCB. 1
FAX ROM version of fax board. 1
NIB Network software version. 1
PS/PCL UFR board (PS/PCL function) version. 1
SDL-STCH ROM version of saddle stitcher controller PCB. 1
OP-CON ROM version of cassette pedestal controller PCB. 1
MN-CONT System software version of main controller PCB. 1
RUI Remote UI version. 1
PUNCH Punch unit version 1
LANG-EN English language file version. 1
LANG-FR French language file version. 1
LANG-DE German language file version. 1
LANG-IT Italian language file version. 1
LANG-JP Japanese language file version. 1
GDI-UFR UFR board (GDI-UFR function) version. 1
MEAP Use it to indicate the version of MEAP content. 1
OCR-CN OCR version for Chinese (simplified) 1
OCR-JP OCR version for Japanese 1
OCR-KR OCR version for Korean 1
OCR-TW OCR version for Chinese (traditional) 1
BOOTROM BOOT-ROM version 1
TTS-JA Voice dictionary version for Japanese 1
TTS-EN Voice dictionary version for English 1
WEB-BRWS Web browser version 1
HELP Simple NAVI version 1
17-4
Chapter 17
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
Sub item Description level.
WEBDAV WebDAV version 1
TIMESTMP TIMESTMP version 1
ASR-JA Version of the Japanese voice recognition dictionary 1
ASR-EN Version of the English voice recognition dictionary 1
LANG-CS Use it to check the version of the Czech language file. 2
LANG-DA Use it to check the version of the Danish language file. 2
LANG-EL Use it to check the version f the Greek language file. 2
LANG-ES Use it to check the version of the Spanish language file. 2
LANG-ET Use it to check the version of the Estonian language file. 2
LANG-FI Use it to check the version of the Finnish language file. 2
LANG-HU Use it to check the version of the Hungarian language file. 2
LANG-KO Use it to check the version of the Korean language file. 2
LANG-NL Use it to check the version of the Dutch language file. 2
LANG-NO Use it to check the version of the Norwegian language file. 2
LANG-PL Use it to check the version of the Polish language file. 2
LANG-PT Use it to check the version of the Portuguese language file. 2
LANG-RU Use it to check the version of the Russian langue file. 2
LANG-SL Use it to check the version of the Slovenian language file. 2
LANG-SV Use it to check the version of the Swedish language file. 2
LANG-TW Use it to check the version of the Chinese language file (traditional text). 2
LANG-ZH Use it to check the version of the Chinese language file (simplified text). 2
ECO-ID Use it to check the ECO-ID number 2
LANG-BU Use it to check the version of the Bulgarian language file. 2
LANG-CR Use it to check the version of the Croatian language file. 2
LANG-RM Use it to check the version of the Romanian language file. 2
LANG-SK Use it to check the version of the Slovakian language file. 2
LANG-TK Use it to check the version of the Turkish language file. 2
LANG-CA Catalan language file version 2
2. ACC-STS
T-17-2
COPIER>DISPLAY>ACC-STS
Sub item Description level.
FEEDER Displays whether DADF is connected.
0: Not connected 1
1: Connected
SORTER Displays whether finisher is connected.
0: Not connected
1
1: Finisher M1 or N1 connected
2: Saddle finisher N2 connected
DECK Displays whether paper deck is connected.
0: Not connected 1
1: Connected
CARD Displays whether card reader is connected.
0: Not connected 1
1: Connected
RAM Displays memory capacity of memory mounted on main controller PCB.
1
512 MB, 768 MB
COINROBO Displays whether coin vendor is connected.
0: Not connected 1
1: Connected
NIB Displays whether network board is connected.
0: Not connected,
1: Ethernet board connected, 1
2: Token ring board connected,
3: Ethernet board and token ring board connected
NETWARE Displays whether NetWare firmware is installed.
0: Not installed 1
1: Installed
SEND Indicates whether SEND function is appended.
0: No SEND function 1
1: SEND function
PDL-FNC1 Display of Enabled PDL (1) 1
PDL-FNC2 Display of Enabled PDL (2) 1
HDD Display of HDD model name 1
PCI1 Display of PCI1 board name 1
PCI2 Display of PCI2 board name 1
PCI3 Display of PCI3 board name 1
USBH-SPD Display of USB device connection speed 2
17-5
Chapter 17
3. ANALOG
T-17-3
COPIER>DISPLAY>ANALOG
Sub item Description level.
TEMP Copier's internal temperature (environment sensor) in deg C 1
HUM Copier's internal humidity (environment sensor) in %RH 1
ABS-HUM Amount of moisture (environment sensor) in grams 1
FIX-C Temperature of the fixing roller surface (Detection temperature of the main thermistor) 1
FIX-E Temperature of the fixing roller surface (Detection temperature of the sub thermistor ) 1
FIX-E2 Temperature of the fixing roller surface (Detection temperature of the sub thermistor 2) 1
TEMP2 Temperature in the machine (Environment sensor) 1
HUM2 Humidity in the machine (Environment sensor) 1
4. CST-STS
T-17-4
COPIER>DISPLAY>CST-STS
Sub item Description level.
WIDTH-MF Use it to check the width of paper in the manual feed tray (in mm). 2
5. JAM
a. Displays jam data
F-17-9
AA Jam sequence number 1 to 50 (the larger the number, the older the jam)
BBBB Date of jam
CCCC Time of jam
DDDD Time jam was restored
EEEEE Jam location 0: Copier, 1: DADF, 2: Finisher
FFff Jam code FF: Jam type, ff: Jam sensor (as will hereinafter be described in detail)
GG Paper feed position (as will hereinafter be described in detail)
HH Paper feed level software counter value
17-6
Chapter 17
17-7
Chapter 17
Code Description
1 Cassette 1
2 Cassette 2
17-8
Chapter 17
Code Description
3 Cassette 3
4 Cassette 4
5 Side paper deck
6 to 8 not used
9 duplex unit
10 manual feed tray
6. ERR
a. Displays error data
F-17-10
AA Error sequence number 1 to 50 (the larger the number, the older the error)
BBBB Date of error
CCCC Time of error
DDDD Time error was restored
EEEE Error code
FFff Detail code "0000" if none.
G Error location
0: Main controller
1: DADF
2: Finisher
3: Unused
4: Reader unit
5: Printer unit
6: PDL board (any of)
7: Fax board
7. HV-STS
T-17-11
COPY>DISPLAY>HV-STS
Sub item Description level.
1ATVC-Y Primary transfer ATVC current monitor value (Y) 2
1ATVC-M Primary transfer ATVC current monitor value (M) 2
1ATVC-C Primary transfer ATVC current monitor value (C) 2
1ATVC-K4 Primary transfer ATVC current monitor value (K of 4C) 2
2ATVC Secondary transfer ATVC result 2
8. CCD
T-17-12
COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD
Sub item Description level.
TARGET-B Use it to check the shading target value for B. 2
TARGET-G Use it to check the shading target value for G. 2
TARGET-R Use it to check the shading target value for R. 2
OFST CCD offset level adjustment value 2
GAIN CCD gain level adjustment value 2
MFIL Main scanning direction MTF correction index 2
SFIL Sub scanning direction MTF correction index 2
17-9
Chapter 17
9. DPOT
Displaying Photosensitive Drum Surface Potential Control Data
T-17-13
COPIER>DISPLAY>DPOT
Sub item Description level.
MEMO:
For items other than DPOT-K, displaying value at the time of the latest potential control.
2TR-PPR Use it to check the output value of the paper separation voltage of the secondary transfer DC voltage generated last. 2
2TR-BASE Use it to check the output value of the reference voltage of the secondary transfer DC voltage generated last. 2
1TR-DC-Y Use it to check the output value of the primary transfer DC voltage (Y) generated last. 2
1TR-DC-M Use it to check the output value of the primary transfer DC voltage (M) generated last. 2
1TR-DC-C Use it to check the output value of the primary transfer DC voltage (C) generated last. 2
1TR-DC-K Use it to check the output value of the primary transfer DC voltage (K) generated last. 2
CHG-AC-Y output value of primary charge AC voltage (Y) output last 2
CHG-AC-M output value of primary charge AC voltage (M) output last) 2
CHG-AC-C output value of primary charge AC voltage (C) output last) 2
CHG-AC-K output value of primary charge AC voltage (Bk) output last) 2
10. DENS
T-17-14
COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS
Sub item Description level.
DENS-Y/M/C/K Calculated value of developer concentration (indicated as % off target value)
Appropriate values -2.0 to 2.0%
1
Note
Value is updated when toner is supplied after main power switch ON.
DENS-S-Y/M/C/K Detection density value of the sample image created at ATR control (Y/M/C/Bk) 2
DEV-DC-Y/K The latest output value of the development DC voltage (Y/Bk) 2
CHG-DC-Y/K The latest output value of the primary charging DC voltage (Y/Bk) 2
DMX-DATA Result of Dmax control 2
11. MISC
T-17-15
COPIER>DISPLAY>MISC
Sub item Description level.
ENV-TR printer internal environment display
1: Low humidity environment (5.8 g or less moisture)
1
2: Normal humidity environment (5.9 to 17.3 g moisture)
3: High humidity environment (17.3 g or more moisture)
Y/M/C/K-DRM-LF Drum unit life (Y/M/C/Bk)
Expresses how much of life has expired (as percentage).
Appropriate values 0 to 100 (%) 1
Note
0% when new drum unit is inserted.
12. ALARM-2
a. Displays alarm data
F-17-11
AA Alarm sequence number 1 to 50 (the larger the number, the older the error)
BBBB Date of alarm
17-10
Chapter 17
17-11
Chapter 17
13. ENVRNT
F-17-12
No. number of a data piece (higher the number, older the data piece)
DATE date of data collection
TIME time of data collection
D + deg C machine inside temperature
E+% machine inside humidity
F + deg C fixing roller surface (middle) temperature
17-12
Chapter 17
17.2.2 FEEDER
T-17-17
FEEDER>DISPLAY
Sub item Description level.
FEEDSIZE Displays the document size detected by the ADF.
Note
1
Displays the document size as a paper size such as A4 or LTR.
For paper names, see COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-U1, CST-U2.
TRY-WIDE Indicates the length of the original width detection slide (paper width detention; 0.1 mm).
Indicates the length of the slide used to detect the width of the original in the DF's original pickup tray (distance between 1
2 points).
17.3.1 Overview
0014-6637
The following appears in response to COPIER>I/O; descriptions of the items (limited to those needed in the field) area given on the pages that follow:
DC-CON
R-CON
FEEDER
SORTER
MN-CONT
F-17-13
Bit0
Bit7
Address
F-17-14
17-13
Chapter 17
17.3.2 <DC-CON>
0014-6638
T-17-18
17-14
Chapter 17
17.3.3 <R-CON>
0014-6639
T-17-19
17.3.4 <FEEDER>
0014-6640
T-17-20
17-15
Chapter 17
17.3.5 <SORTER>
0014-6641
T-17-21
17-16
Chapter 17
T-17-22
17-17
Chapter 17
17-18
Chapter 17
T-17-23
17-19
Chapter 17
17.3.6 <MN-CONT>
0014-6642
T-17-24
17-20
Chapter 17
17-21
Chapter 17
17.4.1 COPIER
1. ADJ-XY
Adjust the scanner image leading edge position
T-17-25
COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY
Sub item Description level.
ADJ-X Use it to adjust the scanner image leading edge position (i.e., image read start position in sub scanning direction).
Method of adjustment
- if the non-image width is larger than indicated, decrease the setting.
- if an area outside the original is copied, increase the setting.
- an increase by '1' will move the image read start position toward the trailing edge by 0.1 mm (i.e., move the image read
1
area toward the trailing edge).
- if you have initialized the RAM of the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment 1 to 100 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 20]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
ADJ-Y Use it to adjust the read start cell position of the CCD (i.e., image read start position in main scanning direction).
Method of Adjustment
- if the non-image width is larger than indicated, decrease the setting.
- if an area outside the original is copied, increase the setting.
- an increase by '1' will move the image read start position toward the front by 0.1 mm (i.e., move the image read area
1
toward the front).
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment 85 to 169 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 131]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
ADJ-Y-DF Use it to adjust the main scanning points for DF SRAM reading mode.
Method of Adjustment
- an increase by '1' will move the image read start position to the front by 0.1 mm.
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value 1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment 50 to 250 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 158]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
STRD-POS Use it to adjust the CCD read position for DF stream reading mode.
Method of Adjustment
- an increase by '1' will move the image read position to the left by 1 mm.
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value 1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment 1 to 200 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 100]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
Image’s leading
edge Platen glass
Vertical size plate (incorporating white plate)
White plate
Document
17-22
Chapter 17
2. CCD
T-17-26
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
Sub item Description level.
W-PLT-X/Y/Z Use it when entering the white label data indicated on the standard white plate.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
1
- if you have replaced the copyboard glass, enter the value indicated on the copyboard glass. (See the figure below)
Range of Adjustment: 1 to 9999
[Factory default/After RAM clear: W-PLT-X=8244: W-PLT-Y=8707: W-PLT-Z=9383]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
CCDU-RG Use it to correct color displacement in sub scanning direction between RG associated with the CCD unit.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value indicated
1
on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
MTF-MG Enter the MTF correction value in the main scanning direction.
Adjustment method:
- When executing RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label .
- When replacing the CIS unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the CIS unit. 1
Setting range: 0 to 99
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
When you changed this setting, enter the new value on the service label.
MTF-SG Enter the MTF correction value in the sub scanning direction.
Adjustment method:
- When executing the RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
- When replacing the CIS unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the CIS unit. 1
Setting range: 0 to 99
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
When you changed this setting, enter the new value on the service label.
BOOK-RG Enter the offset value for color misalignment caused by the copyboard glass.
Adjustment method:
- When executing RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
- When replacing the copyboard glass, enter the numeric value indicated on the copyboard glass. 1
Setting range: -150 to 150
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
When you changed this setting, enter the new value on the service label.
DF-RG Enter the offset value for color misalignment caused by the stream reading glass.
Adjustment method:
- When executing RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
- When replacing the stream reading glass, enter the numeric value indicated on the stream reading glass. 1
Setting range: -150 to 150
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
When you changed this setting, enter the new value on the service label.
17-23
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
Sub item Description level.
50-RG Display the offset value for color misalignment (between RGs) at 50% reading in the BOOK mode.
Adjustment method:
When executing RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
1
Setting range: -150 to 150
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
MEMO:
When you changed this setting, enter the new value on the service label.
50-GB Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement; GB) for book mode at 50% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
100-RG Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement; RG) for book mode at 100% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
100-GB Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement; GB) for book mode at 100% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
50DF-RG Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement RG) for ADF mode at 50% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
50DF-GB Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement; GB) for ADF mode at 50% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
100DF-RG Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement; RG) for ADF mode at 100% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
100DF-GB Use it to indicate the degree of offset (color displacement; GB) for ADF mode at 100% reading.
Method of Adjustment
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
1
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: -150 to 150 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
DFTAR-R Use it when entering the shading target value (red) for use when the DF is used (i.e., normal original read position).
Method of Adjustment
- COPIER>FUNCTION>CC>WLVL1/DF-WLVL2
if the image has a fault when the foregoing service mode item has been executed (e.g., as caused by soiling of the chart),
enter the factory measurement using this mode item. 1
- if you have initialize the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: 1 to 2047 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 1106]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
DFTAR-G Use it when entering the shading target (green) for the DF (normal original reading position).
Method of Adjustment
- COPIER>FUNCTION>CD>DF-WLVL1/DF-WLVL2
if the image starts to develop a fault after executing the foregoing service mode item (e.g., as caused by soiling of the
chart), enter the factory measurement using this mode. 1
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: 1 to 2047 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 1131]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
17-24
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
Sub item Description level.
DFTAR-B Use it to enter the shading target value (blue) for the DF (normal original read position).
Method of Adjustment
- COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-WLVL1/DF-WLVL2
if the image starts to develop a fault after executing the foregoing service mode item, enter the factory measurement using
this mode item. 1
- if you have initialized the RAM on the reader controller PCB or replaced the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Range of Adjustment: 1 to 2047 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 1185]
Attention:
If you have changed the setting, be sure to record the new setting on the service label.
DFTAR2-R Enter the shading target value (RED color) for the use of DF. (second document reading position)
Adjustment method:
- When a fault occurs in the image (due to dirt on the chart, etc.) after executing COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-
WLVL2, use this mode and enter the factory measurement value.
1
- When executing RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Setting range: 1 to 2047
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 1138]
DFTAR2-G Enter the shading target value (GREEN color) for the use of DF. (second document reading position)
Adjustment method:
- When a fault occurs in the image (due to dirt on the chart, etc.) after executing COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-
WLVL2, use this mode and enter the factory measurement value.
1
- When executing RAM clear for the reader controller PCB or replacing the reader controller PCB, enter the value
indicated on the service label.
Setting range: 1 to 2047
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 1154]
DFTAR2-B Enter the shading target value (BLUE color) for the use of DF. (second document reading position)
Adjustment method:
When a fault occurs in the image (due to dirt on the chart, etc.) after executing COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-
1
WLVL2, use this mode and enter the factory measurement value.
Setting range: 1 to 2047
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 1201]
820686679349
va l u e o f W- P L AT E - X va l u e o f W- P L AT E - Z
va l u e o f W- P L AT E - Y
F-17-17
3. LASER
Laser Output Adjustment
T-17-27
COPIER>ADJUST>LASER
Sub item Description level.
LA-PWR-A Enter the laser power adjustment value for Laser A.
This machine adjusts the laser power at DMAX for PCRG initialization. This item adjusts the laser power Y. This can
1
be used to determine a cause of a density fault. When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the value corresponding to PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 15
LA-PWR-B Enter the laser power adjustment value for Laser B.
This machine adjusts the laser power at DMAX for PCRG initialization. This item adjusts the laser power Y. This can
1
be used to determine a cause of a density fault. When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the value corresponding to PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 15
LA-PWR-C Enter the laser power adjustment value for Laser C.
This machine adjusts the laser power at DMAX for PCRG initialization. This item adjusts the laser power Y. This can
1
be used to determine a cause of a density fault. When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the value corresponding to PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 15
LA-PWR-D Enter the laser power adjustment value for Laser D.
This machine adjusts the laser power at DMAX for PCRG initialization. This item adjusts the laser power Y. This can
1
be used to determine a cause of a density fault. When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the value corresponding to PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 15
FSLUT-Y1 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 1
Correction value for the second block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-Y2 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 2
Correction value for the second block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-Y3 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 3
Correction value for the third block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
17-25
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>LASER
Sub item Description level.
FSLUT-Y4 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 4
Correction value for the fourth block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-Y5 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 5
Correction value for the fifth block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-Y6 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 6
Correction value for the sixth block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-Y7 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 7
Correction value for the seventh block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-Y8 Partial ratio adjustment for Y-color images in the main scanning direction: 8
Correction value for the eighth block of partial ratio correction Y
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M1 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 1
Correction value for the first block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M2 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 2
Correction value for the second block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M3 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 3
Correction value for the third block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M4 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 4
Correction value for the fourth block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M5 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 5
Correction value for the fifth block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M6 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 6
Correction value for the sixth block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M7 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 7
Correction value for the seventh block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-M8 Partial ratio adjustment for M-color images in the main scanning direction: 8
Correction value for the eighth block of partial ratio correction M
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C1 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 1
Correction value for the first block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C2 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 2
Correction value for the second block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C3 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 3
Correction value for the third block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
17-26
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>LASER
Sub item Description level.
FSLUT-C4 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 4
Correction value for the fourth block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C5 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 5
Correction value for the fifth block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C6 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 6
Correction value for the sixth block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C7 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 7
Correction value for the seventh block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-C8 Partial ratio adjustment for C-color images in the main scanning direction: 8
Correction value for the eighth block of partial ratio correction C
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K1 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 1
Correction value for the first block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K2 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 2
Correction value for the second block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K3 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 3
Correction value for the third block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K4 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 4
Correction value for the fourth block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K5 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 5
Correction value for the fifth block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K6 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 6
Correction value for the sixth block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K7 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 7
Correction value for the seventh block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
FSLUT-K8 Partial ratio adjustment for Bk-color images in the main scanning direction: 8
Correction value for the eighth block of partial ratio correction K
When replacing the laser scanner unit, enter the value indicated on the label attached to the unit. When no value is 1
entered, color misalignment occurs.
Setting range: 0 to 99
4. IMG-REG
Adjustment for color displacement of the color image
T-17-28
COPIER>ADJUST>IMG-REG
Sub item Description level.
REG-H-Y Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for Y
Offset the writing position of Y-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-H-M Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for M
Offset the writing position of M-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-27
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>IMG-REG
Sub item Description level.
REG-H-C Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for C
Offset the writing position of C-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-H-K Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for K
Offset the writing position of K-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-HS-Y Finely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for Y
Offset the writing position of Y-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of 1/16 pixel. Use this item to
adjust color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of 1/16 pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-HS-M Finely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for M
Offset the writing position of M-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of 1/16 pixel. Use this item to
adjust color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of 1/16 pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-HS-C Finely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for C
Offset the writing position of C-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of 1/16 pixel. Use this item to
adjust color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of 1/16 pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-HS-K Finely adjust the writing position (in the main scanning direction) of the pattern for K
Offset the writing position of K-color images (in the main scanning direction) in the unit of 1/16 pixel. Use this item to
adjust color misalignment in the main scanning direction in the unit of 1/16 pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-V-Y Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the sub scanning direction) of the pattern for Y
Offset the writing position of Y-color images (in the sub scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the sub scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-V-M Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the sub scanning direction) of the pattern for M
Offset the writing position of M-color images (in the sub scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the sub scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-V-C Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the sub scanning direction) of the pattern for C
Offset the writing position of C-color images (in the sub scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the sub scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
REG-V-K Coarsely adjust the writing position (in the sub scanning direction) of the pattern for K
Offset the writing position of K-color images (in the sub scanning direction) in the unit of pixel. Use this item to adjust
color misalignment in the sub scanning direction in the unit of pixel. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
5. DENS
Concentration of developer in developer unit.
T-17-29
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
Sub item Description level.
SGNL-Y Display the Y-color toner density signal value when executing "INIT" for ATR control.
Display the Y-color toner density signal value when executing ATR-INIT, which is implemented at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 65535
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
SGNL-M Display the M-color toner density signal value when executing "INIT" for ATR control.
Display the M-color toner density signal value when executing ATR-INIT, which is implemented at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 65535
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
SGNL-C Display the C-color toner density signal value when executing "INIT" for ATR control.
Display the C-color toner density signal value when executing ATR-INIT, which is implemented at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 65535
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
SGNL-K Display the K-color toner density signal value when executing "INIT" for ATR control.
Display the K-color toner density signal value when executing ATR-INIT, which is implemented at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 65535
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-28
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
Sub item Description level.
SIGG-Y Display the gain value for the Y-color toner density standard signal for ATR control.
Display the Y-color patch level when executing ATR-INIT, which is executed at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 255
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
SIGG-M Display the gain value for the M-color toner density standard signal for ATR control.
Display the M-color patch level when executing ATR-INIT, which is executed at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 255
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
SIGG-C Display the gain value for the C-color toner density standard signal for ATR control.
Display the C-color patch level when executing ATR-INIT, which is executed at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 255
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
SIGG-K Display the gain value for the K-color toner density standard signal for ATR control.
Display the K-color patch level when executing ATR-INIT, which is executed at PCRG initialization.
Use this item to determine a cause of a density fault.
1
When replacing the DCON PCB, enter the unique ATR-INIT value for each PCRG.
Setting range: 0 to 255
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
T-SPLY-Y Adjust the toner supply amount (Y-color)
Adjustment method:
When executing RAM clear for the DC controller PCB or replacing the DC controller PCB, enter the value indicated on
2
the service label.
Adjustment range: -3 to 3
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
T-SPLY-M Adjust the toner supply amount (M-color)
Adjustment method:
When executing RAM clear for the DC controller PCB or replacing the DC controller PCB, enter the value indicated on
2
the service label.
Adjustment range: -3 to 3
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
T-SPLY-C Adjust the toner supply amount (C-color)
Adjustment method:
When executing RAM clear for the DC controller PCB or replacing the DC controller PCB, enter the value indicated on
2
the service label.
Adjustment range: -3 to 3
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
T-SPLY-K Adjust the toner supply amount (K-color)
Adjustment method:
When executing RAM clear for the DC controller PCB or replacing the DC controller PCB, enter the value indicated on
2
the service label.
Adjustment range: -3 to 3
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
DMAX-K Adjust the offset for the target value of K-color density control.
Adjustment method:
Set the offset value for the target value of K-color density control at D-MAX control. 2
Setting range: -8 to 8
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
P-TG-Y Adjust the offset for the target value (Y-color) of ATR control.
Add the offset to the ATR patch TGT which was determined at initialization, and change the T/D ratio.
Changing the setting value by 1 will add the offset value by 30 levels to ATR patch TGT.
2
Use this item for low/high density or fogging images.
Setting range: -4 to 4
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
P-TG-M Adjust the offset for the target value (M-color) of ATR control.
Add the offset to the ATR patch TGT which was determined at initialization, and change the T/D ratio.
Changing the setting value by 1 will add the offset value by 30 levels to ATR patch TGT.
2
Use this item for low/high density or fogging images.
Setting range: -4 to 4
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
P-TG-C Adjust the offset for the target value (C-color) of ATR control.
Add the offset to the ATR patch TGT which was determined at initialization, and change the T/D ratio.
Changing the setting value by 1 will add the offset value by 30 levels to ATR patch TGT.
2
Use this item for low/high density or fogging images.
Setting range: -4 to 4
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
P-TG-K Adjust the offset for the target value (Bk-color) of ATR control.
Add the offset to the ATR patch TGT which was determined at initialization, and change the T/D ratio.
Changing the setting value by 1 will add the offset value by 30 levels to ATR patch TGT.
2
Use this item for low/high density or fogging images.
Setting range: -4 to 4
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-29
Chapter 17
6. BLANK
Adjustment for the leading edge of image/margin of the rear end
T-17-30
COPIER>ADJUST>BLANK
Sub item Description level.
BLANK-T Used to enter adjusted value of image blank width (leading edge).
Adjustment method
1
- If you have cleared the main controller PCB's RAM or replaced the SRAM PCB, enter the value on the service label.
Adjustment range 0 to 1000 [Factory default/After RAM clear: +59]
BLANK-L Used to enter adjusted value of image blank width (left edge).
Adjustment method
1
- If you have cleared the main controller PCB's RAM or replaced the SRAM PCB, enter the value on the service label.
Adjustment range 0 to 1000 [Factory default/After RAM clear: +47]
BLANK-R Used to enter adjusted value of image blank width (right edge).
Adjustment method
1
- If you have cleared the main controller PCB's RAM or replaced the SRAM PCB, enter the value on the service label.
Adjustment range 0 to 1000 [Factory default/After RAM clear: +47]
BLANK-B Used to enter adjusted value of image blank width (trailing edge).
Adjustment method
1
- If you have cleared the main controller PCB's RAM or replaced the SRAM PCB, enter the value on the service label.
Adjustment range 0 to 1000 [Factory default/After RAM clear: +59]
7. V-CONT
Potential Control System Adjustment
T-17-31
COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT
Sub item Description Level.
VCONT-Y/K Adjust the image contract electric potential.
Use this item for low/high density. Since the same high pressure is used for Y, M, and C, adjusting VCONT-Y will also
adjust M and C.
Adjustment range: -5 to 5 (Unit: 10V)
2
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
Setting a larger value increases density. Note that the adjustment is made to all Y, M, and C.
Be sure not to use this item in normal operation.
VBACK-Y/K Adjust the image contract electric potential.
Use this item for low/high density. Since the same high pressure is used for Y, M, and C, adjusting VCONT-Y will also
adjust M and C.
Adjustment range: -5 to 5 (Unit: 10V)
2
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
Attention:
Setting a larger value increases density. Note that the adjustment is made to all Y, M, and C.
Be sure not to use this item in normal operation.
8. PASCAL
Adjustment for auto gradation correction control
T-17-32
COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL
Sub item Description level.
OFST-P-Y/M/C/K Use it to apply offset adjustment on the test print reading signal (Y) for PASCAL control at time of auto gradation
correction (full).
1
Method of Adjustment
- a higher setting will make the image darker after auto gradation correction (full).
Range of Adjustment: -128 to +128 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
9. COLOR
Adjustment for color balance
T-17-33
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
Sub item Description Level.
ADJ-Y/M/C/K Adjust the color balance of Y/M/C/K colors for users.
Change the default value of the color balance when the output density varies by machine. Setting a larger value increases
density. Setting a smaller value decreases density. 1
Setting range: -8 to 8
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFST-Y/M/C/K Adjust the density and color balance of the bright part of Y/M/C/K colors.
Offset the color balance of the bright part when the document base is not normally read. Setting a larger value increases
the color balance. Setting a smaller value decreases the color balance.
When the base is not normally eliminated and it looks like a fogging image, decrease the value until the fogging becomes 1
invisible.
Setting range: -32 to 32
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
LD-OFS-Y/M/C/K Adjust the color balance of low density area.
Be sure not to use this item in normal operation.
2
Setting range: -8 to 8
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-30
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
Sub item Description Level.
MD-OFS-/Y/M/C/K Adjust the color balance of middle density area.
Be sure not to use this item in normal operation. (recommended setting value: -1)
2
Setting range: -8 to 8
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
HD-OFS-Y/M/C/K Adjust the color balance of high density area.
Be sure not to use this item in normal operation. (recommended setting value: -2)
2
Setting range: -8 to 8
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
10. HV-PRI
Primary Charging Assembly Output Adjustment
T-17-34
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI
Sub item Description Level.
OFSTAC-Y Offset value for the charging AC current at a constant speed (Y)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-M Offset value for the charging AC current at a constant speed (M)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-C Offset value for the charging AC current at a constant speed (C)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-K Offset value for the charging AC current at a constant speed (K)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-Y2 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/2 speed (Y)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-M2 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/2 speed (M)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-C2 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/2 speed (C)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-K2 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/2 speed (K)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-Y3 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/4 speed (Y)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-M3 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/4 speed (M)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-C3 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/4 speed (C)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
OFSTAC-K3 Offset value for the charging AC current at a 1/4 speed (K)
When a sanded image occurs, increase the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
1
Setting range: 0 to 5 (When incremented by 1, the value changes by 50muA.)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
11. HV-TR
Transfer Charging Assembly / Pre-Transfer Charging Assembly Output Adjustment
T-17-35
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
Sub item Description Level.
2TR-N1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of plain paper (at a constant speed at
600dpi).
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of plain paper, Environmental category: 1
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-31
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
Sub item Description Level.
2TR-N2 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of plain paper (at a constant speed
at 600dpi).
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of plain paper, Environmental category: 1
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-NH1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of plain paper (at a half speed at
1200dpi).
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of plain paper (1200dpi), Environmental
category: 1 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-NH2 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of plain paper (at a half speed at
1200dpi).
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of plain paper (1200dpi), Environmental
category: 1 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-P1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of a postcard.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of a postcard, Environmental category: 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-P2 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of a postcard.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of a postcard, Environmental category: 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-L1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of label paper.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Label paper, Environmental category: 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-SP1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of special paper (Special Paper 1, 2).
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Special paper, Environmental category: 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-H1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of thick paper.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 1 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 1
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-H2 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of thick paper.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 1 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 1
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-UH1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the first side of super thick paper.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 2 (164 to 220g/m2),
Environmental category: 1
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-UH2 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of super thick paper.
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of thick paper 2 (164 to 220g/m2),
Environmental category: 1
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-N12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of plain paper (600dpi
plain paper, 600dpi thin paper, 600dpi plain paper 2). (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of plain paper, Environmental category: 2
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-N22 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of plain paper (600dpi plain paper,
600dpi thin paper, 600dpi plain paper 2). (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of plain paper, Environmental category: 2
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-NH12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of plain paper (1200dpi
plain paper, 1200dpi thin paper, 1200dpi plain paper 2, Bond paper). (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of plain paper (1200dpi), Environmental
category: 2 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-32
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
Sub item Description Level.
2TR-NH22 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of plain paper (1200dpi plain paper,
1200dpi thin paper, 1200dpi plain paper 2, Bond paper). (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of plain paper (1200dpi), Environmental
category: 2 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-H12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of thick paper.
(Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 1 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 2 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-H22 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of thick paper. (Environmental
category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of thick paper 1 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 2 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-UH12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of super thick paper.
(Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 2 (164 to 220g/m2),
Environmental category: 2 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-UH22 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of super thick paper. (Environmental
category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of thick paper 2 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 2 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-P12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of a postcard (postcard,
envelope). (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of a postcard, Environmental category: 2
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-P22 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of a postcard (postcard, envelope).
(Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of a postcard, Environmental category: 2
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-L12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of label paper. (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Label paper, Environmental category: 2
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-SP12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of special paper (Special Paper 1, 2). (Environmental
category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Special paper, Environmental category: 2
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-N13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of plain paper (600dpi
plain paper, 600dpi thin paper, 600dpi plain paper 2). (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of plain paper, Environmental category: 3
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-N23 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of plain paper (600dpi plain paper,
600dpi thin paper, 600dpi plain paper 2). (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of plain paper, Environmental category: 3
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-NH13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of plain paper (1200dpi
plain paper, 1200dpi thin paper, 1200dpi plain paper 2, Bond paper). (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of plain paper (1200dpi), Environmental
category: 3 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-NH23 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of plain paper (1200dpi plain paper,
1200dpi thin paper, 1200dpi plain paper 2, Bond paper). (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of plain paper (1200dpi), Environmental
category: 3 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
17-33
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
Sub item Description Level.
2TR-H13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of thick paper.
(Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 1 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 3 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-H23 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of thick paper. (Environmental
category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of thick paper 1 (106 to 163g/m2),
Environmental category: 3 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-UH13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of super thick paper.
(Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of thick paper 2 (164 to 220g/m2),
Environmental category: 3 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-UH23 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of super thick paper. (Environmental
category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of thick paper 2 (164 to 220g/m2),
Environmental category: 3 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-P13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the single side or first side of a postcard (postcard,
envelope). (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, First side of a postcard, Environmental category: 3
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-P23 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias on the second side of a postcard (postcard, envelope).
(Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Second side of a postcard, Environmental category: 3
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-L13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of label paper. (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Label paper, Environmental category: 3
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-SP13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of special paper (Special Paper 1, 2). (Environmental
category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, Special paper, Environmental category: 3
1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained.
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-O1 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of OHP paper. (Environmental category: 1)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, OHP paper, Environmental category: 1
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-O12 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of OHP paper. (Environmental category: 2)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, OHP paper, Environmental category: 2
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
2TR-O13 Adjust the offset for paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias of OHP paper. (Environmental category: 3)
Offset value for the paper voltage of the secondary transfer bias, OHP paper, Environmental category: 3
When a transfer scattering occurs, increase/decrease the value until an appropriate image is obtained. 1
Setting range: -128 to 127 (Unit: 20V)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0]
1TR-TGY Adjust the offset for the primary transfer ATVC target current (Y)
Adjustment range: -10 to 10 (Unit: 1muA)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0] 2
This is valid when COPIER>OPTION>BODY>PTATVCSW=1 is set (the primary transfer ATVC control is valid).
17-34
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
Sub item Description Level.
Use this item when the following faulty images occur.
- A patchy trace / A trace of the auxiliary brush caused by transfer remaining toner (When the color in the brush trace
has high density) / A transfer ghost: The primary transfer current is low. --> Change the setting value to in the plus
direction. 2
- A trace of the auxiliary brush caused by double transfer fogging / double transfer remaining toner (When the color in
the brush trace has higher density than the one in the prior station): The primary transfer current is high. --> Change the
setting value to the minus direction.
1TR-TGM Adjust the offset for the primary transfer ATVC target current (M)
Adjustment range: -10 to 10 (Unit: 1muA)
[Factory setting value/Value after RAM clear: 0] 2
This is valid when COPIER>OPTION>BODY>PTATVCSW=1 is set (the primary transfer ATVC control is valid).
12. FEED-ADJ
T-17-36
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
Sub item Description level.
REGIST Used to adjust the registration roller clutch ON timing.
Adjustment method
- Increasing the value by 1 moves the image by 0.1 mm in the direction of the leading edge of the paper.
- If you have cleared the DC controller PCB's RAM or replaced the DC controller PCB, enter the value on the service 1
label.
Adjustment range - 50 to 50 (0.1 mm units)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: -20]
REG-THCK Registration clutch ON timing (thick paper)
Adjusts the margin on the leading edge (0.1mm scale) by adjusting the timing to turn ON the registration clutch for thick
paper. 1
Setting Range: 50 ~ -50
[Factory default value / post-RAM clear value: 0]
REG-OHT Registration clutch ON timing (OHT)
Adjustment of the OHT registration clutch ON timing allows adjustment of the leading edge margin (unit: 0.1mm).
1
Setting range: -50 to 50
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
REG-DUP1 Second page registration clutch ON timing (plain paper)
Adjustment of the plain paper second page registration clutch ON timing allows adjustment of the second page leading
edge margin (unit: 0.1mm). 1
Setting range: -50 to 50
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
REG-DUP2 Second page registration clutch ON timing (thick paper)
Adjustment of the thick paper second page registration clutch ON timing allows adjustment of the second page leading
edge margin (unit: 0.1mm). 1
Setting range: -50 to 50
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ADJ-C1 Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction when sheets are fed from cassette 1
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when 1
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-C2 Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction when sheets are fed from cassette 2
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when 1
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-C3 Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction when sheets are fed from cassette 3
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when 1
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-35
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
Sub item Description level.
ADJ-C4 Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction when sheets are fed from cassette 4
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when 1
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-MF Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction when the multi-feeder sheets are fed
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when 1
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-DK Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction when the paper deck sheets are fed
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when 1
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-C1RE Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction of second side of the sheets when first side of sheets for two-
sided copying in cassette 1 is fed (side registration adjustment)
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
1
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-C2RE Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction of second side of the sheets when first side of sheets for two-
sided copying in cassette 2 is fed (side registration adjustment)
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
1
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-C3RE Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction of second side of the sheets when first side of sheets for two-
sided copying in cassette 3 is fed (side registration adjustment)
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
1
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-C4RE Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction of second side of the sheets when first side of sheets for two-
sided copying in cassette 4 is fed (side registration adjustment)
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
1
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-DKRE Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction of second side of the sheets when first side of sheets for two-
sided copying in the paper deck is fed (side registration adjustment)
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
1
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ADJ-MFRE Image write position adjustment in main scanning direction of second side of the sheets when first side of sheets for two-
sided copying in the multi-feeder is fed (side registration adjustment)
Adjustment method
- When the value is incremented by 1, the image moves by 0.1 mm to the right.
1
- Input the value given on the service label when the RAM on the DC controller circuit board has been cleared or when
the DC controller circuit board has been replaced.
Adjustment range: -100 to 100 (in 0.1 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
13. CST-ADJ
T-17-37
COPIER>ADJUST>CST-ADJ
Sub item Description level.
MF-A4R Used to enter the basic value for the manual feed tray's paper width (A4R).
Adjustment method
- If you have cleared the DC controller PCB's RAM or replaced the DC controller PCB, enter the value on the service
label. 1
- When replacing the paper width detection VR or registering a new value, perform the following service mode:
FUNCTION>CST.
Adjustment range 0 to 255 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 141]
17-36
Chapter 17
COPIER>ADJUST>CST-ADJ
Sub item Description level.
MF-A6R Used to enter the basic value for the manual feed tray's paper width (A6R).
Adjustment method
- If you have cleared the DC controller PCB's RAM or replaced the DC controller PCB, enter the value on the service
label. 1
- When replacing the paper width detection VR or registering a new value, perform the following service mode:
FUNCTION>CST.
Adjustment range 0 to 255 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 235]
MF-A4 Used to enter the basic value for the manual feed tray's paper width (A4).
Adjustment method
- If you have cleared the DC controller PCB'sRAM or replaced the DC controller PCB, enter the value on the service
label. 1
- When replacing the paper width detection VR or registering a new value, perform the following service mode:
FUNCTION>CST.
Adjustment range 0 to 255 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 26]
14. MISC
T-17-38
COPIER>ADJUST>MISC
Sub item Description level.
SEG-ADJ Used to adjust the text and photo separation level for text/photo/map mode.
Adjustment method
- To make documents more easily recognized as photo documents, increase the setting value. 1
- To make documents more easily recognized as text documents, decrease the setting value.
Adjustment range -4to 4 (Value at time of factory shipment/value after RAM clear: 0)
K-ADJ Used to adjust the black recognition level during black text processing.
Adjustment method
1
- To make text more easily recognized as black, increase the setting value.
Adjustment range -3to 3 (Value at time of factory shipment/value after RAM clear: 0)
ACS-ADJ Used to adjust the color recognition level during ACS mode.
Adjustment method
To make documents more easily recognized as black and white documents, increase the setting value. 1
- To make documents more easily recognized as color documents, decrease the setting value.
Adjustment range -3to 3 (Value at time of factory shipment/value after RAM clear: 0)
ACS-EN - ACS-EN (Used to adjust ACS recognition zone.)
2
Increasing the setting value expands the recognition zone.
ACS-CNT - ACS-CNT (Used to adjust color recognition pixel count zone during ACS recognition.)
2
Increasing the setting value expands the recognition zone.
ACS-EN2 ACS judgement area adjustment (with DF stream reading)
Adjustment method
Increasing the setting value increases the judgement range. 2
Setting range: -2 to 2
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 1]
ACS-CNT2 Colour judgement pixel count area adjustment in ACS judgement (with DF stream reading)
Adjustment method
Increasing the setting value increases the judgement range. 2
Setting range: -2 to 2
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
REOS-PG REOS processing coefficient selection in 1200 dpi
Setting range: 0 to 4 2
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
17.4.2 FEEDER
T-17-39
FEEDER>ADJUST
Sub item Description level.
DOCST Adjusting the Original Image Leading Edge
Method of adjustment
A higher setting will delay the image leading edge timing.
1
Range of adjustment
-50 to 50 (unit: 0.1mm)
[Factory default/After RAM clear:0]
LA-SPEED Adjusting the document feeding speed at the time of stream reading from the feeder
The speed becomes faster (image is reduced) by increasing setting value.
1
Range of adjustment: -30 to 30 (unit: 0.1%)
[Factory default/After RAM clear:0]
17-37
Chapter 17
L4
Paper
F-17-18
- If the document is farther left than the arrow in the figure below: Increase the value (the leading edge blank is made smaller).
Document position
alignment mark Horizontal size plate
Paper
Document position
alignment mark Horizontal size plate
Paper
17.4.3 SORTER
T-17-40
SORTER>ADJUST
Sub item Description level.
PNCH-HLE Adjustment of distance from sheet edges to punch hole positions
This adjusts the hole positions to meet the conditions of the individual user.
1
Setting range: -4 to 2 (in mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-38
Chapter 17
17.5.1 COPIER
1. INSTALL
T-17-41
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL
Sub item Description level.
STIR-4 This mixes the developing solutions inside the developers of all the colors.
1
The Y, M, C and Bk developers are raced for two minutes to ensure that the developing solutions are mixed.
STRD-POS Automatic detection of CCD scanning position in DF stream reading 1
CARD Used to make card reader installation settings.
Setting values
1 to 2001 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
Operation method Enter the number of cards to use. (You can use up to 1,000 cards from the entered number.) 1
Initialize the card management information.
- Initialize the card name (department ID) (from the entered number).
- Initialize the card's password.
KEY Used to set management key function recognition.
Setting values
0: Don't recognize management key function (value at time of factory shipment).
1: Recognize management key function. 1
Operation method
1) Select COPIER > INSTALL > KEY, then enter '1'
2) Turn the main power switch OFF/ON (the management key function is now recognized).
AINR-OFF Walm-up-rotation disable setting at initial installation
This disables the initialization of the P-CRG which is performed when a new P-CRG has been inserted. It prevents the
fuse from blowing when the P-CRG initialization has been completed.
It is used when replacing the P-CRG and checking the images in situations when, for instance, the causes of trouble are
identified. When it is set to "1," the initialization is canceled and the fuse is not blown even when a new P-CRG has been
1
inserted.
Settings
0: Initialization is performed when a new unit is inserted. The fuse is blown.
1: Initialization is not performed when a new unit is inserted.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
E-RDS E-RDS settings
Setting values
0: Not in use 1
1: In use
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
RGW-PORT Specify port number of sales company server used in E-RDS
Setting range: 1 to 65535 1
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: ]
COM-TEST Check connection with sales company server used in E-RDS
Checks sales company server connection. Judges whether connection can be made and displays the results as OK or 1
FAIL.
COM-LOG Display detailed results of communication test with sales company server used in E-RDS
1
Displays information on any errors that have occurred in connection with sales company server.
RGW-ADR Specify URL of sales company server used in E-RDS
1
Sets sales company server URL.
CNT-DATE Set timing of counter transmission to server
Sets time and date for start of transmission of counter information to server, via E-RDS third party extension function.
Setting range: YYYYMMDDHHMM (YYYY: year, MM: month, DD: date, HH: hours, MM: minutes)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear::000000000000]
Note
This item is only displayed when the E-RDS third party extension function is enabled.Set timing of counter transmission
1
to server
Sets time and date for start of transmission of counter information to server, via E-RDS third party extension function.
Setting range: YYYYMMDDHHMM (YYYY: year, MM: month, DD: date, HH: hours, MM: minutes)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear:: 000000000000]
Note
This item is only displayed when the E-RDS third party extension function is enabled.
CNT-INTV Set interval of counter transmission to server
1
Sets transmission intervals for transmission of counter information to server, via E-RDS third party extension function.
INIT-Y Y color toner density signal (SGNL, REF) initial value reading
This is used when more than 100 sheets have passed through in error with a new CRG used in investigating image 2
defects, etc.
INIT-M M color toner density signal (SGNL, REF) initial value reading
This is used when more than 100 sheets have passed through in error with a new CRG used in investigating image 2
defects, etc.
INIT-C C color toner density signal (SGNL, REF) initial value reading
This is used when more than 100 sheets have passed through in error with a new CRG used in investigating image 2
defects, etc.
INIT-K K color toner density signal (SGNL, REF) initial value reading
This is used when more than 100 sheets have passed through in error with a new CRG used in investigating image 2
defects, etc.
17-39
Chapter 17
2. CCD
T-17-42
COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD
Sub item Description level.
DF-WLVL1/2 Use it to adjust the ADF white level.
Method of Operation
1) Place the type of original most often used by the user on the copyboard glass, and perform the following service mode
item: COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-WLVL1. (In response, the machine will read the white level for book mode,
checking the transmission quality of the glass for book mode).
2) Place the type of original most often used by the user in the DF, and perform the following service mode item: 1
COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>DF-WLVL2. (In response, the machine will read the white level for DF mode (stream
reading mode), checking the transmission quality of the reading glass by reading both sides of the original.)
face reading: computes DFTAR-R/G/B
back reading: computes DFTAR2-R/G/B
Be sure to execute this item in combination with item 2.
LUT-ADJ2 CCD gain detailed compensation
Operation procedure
1) Place the 10-gradation chart (D-10 test sheet: FY9-9129) on the document glass surface, as shown in the figure below.
2) Select the item, and press the OK key. Automatic adjustment now commences. 2
3) Upon completion of the adjustments, operation automatically stops.
4) Set the COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CCD-LUT value to "1."
5) The service mode (COPIER>ADJUST>CCD) item is updated so print out the service sheet and keep it.
3. CST
T-17-43
COPIER>FUNCTION>CST
Sub item Description level.
MF-A4R, MF-A6R, MF- Registers basic value of manual feeder's (DADF's) paper width.
A4 A4R width: 210mm, A6R width: 105mm, A4 width: 297mm
- Once registered, the basic value can be fine-tuned by performing COPIER> ADJUST > CST-ADJ > MF-A4R, MF-
A6R or MF-A4.
Operation method 1
1) Place A4R size paper in the manual feeder, and set the size guide to the A4R width.
2) In this service mode, select 'MF-A4R' to display the item in reverse. Press the OK key to perform automatic adjustment
and register the value.
3) Repeat Steps 1) and 2) to register the basic values for the A6R and A4 sizes.
4. CLEANING
T-17-44
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEANING
Sub item Descripti level.
2TR-CLN Secondary transfer roller cleaning
This is for the bias cleaning of the secondary transfer roller. 1
It is used when the sheets are stained or smudged by dirt in the secondary transfer roller toner.
TNR-COAT Secondary transfer outer roller toner application mode
When the right door is closed while the secondary transfer roller is not dirty (when a new roller is used), the substance
on the secondary transfer roller surfaces rubs against the ITB and becomes adhered to it, leaving areas of the images white
1
where the substance was rubbed onto the ITB. In order to remove this adhered substance, toner is transferred once to the
secondary transfer outer roller, and then the secondary transfer outer roller is cleaned.
This is used when the secondary transfer roller has been replaced with a new one.
5. FIXING
T-17-45
COPIER>FUNCTION>FIXING
Sub item Description level.
NIP-CHK Output for automatically measuring fixing nip width
The fixing nip width automatic measurement is started, and the measurement sheet is printed. The two-sided printing
operation is performed with solid magenta printed on the first side and nothing printed on the second side, and nipping
is performed when the second side is fixed.
This is used in order to check the nip width when the fixing unit, fixing film unit or pressure roller is replaced.
Operating procedure
1) Place A4 (LTR) size sheets in the stack bypass tray. 1
2) Press the OK key. (The paper in the stack bypass tray is fed.)
3) The sheets which have been fed stop temporarily at the fixing nip unit, and are delivered 15 seconds later.
4) Check that the nip width of the delivered sheets corresponds to the rating.
Nip width rating
Center area [b in figure below]: 8 mm or more
Left and right edges [a, c in figure below]: 1 mm or less
6. PANEL
T-17-46
COPIER>FUNCTION>PANEL
Sub item Description level.
LCD-CHK Used to check missing dots in LCD.
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key to start the operation.
1
The touch panel's front surface should light repeatedly in the sequence: white, black, red, green and blue. (Check that it
does.)
2) Press the stop key (the clear key on printer models) to end the operation.
17-40
Chapter 17
COPIER>FUNCTION>PANEL
Sub item Description level.
LED-CHK Used to check that operation panel's LEDs light.
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key to start the operation. 1
The LEDs light sequentially.
2) Press LED-OFF to end the operation.
LED-OFF Used in checking that operation panel's LEDs light.
Operation method 1
1) Selecting this item stops the LED-CHK operation.
KEY-CHK Used to check key input.
Operation method
1) Select "KEY-CHK" to display the number/name of the entered key.
1
2) Press the key to check. If the key is normal, the text for it appears in the
touch panel (see separate table) .
3) Select "KEY-CHK" again to exit the key input check operation.
TOUCHCHK Used to adjust coordinate positions of analog touch panel.
Operation method
- Used to align the touch panel touch position with the LCD coordinate position.
1
- Perform this service mode item if you have replaced the LCD unit.
1) Select "TOUCHCHK" to display the item in reverse, then press the OK key.
2) "+" appears on the touch panel at 9 positions sequentially. After you press each position, adjustment is complete.
T-17-47
7. PART-CHK
T-17-48
COPIER>FUNCTION>PART-CHK
Sub item Description level.
CL Used to specify clutch for operation check.
(Range: 1 to 10, 5 and above are reserved.)
Operation method
1) Select this item.
2) Enter the desired clutch code on the numeric keypad.
1: Two-sided registration clutch CL1 1
2: Two-sided paper feed clutch CL2
3: Conveyor clutch CL1 (paper deck)
4: Paper feed clutch CL2 (paper deck)
3) Press the OK key.
4) Press CL-ON, and check the operation.
CL-ON Used to start clutch operation check.
Operation method
1
1) Select this item, and press the OK key. The clutch turns ON/OFF in the pattern below.
0.5 second ON -> 10 seconds OFF -> 0.5 second ON -> 10 seconds OFF -> 0.5 second ON -> OFF
FAN Specify fan checking the operation.
Setting range: 1 to 10 (7 or above are reserves)
Operation method
1)Select the item.
2)Enter the fan code with the numeric keypad.
1: Power supply exhaust fan 1 (FM1), Power supply exhaust fan 2 (FM10)
2: Fixing exhaust fan (FM2)
3: Machine exhaust fan (FM3)
4: Cleaner fan (FM4) 1
5: Delivery cooling fan (FM5)
6: Manual feed cooling fan (FM6)
7: Delivery vertical path cooling fan (FM8)
8: ITB cooling power supply fan (FM11)
9: Vertical path delivery exhaust fan (FM13)
10: Face-down tray cooling fan (FM12)
3)Press [OK].
4)Check the operation by pressing [FAN-ON].
17-41
Chapter 17
COPIER>FUNCTION>PART-CHK
Sub item Description level.
FAN-ON Start the fan operation.
Operations of the power supply fan, fixing fan, and cleaner fan
1)Select the item, and press [OK] so the next operation is executed.
ON for 10 sec with normal speed > ON for 10 sec with half speed > Standby state
Operations of the machine exhaust fan, delivery cooling fan, manual feed cooling fan, delivery vertical path cooling fan,
ITB cooling power supply fan, vertical path delivery exhaust fan, and face-down tray cooling fan 1
1) Select the item, and press [OK] so the next operation is executed.
ON for 10 sec with normal speed > Standby state
Motors other than toner container motor (Y/M/C/K) and horizontal registration motor:
1)Select the item, and press [OK].
ON for 10 sec > OFF
SL Used to specify solenoid for operation check.
(Range: 1 to 15; 10 and above are reserved.)
Operation method
1) Select this item.
2) Enter the desired solenoid code on the numeric keypad.
1: Manual paper feed solenoid SL1
2: Paper delivery path switching solenoid 1 SL2
3: Cassette 1 paper feed solenoid SL3
1
4: Cassette 2 paper feed solenoid SL4
5: Cassette 3 paper feed solenoid SL51
6: Cassette 4 paper feed solenoid SL52
7: Paper delivery path switching solenoid 2 SL5
8: Paper deck paper feed solenoid SL1D
9: Paper container OPEN solenoid SL2D
3) Press the OK key.
4) Press SL-ON, and check the operation.
SL-ON Starts solenoid operation.
Operation method
1
1) Select this item, and press the OK key. The solenoid turns ON/OFF in the pattern below.
0.5 second ON -> 10 seconds OFF -> 0.5 second ON -> 10 seconds OFF -> 0.5 second ON -> OFF
8. CLEAR
T-17-49
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
Sub item Description level.
ERR Clears error codes.
(Cleared error codes: E000, E001, E002, E003)
Operation method 1
1) Select this item, and press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
17-42
Chapter 17
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
Sub item Description level.
DC-CON Clears DC controller PCB's RAM.
MEMO:
The RAM is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Operation method
1
1) Select COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > P-PRINT to print out the service mode setting values.
2) Select this item, then press the OK key.
3) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
4) Enter the data printed by the P-PRINT operation as needed.
R-CON Use it to reset the RAM on the reader controller PCB.
Method of Operation
The RAM will not be cleared until the main power switch has been turned off and then on again.
1
2) Select the item, and press the OK key.
3) Turn off and then on the main power.
4) As necessary, enter the settings printed out using 'PRINT'.
JAM-HIST Clears reader controller PCB's RAM.
MEMO:
The RAM is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Operation method
1
1) Select COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > P-PRINT to print out the service mode setting values.
2) Select this item, then press the OK key.
3) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
4) Enter the data printed by the P-PRINT operation as needed.
ERR-HIST Clears error code history.
MEMO:
The error code history is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
1
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
PWD-CLR Clears "System administrator" password set in user mode.
MEMO:
The password value is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
1
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
ADRS-BK Clears address book data.
MEMO:
The address book data is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
1
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
CNT-MCON Clears service counters maintained by main controller PCB (main).
(See the COUNTER mode items for the counters cleared.)
MEMO:
The counter values are cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON. 1
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
CNT-DCON Clears following service counters maintained by DC controller PCB:
- COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2>SORT
- COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2>FIN-STPR
- COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2>FIN-PDDL
- COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2>SADDLE
- COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2>SDL-STPL 1
Attention:
The counter values are cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
OPTION Restores OPTION service mode setting values to default values (RAM clear values).
Attention:
The setting values are cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Note The cleared data is the data in the main controller, DC controller and reader controller.
1
Operation method
1) Select COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > P-PRINT to print out the service mode setting values.
2) Select this item, then press the OK key.
3) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
MMI Clears following user mode setting values:
- Backup data for copy operation panel (user-set values)
- Common settings backup data (user-set values)
- Backup data (except fax data) (user-set values)
Attention: 1
The setting values are cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
MN-CON Clears RAM on main controller PCB's SRAM board.
Attention:
- The RAM is cleared after the OK key is pressed.
- Performing this item initializes all the data on the SRAM board. In other words, file management information for the
hard disk is initialized, and image data on the hard disk can no longer be read. Before performing this item, explain to 1
the user that all images in the BOX will be lost, and receive permission to perform.
Operation method
1) Select COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > P-PRINT to print out the service mode setting values.
2) Select this item, then press the OK key.
17-43
Chapter 17
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
Sub item Description level.
CARD Clears card ID (department) data.
Attention:
The card ID data is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
1
Operation method
1) Select this item, then press the OK key.
2) Turn the main power OFF/ON.
LANG-ERR Clear language related error.
This item enables recovery when a language related error code is generated after switching from the default language. 1
(Returns to default language after recovery.)
ERDS-DAT Embedded-RDS SRAM data clear
1
SCM data in the embedded-RDS SRAM are restored to the factory settings.
Y-TN-CLR Y color toner counter clear
This clears the Y color toner counter.
1
Clear the counter when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner runs out after the low remaining Y color
toner warning has been given. To specify the counter to be cleared, execute COUNTER>MISC>T-SPLY-Y.
M-TN-CLR M color toner counter clear
This clears the M color toner counter.
1
Clear the counter when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner runs out after the low remaining M color
toner warning has been given. To specify the counter to be cleared, execute COUNTER>MISC>T-SPLY-M.
C-TN-CLR C color toner counter clear
This clears the C color toner counter.
1
Clear the counter when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner runs out after the low remaining C color
toner warning has been given. To specify the counter to be cleared, execute COUNTER>MISC>T-SPLY-C.
K-TN-CLR K color toner counter clear
This clears the K color toner counter.
1
Clear the counter when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner runs out after the low remaining K color
toner warning has been given. To specify the counter to be cleared, execute COUNTER>MISC>T-SPLY-K.
SND-STUP - use it to initialize the transmission read settings
After changing service mode settings (pressing the OK key), turn off and then on the power to initialize the backup data
of the transmission read settings. 2
Otherwise, after you have changed the display language, the language used before the change would remain. Be sure to
perform this mode item if you have switched the language.
CA-KEY CA authentication and key deleted together.
2
When the serviceman needs to replace or dispose of the device, the CA authentication and key can be deleted together.
KEY-CLR HDD encoding board code key clear
The HDD encoding board (security kit) code key is cleared to allow replacement.
When this item is selected and OK pressed, the code key is cleared. Then, when the main power supply is turned OFF/
ON, the encoding board installation processing activates. If installation processing is carried out, a new code key is
2
generated.
Caution!
If this operation is carried out, all data on the HDD will be rendered useless. The main power supply is switched OFF/
ON after this operation in order to format the HDD.
9. MISC-R
T-17-50
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R
Sub item Description level.
SCANLAMP Use it to check the activation of the scanning lamp.
Method of Operation
1
1) Select the item.
2) Press the OK key so that the scanning lamp will go on and remain on for 3 sec.
10. MISC-P
T-17-51
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P
Sub item Description level.
P-PRINT Prints service mode setting values.
Operation method
1) Select this item.
1
2) Press the OK key to print the setting values.
Reference:
Printing takes about 15 seconds to start.
KEY-HIST - KEY-HIST (Prints the operation panel's key input history.)
1) Select this item. 1
2) Press the OK key to start printing.
HIST-PRT - HIST-PRT (Prints the jam history and error history.)
1) Select this item. 1
2) Press the OK key to start printing.
USER-PRT Prints user mode list.
Operation method
1) Select this item.
1
2) Press the OK key to print the list.
Reference:
Printing takes about 3 seconds to start.
17-44
Chapter 17
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P
Sub item Description level.
LBL-PRNT Prints service label.
Operation method
1) Place A4/LTR paper in the manual feed tray.
2) Select this item. 1
3) Press the OK key to print the label.
Reference:
Printing takes about 15 seconds to start.
D-PRINT Printing out service mode (DISPLAY)
Procedure
1) Select this mode.
1
2) Press OK to print out.
Reference:
Only DISPLAY items are printed out. (Items of P-PRINT/LBL-PRINT/HIST-PRINT and ALARM are excluded.)
ENV-PRT Outputting logs of inside machine temperature and humidity/fixing roller surface temperature
Procedure
1) Select this mode.
2) Press OK to output logs of inside machine temperature and humidity/fixing roller surface temperature.
1
Reference:
This mode is to output logs of [inside temperature(deg C)/humidity(%)/fixing roller surface (center) temperature (deg
C)] variations using signals of the attached temperature/humidity (environmental) sensor and fixing thermistor (main).
(Max. 100 records)
PJH-P-1 Prints print job history with detailed information (for 100 jobs).
1
Prints print job history with detailed information for last 100 jobs stored in copier main unit.
PJH-P-2 Prints print job history with detailed information (for all jobs).
1
Prints print job history with detailed information for all jobs stored in copier main unit.
TRS-DATA - TRS-DATA (Moves the data received in memory to the BOX.)
1) Select this item. 1
2) Press the OK key to start printing.
11. SYSTEM
T-17-52
COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM
Sub item Description level.
DOWNLOAD Switches to download mode.
Operation method
1) Select this item.
2) Press OK to enter download mode and have the copier wait for commands (wait for connection). ("STNDBY" is now 1
displayed, next to the DOWNLOAD sub-items.)
3) Use the service support tool to start downloading. ("CONNECTED"is displayed during communication with the PC.)
4) When communication ends, "HOLD"is displayed. (The power can be turned off when "HOLD"is displayed.)
CHK-TYPE Used to specify partition number when performing HD-CHECK or HD-CLEAR.
Operation method
1) Select this item.
2) Use the numeric keypad to select the desired partition number.
0: Check and restore all bad sectors on hard disk
1: Image storage area 1
2: General-purpose file storage area
3: PDL file storage area
4: Firmware storage area
- General-purpose files include user-set data, log data, PDL spool data, and management information for image data.
3) Press the OK key.
HD-CHECK Use it to check the entire HD and perform recovery.
Operation method
set '0' to the following: COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM>CHK-TYPE 1
1) Select this item.
2) Press the OK key.
HD-CLEAR Initializes partition specified by CHK-TYPE item.
Attention:
- The following must be kept in mind and the user must be properly informed of the fact when using CHECK-TYPE:
0: entire HDD -> no operation occurs (to initialize, use the SST)
1: image storage area -> removes image data
2: general-purpose file area (user settings data, various log data, PDL spool data, image data control information) ->
initializes files
3: PDL-related file storage area -> removes font data, requiring re-installation
4: firmware, address book, filter storage area -> no operation occurs (to initialize, use the SST) 1
Operation method
1) Select this item.
2) Press the OK key.
Attention:
If you perform <HD-CLEAR> after selecting 1 (image storage area) or 3 (PDL file storage area) for the <CHK-TYPE>
item, the initialization process is performed after the power is turned OFF/ON.
The initialization process takes about 5 minutes. A progress bar slowly advances to indicate the progress during this time.
Never turn the power OFF during this time.
17-45
Chapter 17
COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM
Sub item Description level.
DEBUG-1 Setting of types of logs to be saved and timing at which they are to be saved on hard disk
This specifies the types of logs to be saved and the timing at which they are to be saved on the hard disk.
Setting range
0: For saving PLOGs. They are saved when Reboot/Exception has been detected.
1: For saving PLOGs. They are saved when Reboot/Exception/Ecode has been detected.
2: For saving SUBLOGs. They are saved when Reboot/Exception/Ecode has been detected.
3: For saving SUBLOGs in the overwrite mode. They are saved when Reboot/Exception/Ecode has been detected.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0] 2
Remarks
Logs of the PLOG type to be saved when "0" or "1" is set can be printed out by selecting
COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM>DEBUG-2. SUBLOGs to be saved when "2" or "3" is set cannot be printed out (they
are uploaded from SST).
MEMO:
- This is not used with normal servicing. (It is used for analyzing trouble causes.)
- To use it, the instructions given by the quality support division must be followed.
DEBUG-2 Printout of logs saved on hard disk
This prints out the PLOGs to be saved when "0" or "1" has been set for COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM>DEBUG-1.
Remarks
The SUBLOGs to be saved when "2" or "3" has been set for COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM>DEBUG-1 are not
printed out. The number of printout sheet is about 20 in the A4 size. 2
MEMO:
- This is not used with normal servicing. (t is used for analyzing trouble causes.)
- To use it, the instructions given by the quality support division must be followed.
17.5.2 FEEDER
T-17-53
FEEDER>FUNCTION
Sub item Description level.
MTR-CHK Use it to check the motor and the like of the ADF on its own.
Operation
1) Press [MOTOR-CHK] to highlight.
2) Enter the number of the component using the keypad.
3) Press the OK key.
4) Press [MOTOR-ON[ to start checking the operation.
1
Settings
0: pickup motor
1: feed motor
2: delivery reversal motor
3: lock motor
Operation
1) Press [FEED-CHK] to highlight.
2) Enter the number of the component using the keypad.
3) Press the OK key.
4) Press [FEED-ON] to start checking the operation.
1
Feed Mode
0: single-sided operation
1: double-side operation
2: single-sided operation w/ stamp
3: double-sided operation w/ stamp
Operation
1) Press [SL-CHK] to highlight
2) Enter the number of the component using the keypad.
3) Press the OK key.
4) Press [SL-ON] to start checking the operation. 1
Number of Component
0: lock solenoid
1: stamp solenoid
17-46
Chapter 17
FEEDER>FUNCTION
Sub item Description level.
SL-ON Use it to start the operation of the selected solenoid.
Operation
The operation varies from model to model.
1
1) Press [SL] to highlight; then, press the OK key to start motor operation.
2) Press the OK key once again to stop the ongoing operation.
(The operation will stop automatically in 5 sec; however, the indication will not change to [STOP] unless the OK key is
pressed once again.)
MTR-ON Use it to start motor operation.
Operation
The operation varies from model to model.
1
1) Press [MTR-ON] to highlight; then, press the OK key to start motor operation.
2) Press the OK key once again to stop the motor.
(The operation will stop automatically in 5 sec; however, the indication will not change to [STOP] unless the OK key is
pressed once again.)
ROLL-CLN Use it to clean the ADF roller.
In this mode item, the roller is rotated by the work of its motor; it is cleaned by lint-free paper (moistened with alcohol)
forced against it while it rotates.
1
Operation
1) Press [ROLL-CLN] to highlight.
2) While the roller is rotating, clean it by forcing lint-free paper (moistened with alcohol) against it.
3) Press [ROLL-CLN] to highlight, and press the OK key to stop the rotation of the roller.
FEED-ON Use it to check the movement of paper in the ADF on its own.
Operation 1
1) Press [FEED-ON], and then press the OK key so that the ADF starts to move paper according to the operation mode
selected using [FEED-CHK].
17.6.1 COPIER
1. BODY
T-17-54
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
Sub item Description level.
MODEL-SZ Used to select standard variable magnification display and ADF document size detection.
Caution!
The setting value takes effect after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Setting values
1
0: AB (6R5E)
1: INCH (5R4E)
2: A (3R3E)
3: AB/INCH (6R5E)
PASCAL Used to select whether to use the contrast electric potential calculated by automatic gradation compensation (full
compensation) control, and the gradation compensation data.
Caution!
- For printer models, you must always make this setting value 0 at time of installation.
- The setting value takes effect after the power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Setting values 1
0: Don't use
1: Use
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
CONFIG This selects the multiple firmware programs held on the hard disk, and selects the unit's country, language, destination
and sheet size series.
Attention:
The settings take effect after the main power switch has been set to OFF and then back to ON.
Operating procedure
1) Set the unit to the service mode, and select COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CONFIG.
2) Select the items to be selected, and press the "+" and "-" keys.
3) Each time the "+" and "-" key is pressed, the content changes.
1
4) Display the desired contents, and press the OK key.
5) Set the main power switch to OFF and then back to ON.
Settings: XXYYZZAA
XX: Country (example: JP -> Japan)
YY (*): Language (example: ja -> Japanese)
ZZ (*): Destination (example: 00 -> Canon)
AA: Sheet size series (example: 00 -> AB series)
*: This setting cannot be changed.
17-47
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
TEMP-TBL Fixing temperature regulation temperature table change
This is used to adjust the temperature of the temperature regulation for the regular paper (64 to 105g paper) uniform
speed. It improves the hot offset or fixability at the regular paper uniform speed.
Settings
-2:-10 deg C
1
-1:-5 deg C
0:0 deg C
+1:5 deg C
+2:+10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
W/SCNR For copy models, sets whether scanner is present.
Caution!
The setting value takes effect after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Setting values
1
0: Printer model
1: Model with scanner
Reference:
The setting will automatically change to '1' upon detection of the presence of a scanner (printer model).
RUI-DSP Used to select copy function in remote UI.
0: Display copy the screen in remote UI [Factory default/After RAM clear] 1
1: Don't display copy screen in remote UI
ADJ-LVL Sets execution mode for image stabilization control performed after preset number of sheets.
Sets execution mode (adjustment set data) for forward/reverse operation of copy or print jobs and image stabilization
control done between sheets.
Reference:
Automatic adjustment control execution mode setting
This makes it possible to reduce the wait time of the users by reducing the menu items to be executed by automatic
adjustment. The automatic adjustment control is executed for Dmax control, Dhalf and ARCDAT.
1
However, the fluctuations in the image density increase unless the process automatic adjustment is executed from the
user mode.
0: BkDmax control + Dhalf and ARCDAT are executed.
1: BkDmax control + Dhalf are executed. ARCDAT is not executed.
2: ARCDAT is executed. BkDmax control + Dhalf are not executed.
3: Neither BkDmax control + Dhalf nor ARCDAT are executed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
DFDST-L1 A higher setting will increase the level of dust detection (i.e., the machine will be more sensitive in detecting dust, which
if left behind will cause thin lines in the images).
settings range 1
0 to 255 (0: off)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 205]
DFDST-L2 A higher setting will increase the level of dust detection (i.e., the machine will be more sensitive in detecting dust, which
if left behind will cause thin lines in the images).
settings range 1
0 to 255 (0: off)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 155]
ENVP-INT Setting log correction interval of inner machine temperature/humidity/fixing temperature
Setting log collection interval to COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P>ENV-PRT and COPIER>DISPLAY>ENVRNT
Settings
1
0 to 480 <min>
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 60]
Reference Log is not collected when '0' is set.
CNTR-DSP Selecting screen in response to the external controller
Settings
0: The external controllericon is displayed on the control panel of the copier[Factory default/After RAM clear]
1
(When the color image server is connected.)
1: The control panel of the copier becomes nondisplay mode
(When the control panel-mounted external controller is connected.)
BASE-SW Switching from MEAP-Full model to MEAP-Base model
This is used when trouble originating in the MEAP application has occurred. The MEAP application operation can be
restricted by setting it to "0."
Settings
0: Base model 1
1: Full model
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
MEMO:
The model can be switched from "1" to "0" only.
SC-L-CNT Switching of sheet size large/small threshold value in scan counter
This sets the https server port when SSL is used by HTTP of MEAP.
0: B4 size sheets are counted as the small size. 1
1: Letter size sheets are counted as the small size.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
REPORT-Z Report print attribute flag function control
Switches attribute flags added to report prints.
Setting values
0: PDL text mode
1
1: PDL photograph mode
2: SCAN text mode
3: SCAN photograph mode
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
17-48
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
IFXEML-Z Colour iFAX, E-Mail Rx print attribute flag function control
Switches attribute flags added to colour iFAX, E-Mail Rx prints.
Setting values
0: PDL text mode
1
1: PDL photograph mode
2: SCAN text mode
4: SCAN photograph mode
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
BMLNKS-Z BMLinks Rx print attribute flag function control
Switches attribute flags added to colour BMLinks Rx prints.
Setting values
0: SCAN photograph mode
1
1: PDL photograph mode
2: SCAN text mode
3: PDL text mode
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
DST-POS Setting the switching position for document scanning in DF mode (repeat reading)
Setting the document scanning position compensation when the glass surface is dirty
0: Position #1 + position #2
1: Position #1
1
2: Position #2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Reference:
Position #2 is an open space so floating dirt tends to be reflected on the images.
CCD-LUT Whether data is to be used for CCD gain compensation
This is used to compensate for the deterioration in the images (density differences in the center joins of the images) which
develops over time. Set whether or not to use the values adjusted by selecting COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>LUT-
ADJ2.
1
Settings
0: Not used
1: Used
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ITBB-TMG ITB cleaning band frequency setting
This changes the band image frequency. Lengthening the intervals enables the down time and toner consumption to be
reduced.
Settings 1
0 to 10 (in increments of 1: One banding per 100 sheets)
No banding at the "0" setting
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
FX-D-TMP Setting of threshold value for starting throughput reduction sequence when small size sheets are passed through
This sets the productivity reduction start temperature for sheets with widths less than A4R and sheets of an undefined
format. It improves the hot offset and productivity of sheets with widths less than A4R and sheets of an undefined format.
1
Settings
-4 to 4
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FIX-ROT Threshold value setting of sub-thermistor temperature at which to end the racing after small size sheets have passed
through
This sets the large size job start temperature following the small size supporting fan-cooling. It improves the hot offset
or down time. 1
Settings
-2 to 2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FX-S-TMP ITOP temperature regulation offset adjustment
Adjustment of ITOP temperature for regular paper (64 to 105g paper) uniform speed
This reduces the unevenness in the gloss that appears for 94 mm at the leading edges of the sheets at the regular paper
1
uniform speed.
Settings
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
PAP-W-EN Density unevenness reduction mode during solid image output
This deals with cases where the left edges of solid images are darker or screw marks appear. Uneven density is reduced
by providing more space between the sheets so that the time during which the screw is rotated increases. Increase the
value when uneven density in the solid images becomes problematic. The time between sheets is increased by an amount
1
equivalent to the number of seconds set.
Setting
0 to 10 seconds
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TMP-TBL2 Fixing temperature regulation temperature offset (thick paper)
Temperature adjustment of the temperature regulation for thick paper (106 to 163g paper)
This improves the hot offset or fixability of the thick paper (106 to 163g paper).
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TMP-TBL3 Fixing temperature regulation temperature offset (super-thick paper)
Temperature adjustment of the temperature regulation for super-thick paper (164 to 220g paper)
This improves the hot offset or fixability of the super-thick paper (164 to 220g paper).
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-49
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
TMP-TBL5 Fixing temperature regulation temperature offset (4C thin paper)
Temperature adjustment of the temperature regulation for color thin paper
This improves the hot offset or fixability of color thin paper.
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TMP-TBL6 Fixing temperature regulation temperature offset (envelopes)
Temperature adjustment of the temperature regulation for envelopes
This improves the hot offset or fixability at the envelopes
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TMP-TBL7 Fixing temperature regulation temperature offset (special fixing mode)
Temperature adjustment of the temperature regulation for special fixing mode
This improves the hot offset or fixability in case of the special fixing mode
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXS-TMP2 ITOP temperature offset (thick paper)
Temperature adjustment of ITOP for thick paper (106 to 163g paper)
This reduces the unevenness of the gloss that appears for 94 mm at the leading edges of the thick sheets (106 to 163g
paper).
Settings
-2: -10 deg C 1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXS-TMP3 ITOP temperature offset (super-thick paper)
Temperature adjustment of ITOP for super-thick paper (164 to 220g paper)
This reduces the unevenness of the gloss that appears for 94 mm at the leading edges of the super-thick sheets (164 to
220g paper).
Settings
-2: -10 deg C 1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXS-TMP4 ITOP temperature offset (Bk OHT)
Temperature adjustment of ITOP for Bk OHT
This reduces the unevenness of the gloss that appears for 94 mm at the leading edges of Bk OHT paper.
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXS-TMP5 ITOP temperature offset (4C OHT)
Temperature adjustment of ITOP for color OHT
This reduces the unevenness of the gloss that appears for 94 mm at the leading edges of color OHT paper.
Settings
-2: -10 deg C
1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXS-TMP6 ITOP temperature offset (regular, thin, regular 2 1/2)
Temperature adjustment of ITOP for regular paper (64 to 105g paper) half speed
This reduces the unevenness of the gloss that appears for 94 mm at the leading edges of regular paper and half-speed
paper.
Settings
-2: -10 deg C 1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXST2-N2 L/L regular 2 ITOP wait time
Pre-rotation extension for regular 2 at an outside air temperature of 18 deg C or below.
This improves the fixability of regular 2 at an outside air temperature of 18 deg C or below. 1
Setting range: 0 to 20
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-50
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
FXST2-UH L/L super-thick paper ITOP wait time
Pre-rotation extension for super-thick paper at an outside air temperature of 18 deg C or below.
This improves the fixability of super-thick paper at an outside air temperature of 18 deg C or below. 1
Setting range: 0 to 30
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FN-ENTMP Fixing edge area cooling fan ON/OFF temperature
Fixing edge area cooling fan ON/OFF temperature
This improves the hot offset or fixability of the edge areas of standard small size paper (A4R width, LTRR width, B4
width, EXE width, K8 width, LDR width).
Settings
-4: -20 deg C
-3: -15 deg C
-2: -10 deg C 1
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C
+1: 5 deg C
+2: +10 deg C
+3: +15 deg C
+4: +20 deg C
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FX-ASTBY Not used 1
FX-UP-UH SRA3 super-thick paper fixability improvement mode
Pre-rotation extension for SRA3 size (320 x 450 mm) super-thick paper
This is used to improve the fixability particularly at the image edges on SRA3 size super-thick paper.
Settings 1
0: 0 sec.
1: 2 sec.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
PTN-LVL Half-tone image edge lateral streaks countermeasure mode
This changes the amount of toner which is discharged.
Lateral streaks sometimes appear when printing half tones on the edges of images in an L/L environment. Increment the
setting by 1 when these streaks appear. The disadvantage of doing this is the increase in the toner consumption. The
1
setting can be decremented by 1 when half tones are not going to be printed on the edges of images and/or when users
who are not bothered by the streaks want to reduce the toner consumption.
Setting range: -1 to 1
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TNR-WARN Low remaining toner warning display ON/OFF
This switches the low remaining toner warning between ON and OFF. Set it to "1" if the toners are to be replaced after
they have all been used up.
Settings 1
0: The warning is displayed.
1: The warning is not displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
IFX-CHIG Setting of character count for ignoring IFAX received mail text
When the text of a mail during IFAX reception is shorter than the number of characters set, it is ignored, and the text is
neither printed nor sent.
If the mail text has been lost as a result of setting the value to a number other than "0", and there is no attached TIFF file,
a blank page (except the header and footer) will be printed and sent.
* Kanji are treated as 2-byte characters, and the carriage return and other control codes are also included in the character 1
count.
Settings
0 to 999 (unit: number of characters)
0: The mail text is not ignored.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
SCANSLCT ON/OFF of function which obtains the scanning area from the selected sheet size
Settings
0: OFF (scanning area is determined by detection of document)
2
1: ON (scanning area is determined by sheet size)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
If the sheets are larger than the document size, productivity will drop at the "1" setting since the scanning area increases.
SENS-CNF Document detection sensor layout setting
Settings
0: AB system
1: Inch system
2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Attention:
The value is cleared to "0" by the clearing of the RAM on the reader controller circuit board. In machines destined for
inch system areas (such as North America), it must be set to "1."
RAW-DATA Sets whether to print out raw received data.
0: Normal operation [Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
1: Print out raw received data
RMT-LANG Used to select language of remote UI used from Web.
2
Select language code with + and - keys.
IFAX-LIM Used to select whether number of output lines will be restricted when largevolume data is received by IFAX.
0: No restriction 2
1 to 999 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 500]
SMTPTXPN Used to change SMTP send port number.
0 to 65535 (increments of 1) 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 25]
SMTPRXPN Used to change SMTP receive port number.
0 to 65535 (increments of 1) 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 25]
POP3PN Used to change POP receive port number.
0 to 65535 (increments of 1) 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 110]
17-51
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
ORG-LGL Use it to set a special paper size not recognized by the DF size detection mechanism.
settings
0: LEGAL
1: FOOLSCAP
2: A-FOOLSCAP
3: FORIO
4: G-LEGAL
2
5: OFFICIO
6: E-OFFICIO
7: A-OFFICIO
8: B-OFFICIO
9: A-LEAGAL
10: M-OFFICIO
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ORG-LTR Used to set special paper size not compatible with DF size recognition.
Setting values
0: LTR
1: G-LTR 2
2: A-LTR
3: EXECTIVE
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ORG-B5 Sets special paper sizes that cannot be detected in ADF.
Setting values
0: B5 2
1: K-LEGAL
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
UI-COPY Use it to select whether to display the copy screen in the control panel.
Setting values
0: Do not display the copy screen. 2
1: Display the copy screen.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
UI-BOX Used to select whether to display operation panel box screen.
Setting values
0: Don't display 2
1: Display
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
UI-SEND Used to select whether to display operation panel send screen.
Setting values
0: Don't display 2
1: Display
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
UI-FAX Used to select whether to display operation panel fax screen.
Setting values
0: Don't display 2
1: Display
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
SCR-SLCT Used to select half-tone process for photographic printing paper/photo mode.
Setting values
0: Use error diffusion method
2
1: Use low-line-count screen
2: Use high-line-count screen
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
TMC-SLCT Used to select coefficient used in error diffusion process.
Setting values
0: Low granularity/low dot stability for Y/M/C/Bk
2
1: Y/M/C -> Low granularity, low dot stability, Bk -> high granularity, low dot stability
2: High granularity/low dot stability for Y/M/C/Bk
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
DEVL-VTH Sets threshold value (video count) for starting toner forcible consumption sequence.
2
Whenever possible, avoid using this setting during normal operation.
FTPTXPN Used to specify port (FTP) number to send to.
0 to 65535 (16-bit value) 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 21]
PRNT-ORD Used to switch order of output to side tray.
2
Whenever possible, avoid using this setting during normal operation.
PRN-FLG Used to select area flag for PDL images.
2
Whenever possible, avoid using this setting during normal operation.
SCN-FLG Used to select area flag for copy images.
2
Whenever possible, avoid using this setting during normal operation.
T-LW-LVL Low remaining toner warning message display timing selection
This selects the threshold (%) of the remaining amount of toner at which "Low toner message" is displayed on the control
unit. It is used when selecting the percentage of the toner left at which to display the supply toner warning.
Settings
0: Normal level (5% remaining)
1: 10% remaining 2
2: 15% remaining
3: 20% remaining
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Attention:
Every effort must be made to avoid using this when the machine is operating normally.
NWERR-SW Used to select whether to display network error messages.
Setting values
0: Don't display 2
1: Display
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
17-52
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
STS-PORT ON/OFF of T.O.T (TUIF over TCP/IP) synchronized status communication port
This sets the port used for communicating the Inquiry/Response (synchronized) statuses in T.O.T to ON or OFF.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0] 2
Set this to "1" when using a crossover cable to connect the PC and machine while using service NAVI.
MEMO:
T.O.T (TUIF over TCP)
A communication protocol (unique to Canon) for the presentation of built-in applications (UI) and for communicating
between applications inside the machine such as COPY, SEND and BOX.
CMD-PORT ON/OFF of T.O.T (TUIF over TCP/IP) non-synchronized command communication port
This sets the port used for communicating non-synchronized commands in T.O.T to ON or OFF.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0] 2
Set this to "1" when using a crossover cable to connect the PC and machine while using service NAVI.
MEMO:
T.O.T (TUIF over TCP)
A communication protocol (unique to Canon) for the presentation of built-in applications (UI) and for communicating
between applications inside the machine such as COPY, SEND and BOX.
MODELSZ2 Global support with pressure plate document size detection (both AB and inch detection)
When this item is set to "1," the AB/inch (global) support mode is established regardless of the AB/inch switching flag
MODEL-SZ setting.
Settings
0: Normal (no global detection: size detected by AB or inch depending on destination)
2
1: Both AB and inch series detection (global detection)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Attention:
- This is used to support individual users, and it must not be used under normal circumstances.
- In order to detect both the AB and inch series, document size detection sensors are required separately.
OHP-PTH Setting of sheet count for executing ITB cleaning sequence after OHP film has passed through
This changes the frequency of the cleaning band inserted into the post rotation and between sheets when OHP film has
passed through.
With some types of OHP film, the substances in the film's conductive layer adhere to the ITB (OHT memory), leaving
areas of the images white. For this reason, the ITB cleaning sequence is executed by the default setting between sheets
or in the post-rotation. Reduce the value if white spots caused by the OHT memory data occurs. If no OHT memory 2
data is generated, the down time and toner consumption can be reduced by increasing the value.
Setting range:
- Between sheets: Intervals of 0 to 30 sheets
- Post rotation: Intervals of 0 to 22 sheets
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
UISW-DSP Switch appearing on the User screen
use it to enable/disable the indication of the switch used to switch between Standard Setup screen and Simplified setup
screen (e.g., for self-copy shop)
Setting values
0: disable indication of switch
2
1: enable indication of switch
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
Reference:
a model supporting a coin vendor mechanism may come equipped with functions equivalent to those of a limited function
model /standard model
NS-CMD5 Use it to set CRAM-MD5 authentication under SMTP authentication.
setting
2
0: dependent on SMTP server
1: disable
NS-GSAPI Use it to set GSSAPI authentication under SMTP authentication.
setting
2
0: dependent on SMTP server
1: disable
NS-NTLM Use it to set NTLM authentication under SMTP authentication.
setting
2
0: dependent on SMTP server
1: disable it
NS-PLNWS Use it to set PLAIN LOGIN authentication under SMTP authentication.
<environment in which communication packets are subjected to coding>
setting 2
0: dependent on SMTP server
1: disable
NS-PLN Use it to set PLAIN LOGIN under SMTP authentication.
<environment in which communication packages are not subjected to coding>
setting 2
0: dependent on SMTP server
1: disable
NS-LGN Use it to set LOGIN authentication under SMTP authentication.
setting
2
0: dependent on SMTP server
1: disable
MEAP-PN Setting the port No. of HTTP server used for MEAP application
Settings 0 to 65535
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 8000]
2
Reference:
Do not use 1 to 1023 excepting 80 (HTTP) if specifying the port No. of HTTP server as MEAP port.
(Because standard servers use numbers in this range.)
17-53
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
TMIC-BK Use it to set the correction along the trailing edge for BkLUT and BkLUT for PDL (Tmic).
Settings
0: PDL BK_LUT end correction ON; copy Bk_LUT end correction OFF
1: PDL BK_LUT end correction OFF; copy Bk_LUT end correction OFF 2
2: PDL BK_LUT end correction ON; copy Bk_LUT end correction ON (default)
3: PDL BK_LUT end correction OFF; copy Bk_LUT end correction ON
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 2]
SVMD-ENT Switching the method of entering the Service Mode.
Setting Values
0: [User Mode key] -> Press [2] and [8] simultaneously -> [User Mode key]
2
1: [User Mode key] -> Press [4] and [9] simultaneously -> [User Mode key]
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
Reference Information Support for Siemens
DH-MODE Patch Data (high density side) Used in D-half Except in Full Correction
Change the default setting so that the readout collected from D-half at time of full correction will be substituted for the
patch on the high density side at time of D-half (other than in full correction).
Settings 2
0: use patch image read data of full correction (at time of shipment/upon RAM initialization)
1: do not use patch image read data of full correction
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
SSH-SW SSH server ON/OFF
Settings
0: Sever is not started up
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
1: Server is started up
2
Caution!
The following modes also become ON when COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-CNCT is set to '1'.
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CMD-PORT
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>SSH-SW
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-PORT
RMT-LGIN ON/OFF setting of remote login operation to SSH server
Settings
0: Remote login operation to SSH server is disabled 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: Remote login operation to SSH server is enabled
RE-PKEY ON/OFF setting of SSH server key reproduction
Settings
0: SSH server key is not reproduced.
[Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
1: SSH server key is reproduced.
Caution!
This mode is enabled only when COPIER>OPTION>BODY>SSH-SW is set to '1'.
U-NAME Use it to set a user name required to connect to the SSH server.
Sets a login user name required to connect to the SSH server. Only one user can login the server.
Setting range 2
8 characters maximum (English one byte characters)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: gN3Fp2A]
U-PASWD Use it to set a password of the user required to connect to the SSH server.
Sets a password of the login user required to connect to the SSH server.
Setting range
2
8 characters maximum (English one byte characters)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: Vs8DuwJ]
The password is left hidden on the screen.
DA-PORT Setting port for communication with DA
Settings
0: Close
1: Open
[Factory default/After RAM clear:0]
Caution! 2
The following modes also become ON when COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-CNCT is set to '1'.
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>STS-PORT
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CMD-PORT
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>SSH-SW
COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-PORT
DA-CNCT Setting for connection with DA
Settings
1: DA is used.
0: DA is not used.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Note:
The items listed below are also set to ON when this item COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-CNCT is set to "1."
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>STS-PORT
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>CMD-PORT
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>SSH-SW
2
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-PORT
MEMO:
This is used on machines marketed in Japan only. It is not used on overseas machines.
Fixer replacement message ON/OFF
This sets to ON or OFF the "Get ready to replace the fixer" message that appears on the user operation screen after the
fixed counter has reached the count which represents the end of the fixer's service life.
Settings
0: The message is not displayed.
1: The message is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
17-54
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
FXMSG-SW Fixing unit replacement message ON/OFF
This sets to ON or OFF the "Get ready to replace the fixing unit" message that appears on the user operation screen after
the fixing unit counter has reached the count which represents the end of the fixing unit's service life.
Settings 2
0: The message is not displayed.
1: The message is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
CHNG-STS Setting of T.O.T (TUIF over TCP/IP) status connection port number
This sets the number of the port used for the status connection in T.O.T. It is used when changing the port number with
service NAVI.
Setting range: 1 to 65535
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 20010] 2
MEMO:
T.O.T (TUIF over TCP)
A communication protocol (unique to Canon) for the presentation of built-in applications (UI) and for communicating
between applications inside the machine such as COPY, SEND and BOX.
CHNG-CMD Setting of T.O.T (TUIF over TCP/IP) command connection port number
This sets the number of the port used for the command connection in T.O.T. It is used when changing the port number
with service NAVI.
Setting range: 1 to 65535
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 20000] 2
MEMO:
T.O.T (TUIF over TCP)
A communication protocol (unique to Canon) for the presentation of built-in applications (UI) and for communicating
between applications inside the machine such as COPY, SEND and BOX.
MEAP-DSP Prohibition against switching from MEAP screen to standard screen (copy, send or box screen, etc.)
Settings
0: Transfer to standard screen enabled.
1: Transfer to standard screen disabled.
2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
MEMO:
Even when this item is set to "1," the display is transferred to the standard screen when an error, jam or alarm has
occurred.
ANIM-SW Prohibition against switching error or jam screen display during operation of MEAP application
Even when COPIER>OPTION>BODY>MEAP-DSP has been set to "1," the display is transferred to the standard screen
in order to display a warning when an error, jam or alarm has occurred.
When this item has been set to "1," the transfer of the screen to the standard screen when an error, jam or alarm has
occurred is prohibited, and a warning urging the user to contact a service technician appears on the MEAP screen. 2
Settings
0: The warning screen is displayed.
1: The warning screen is not displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
HDD-TMP Use it to set a level of temperature to serve as a reference for detecting a low temperature error.
Caution!
The new setting will not be valid until the power switch has been turned off and then on again. 2
Settings: 0 to 30 deg C
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 2]
HDD-TIM Use it to set the time interval allowed before a low temperature error is identified
Caution!
The new setting will not be valid until the power switch has been turned off and then on again. 2
Settings: 0 to 200 min
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 10]
HDD-SW Use it to enable/disable E code indication of a low temperature error
Caution!
The new setting will not be valid until the power switch has been turned off and then on again
Settings 2
0: do not indicate
1: indicate
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
MEAP-SSL Use it to set an HTTPS port for MEAP.
Sets a port for the HTTPS server to use SSL in the MEAP HTTP.
2
Setting range: 1 to 65535
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 8443]
DH-TMG Setting up a threshold for the accumulated number of outputs for the Dhalf control sequence operation trigger.
Control
If the fixing unit is lower than a specified temperature when the machine is turned on or recovered from the sleep mode,
use this mode to make automatic full adjustments during initial multiple rotations.
At this time, the Dhalf control is performed only if the number of outputs accumulated since the last Dhalf control
exceeds the value specified in this Service Mode.
2
Changing the timing of or canceling the Dhalf control (according to the number of accumulated outputs) by using this
mode can reduce the downtime in the morning. (A measure for a complaint about the downtime in the morning)
Meanwhile, there is a possibility that gray scale (half-tone image) might be degraded when the Dhalf control is cancelled.
With regard to the accumulated number of outputs, a small-size copy is regarded as 1 count, and a large-size copy is
regarded as 2 counts.
When the Dhalf control is performed first thi
MIX-FLG Use it to select an image field flag (for image synthesis).
Selects the image processing method which is performed when a combined image cannot be compressed at a certain
compression ratio on the main controller side.
Setting value
0: Image processing equivalent to the PDL character mode 2
1: Image processing equivalent to the PDL photo mode
2: Image processing equivalent to the SCAN character mode
3: Image processing equivalent to the SCAN photo mode
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
17-55
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
KSIZE-SW Paper size (K size) switch for China
This switch allows iR series scanner controllers to support K size paper detection and display.
When the switch is set to ON = 1 for MODEL-SZ = (AB type) destinations, the operation switches to allow K size paper
recognition and detection to be performed with document detection, paper selection screen and APS type, etc. The
following types of K size paper are available.
- 8K: 270mm x 390 mm 2
- 16K: 270mm x 195 mm
Setting values
0: OFF (K size paper not handled)
1: ON (K size paper handled)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
LPD-PORT LPD port number setting
Reference:
LPD port: Port number of the network for TCP/IP communication when initiating network printing. 2
Setting range: 1 to 65535
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 515]
ORG-A4R Setting of special sheet sizes which cannot be recognized when ADF is used
This enables images to be formed properly by setting from the service mode the special sheet sizes which cannot be
recognized when documents are fed from ADF.
When ADF has detected A4-R in a machine for an inch/AB series market, A4-R is converted into a document size which
has been set in the service mode, and the images are formed using the post-conversion document size. 2
Settings
0: The document size is converted into A4-R.
1: The document size is converted into FOLIO-R.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
PDF-RDCT Switches to reduction transmission for reception transfer (PDF transmission).
Images received in FAX, IFAX modes are converted to PDF and then reduced for transmission as email or for file
transmission.
Setting values 2
0: Image not converted to PDF and reduced for reception transfer.
1: Image converted to PDF and reduced for reception transfer.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
REDU-CNT Density adjustment method switching control
This controls whether to perform the kind of density adjustment in which restrictions on the amount of toner are factored.
Settings
2
0: The kind of density adjustment is not performed.
1: The kind of density adjustment is performed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
REBOOTSW Restart switch when the E240 error occurs
Normally, when the E240 error (an error in communication between the main controller and DC controller) occurs, the
drive system may continue operating so the specifications calls for an automatic restart. However, restart causes the
spooled print jobs to be cleared (and this could lead to complaints from our users). This item, therefore, makes it possible
to set whether automatic restart is to be initiated when the E240 error occurs.
Settings
2
0: Operation is restarted automatically when the E240 error occurs.
1: Operation is not restarted automatically when the E240 error occurs.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Attention:
- This must not be used under normal circumstances.
- When users wish to use this item, they must be given a thorough explanation.
VP-ART Mode to enable the line art processing to be changed
This changes the outlining process of the line art in scalable PDF files.
2
Setting range: 0 to 99
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
VP-TXT Mode to enable the vector-generating process for characters to be changed
This changes the vector-generating process for characters in scalable PDF files.
2
Setting range: 0 to 99
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
UI-PRINT Control area printing job screen display restriction
Switch for selecting whether to display the printing job screen in the control area.
This specification is for users who are customizing the control area so that they have the option of not displaying the
screen.
2
Settings
0: The printing job screen is not displayed.
1: The printing job screen is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
WUEV-SW Sleep notification selector switch
This sets whether to post the sleep notification to the DS application on the network when the copier unit has been
transferred or reset to the sleep mode.
Settings 2
0: Sleep notification is posted.
1: Sleep notification is not posted.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
WUEV-INT Sleep notification interval setting
This sets the sleep notification interval when sleep notification is to be posted.
2
Setting range: 60 to 65536 (in 1-second increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 600]
WUEV-POT Sleep notification destination port number setting
This sets the PC port number of the sleep notification destination when sleep notification is to be posted.
2
Setting range: 1 to 65535
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 11427]
WUEV-RTR Sleep notification range setting
This sets the number of routers through which the sleep notification can pass until its destination when sleep notification
is to be posted. 2
Setting range: 0 to 254
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 3]
17-56
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
SJB-UNW Selector switch for number of secure print jobs on hold (number of reserved jobs)
This selects 50 or 90 as the upper limit for the number of secure print jobs on hold (number of reserved jobs).
Setting
2
0: 50
1: 90
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
UI-RSCAN Control unit remote scan screen display restriction
This switch is used to select whether to display the remote scan screen on the control unit.
This specification is for users who are customizing the control area so that they have the option of not displaying the
screen.
2
Settings
0: The remote scan screen is not displayed.
1: The remote scan screen is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
UI-EPRNT Control unit expansion print screen display restriction
This switch is used to select whether to display the expansion print screen (EFI print screen) on the control unit.
This specification is for users who are customizing the control area so that they have the option of not displaying the
screen.
Additional note
The conventional UI-EXT has been separated into UI-RSCAN and UI-EPRNT to enable them to be controlled 2
independently.
Settings
0: The expansion print screen is not displayed.
1: The expansion print screen is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
UI-WEB Control unit web browser screen display restriction
This switch is used to select whether to display the web browser screen on the control unit.
This specification is for users who are customizing the control area so that they have the option of not displaying the
screen.
2
Settings
0: The web browser screen is not displayed.
1: The web browser screen is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
WEBV-SW Switch to prohibit use of WEBDAV function
By setting this switch to 1 (ON), the WEBDAV function can no longer be used. (The WEBDAV-related displays in the
following are cleared.)
- User mode -> destination table specification settings -> registration of destination -> file -> "WEBDAV" in protocol
- User mode -> "Use chunk division transmission during WEBDAV transmission" among the transmission specification
settings
Reference 2
WEBDAV is a standard function of the copier, but it is sometimes not used in order to reduce the amount of MEMOry
used.
Settings
0: The WEBDAV function is used.
1: The WEBDAV function is not used.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
CARD-RNG Setting of number of usable card divisions (number of cards)
This sets the number of divisions (number of cards) for the cards which can be used when the card reader is utilized.
2
Setting range: 1 to 1000
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1000]
WUEN-LIV Start time setting after sleep notification from network
This sets the time in 1-second increments (from 10 seconds to 10 minutes) which is to elapse until the sleep mode is next
established when sleep start has been initiated from the network for the copier with no accompanying introduction of
2
jobs.
Setting range: 10 to 600 (in 1-second increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 15]
COMP-PRT Composite print operation control (image processing memory allocation control)
When a count of 2 or more prints are to be made in page print/ set print/ stamp/ date print/ book binding/ watermark print
(composite print), depending on the memory model (optional configuration) and document size, the memory allocation
method is set to 'print priority' for image processing purposes. This means there is not enough memory for image
processing for Scan, Send Tx (excluding FAX) and PDL entry, and these operations must wait until printing is finished.
In this case, all memory is allocated equally to all jobs so that the operations can be carried out (each a little at a time) 2
without waiting until printing is finished.
Setting values
0: Print priority
1: Equal allocation
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
AST-SEL Change advanced smoothing range
Used when adjustments to advanced smoothing effect are felt necessary.
If the smoothing effect is felt to be too strong, even though 'Soft' is selected in the advanced smoothing UI, set this item
to '0'. If the smoothing effect is felt to be too weak, even though 'Strong' is selected in the advanced smoothing UI, set 2
this item to '3'.
Setting range: 0 to 3
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 2]
REGM-SEL Change fine line density correction range
Used when adjustments to fine line density for lines and characters in 1200 dpi printing are felt necessary.
If lines and characters are felt to be too faint, even though '+2' is set in the fine line density UI, increase the plus setting
of this item. If lines and characters are felt to be too dark, even though '-2' is set in the fine line density UI, increase the 2
minus setting of this item.
Setting range: 0 to 4
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 2]
17-57
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
ORG-LTRR Setting of special sheet sizes which cannot be recognized when ADF is used
This enables images to be formed properly by setting from the service mode the special sheet sizes which cannot be
recognized when documents are fed from ADF.
When ADF has detected LTR-R in a machine for an inch/AB series market, LTR-R is converted into a document size
which has been set in the service mode, and the images are formed using the post-conversion document size.
Settings 2
0: The document size is converted into LTR-R.
1: The document size is converted into G-LTR-R.
2: The document size is converted into A-LTR-R.
3: The document size is converted into EXECUTIVE-R.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ORG-LDR Setting of special sheet sizes which cannot be recognized when ADF is used (when the size is mistakenly recognized as
LDR)
This enables images to be formed properly by setting from the service mode the special sheet sizes which cannot be
recognized when documents are fed from ADF.
When ADF has detected LDR in a machine for an inch/AB series market, LDR is converted into a document size which
2
has been set in the service mode, and the images are formed using the post-conversion document size.
Settings
0: The document size is converted into LDR.
1: The document size is converted into A-LTR.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
P-INTVL ATR batch interval setting
This is used when the E020 error occurs frequently. The trackability can be improved by increasing the ATR frequency.
ATR execution timing at "0" setting: Once every 25 sheets when sheets of A4 size paper are printed with a density of
less than 25% 2
Setting range
-2 to 2 (in 25% increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
FXWRNLVL Fixing film unit warning level change mode
This changes the warning level of the fixing film unit service life. This is used to select whether the fixing film unit
service life is to be displayed.
Settings
0: Warning is not displayed. 2
1: Warning is displayed when the default counter value is reached.
2: Warning is displayed when a counter value lower than the default counter value is reached.
3: Warning is displayed when a counter value higher than the default counter value is reached.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
DRM-RTIM Drum streak prevention sequence start offset time setting
This changes the frequency with which the drum is to be rotated for 300ms when the standby and sleep modes are
established in order to prevent drum streaks from once every 15 minutes.
Settings 2
0 to 12 (in 5-minute increments)
0: The drum streak sequence is not implemented.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 3]
ORG-B4 Setting of special sheet sizes which cannot be recognized when ADF is used
This enables images to be formed properly by setting from the service mode the special sheet sizes which cannot be
recognized when documents are fed from ADF.
When ADF has detected B4 in a machine for an inch/AB series market, B4 is converted into a document size which has
been set in the service mode, and the images are formed using the post-conversion document size. 2
Settings
0: The document size is converted into B4.
1: The document size is converted into FOLIO-R.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
SHT-DCSW Skipping DCON completion processing when shutdown is executed
This skips the DCON completion processing when shutdown (hard disk protection mode) is executed. The time taken
for shutdown to be completed is reduced by setting this to "1" for those users who complain that shutdown takes too long
to complete.
[11-139] It takes about 60 minutes to control the DCON fan when shutdown is executed. Since there is no function to
turn the power OFF automatically when shutdown is completed, users must monitor the copier until shutdown is 2
completed. By enabling this item, shutdown is completed without waiting for the DCON fan control to be completed.
Settings
0: The completion of DCON fan control is awaited, and then shutdown is completed.
1: Shutdown is completed without waiting for the completion of DCON fan control.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
DHCP-12 DHCP-Option 12 request ON/OFF selector switch
This uses DHCP option 55 to enable host name (option 12) inquiries when the DHCP-12 switch is set to ON. It is used
to prevent option 12 and option 81 from being included in DHCP packets in conditions where the packets passing over
the network are being monitored. (Supported through separate business negotiations, etc.)
* DHCP = Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol 2
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
DHCP-81 DHCP-option 81 request ON/OFF selector switch
When the DHCP-81 switch is set to ON and the user mode dynamic DNS setting is ON, this enables dynamic changes
in the IP address using DHCP option 81. It is used to prevent option 12 and option 81 from being included in DHCP
packets in conditions where the packets passing over the network are being monitored. (Supported through separate
business negotiations, etc.) 2
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
PT-W-SET Change of pre-rotation band image width when color OHT paper passes through
This increases the band amount when rattling noises are heard from the ITB cleaner blade when color OHT paper passes
through in order to minimize these noises. 2
Setting range: 0 to 10 (in 10 mm increments)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 5]
17-58
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>BODY
FLYING Setting whether to initiate a flying start
This is set to "1" when a flying start is not to be initiated in consideration of the service life of the fixing unit. Normally,
after a job is completed, operation is controlled so that the fixing is performed and the takes of the polygons are made
longer in preparation for the next job, but this control is not performed when the item is set to "1."
2
Settings
0: A flying start is initiated.
1: A flying start is not initiated.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
PP-LWRT Not used 2
USB-RCNT Setting for automatic connection when USB device is disconnected
This sets whether automatic re-connection is to be initiated when the USB device is disconnected (USB reconnect).
Settings
2
0: No automatic connection
1: Automatic connection is initiated.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
2. USER
T-17-55
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
COPY-LIM Used to change upper limit value setting for number of sheets to copy.
Setting values 1
1 to 999 sheets [Factory default/After RAM clear: 999]
SLEEP Used to turn sleep function ON/OFF.
Setting values
0: OFF
1
1: ON [Factory default/After RAM clear]
Reference:
The sleep function is set by the timer setting in the "User mode"
COUNTER 1 Counter status verification screen soft counter 1 setting
This makes it possible to change the type display of soft counter 1 on the control unit to suit the demand from users and
dealers.
Setting 1
101: Total 1
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: Fixed at 1 -> Cannot be changed]
17-59
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
TAB-ROT Rotates landscape images on PDL tab paper 180 degrees.
Setting values
1
0: Don't rotate [Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: Rotate
PR-PSESW Print pause function switch display selection
Sets whether to display the print pause switch on the user screen.
Setting values
1
0: No display
1: Display
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
IDPRN-SW Used to switch type of count-up job for department management counter.
Setting values
0: BoxPrint, ReportPrint, SendLocalPrint and PDLPrint are counted as PRINT categories [Factory default/After RAM 1
clear]
1: Only PDLPrint is counted as a PRINT category
CPRT-DSP Used to select whether to display count print button in sales counter check screen.
Setting values
0: Don't display (This setting is only for stores that request it.) 1
1: Display (Count print function can be used.)
[Factory default/After RAM clear]
CNT-SW Used it to select charge counters and default display items (100-V model only)
Settings
0:counter 1-101 total 1
counter2-total(black-and-white1):108.
counter3-copy(full color + mono color/1):232.
counter4-print(full color + mono color/1):324
1:counter1-total2:102.
counter2-copy(full color + mono color/2):231.
counter3-totalA(full color + mono color/2):148.
counter4-copy(black-and-white2):222.
counter5-totalA(black-and-white2):133
2:(setting0 and mono color Version)
counter1-total1:101.
1
counter2-total(black-and-white1):108.
counter3-copy(full color + mono color/1):232.
counter4-print(full color + mono color/1):324.
counter5-total( mono color/1):118
3:counter1-total1:101.
counter2-total(full color + mono color/small):123.
counter3-total(full color + mono color/large):122.
counter4-total(black-and-white/small):113.
counter5-total(black-and-white/large):112.
counter6-scan(total1):501
4:(setting3 and mono color Version)
counter1-total1:101.
counter2-total(full color + mono co
BCNT-AST Used to select a job type with which to count BOX print from ASSIST.
Setting values
1
0: Count as PDL print [Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: Count as Copy print
DFLT-CPY Sets default COPY colour mode.
Setting values
0: AUTO/ACS/Driver setting
1: Full colour
2: Black and white 1
JPN [Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
USA [Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
EUR [Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
Other than the above: [Factory settings and after RAM clear:0]
DFLT-BOX Sets BOX default mode
Setting range
0: AUTO/ACS/Driver settings
1: Full colour
2: Black and white 1
JPN [Factory settings and after RAM clear:: 0]
USA [Factory settings and after RAM clear:: 0]
EUR [Factory settings and after RAM clear:: 0 ]
Other than the above: [Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
DOC-REM Sets document removal message.
Setting range
0: No display 1
1: Display
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
COUNTER7 Selects type of counter to be displayed in user mode counter 7.
Enter values to make setting. The setting will be for the seventh counter displayed in the user mode counter confirmation. 1
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0 (No setting)]
COUNTER8 Selects type of counter to be displayed in user mode counter 8.
Enter values to make setting. The setting will be for the eighth counter displayed in the user mode counter confirmation. 1
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0 (No setting)]
17-60
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
LDAP-SW Sets LDAP search conditions.
Sets conditions to be matched when searching from email addresses and fax numbers from the LDAP server.
Setting values
0: 'includes'
1: 'does not include'
1
2: 'is equal to'
3: 'is not equal to'
4: 'begins with'
5: 'ends with'
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 4]
FROM-OF Sets whether to delete 'from' address when sending mail.
Setting values
0: Do not delete 'from' address. 1
1: Delete 'from'.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
SPEAKER Sets text-to-speech (user mode) 'Speaker/ Headphones' button display.
Setting values
0: Do not display 'Speaker/ Headphones' button. 1
1: Display 'Speaker/ Headphones' button.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear:: 0]
FILE-OF Sets file address transmission prohibition.
This setting prohibits transmission to a file address by prohibiting file address entry into the address book.
Setting values
1
0: Do not prohibit transmission to file address.
1: Prohibit transmission to file address.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
MAIL-OF Sets email address transmission prohibition.
This setting prohibits transmission to an email address by prohibiting email address entry into the address book.
Setting values
1
0: Do not prohibit transmission to email address.
1: Prohibit transmission to email address.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
IFAX-OF Sets IFAX address transmission prohibition.
This setting prohibits transmission to an IFAX address by prohibiting IFAX address entry into the address book.
Setting values
1
0: Do not prohibit transmission to IFAX address.
1: Prohibit transmission to IFAX address.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
LDAP-DEF Switches LDAP search condition defaults.
Sets default search attributes when LDAP detailed search is selected.
Setting values
0: 'Name'
1: 'Email'
2: 'Fax' 1
3: 'Organisation'
4: 'Unit'
5: User setting 1
6: User setting 2
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ACS-DSP ACS ON/OFF screen display switching
This selects whether to display the switches to be used for selecting or not selecting automatic color with initial settings/
registration. When a CL series machine is installed, the service technician ensures that the screen, on which to select
whether to use ACS, is displayed in initial settings/registration if this is requested by the user.
Reference:
Initial settings/registration has been created to meet user demand to prevent fees from being charged for color because
2
ACS is set when the charging system is installed even in cases where such fees do not apply. This item also selects
whether the above screen is to be displayed.
Settings
0: Not displayed.
1: Displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
SIZE-DET Sets document size detection function ON/ OFF.
When the pressure plate opens and closes, there is no light flashing, so extraneous light can be cut out.
Setting values
0: OFF 2
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 1]
2
DATE-DSP Used to switch date display.
0: 'YYMM/DD
2
1: DD/MM'YY
2: MM/DD/YY
MB-CCV Used to select whether to restrict mailbox control card users.
0: Don't restrict 2
1: Restrict
TRY-STP Used to set mode in which output stops when tray is full.
0: Normal mode (Interrupted when finisher tray is full.) 2
1: Interrupted only by height detection
MF-LG-ST Sets long length mode key.
Setting values
0: Normal setting 2
1: Display long length key in mode screen.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
17-61
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
CNT-DISP Used to select whether to display serial number when counter check key is pressed.
0: Display serial number. 2
1: Don't display serial number.
NW-SCAN Used to select whether to permit network scan function
0: Don't permit 2
1: Permit (Invalid when UFR board or open interface board isn't connected.)
HDCR-DSP Selection of clear method in hard disk all data erasure mode
This selects the method clearing the data in the hard disk all data erasure mode.
Settings
1: Cleared once using 0 (null) data.
2: Cleared once using random data.
3: Cleared 3 times using random data.
2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
MEMO:
Hard disk all data erasure function
This function overwrites the 0 (null) data and random data in the file data area on the hard disk at the logical timing of
erasing the files (the timing at which the control information data is erased), and it thereby erases all the data on the hard
disk.
JOB-INVL Used to set job interval during interrupt.
0: Standard setting (Output next job continuously during interrupt copy job.)
2
1: Start output of next job after last sheet of interrupt copy job has been delivered.
2: Start output of next job after last sheet of any job has been delivered.
P-CRG-LF Used to select operation performed when drum unit has reached end of service life.
0: Don't stop 2
1: Stop
PCL-COPY PCL COPIES command binder control mode
The PCL COPIES command control method differs between the PCLs made in-house and the PCLs made by sources
outside the company, and it is for the purpose of standardizing the operations of both kinds of PCLs that this mode has
been provided.
Settings
0: Control is exercised on a page by page basis as per the COPIES command value specified on the page concerned.
1: The COPIES command value specified on page 1 is treated as the binding number, and the COPIES command values 2
on the next and subsequent pages are canceled. (This is set only when the sort mode is established. In a non-sorting
mode, the same control is exercised as when "0" is set.)
2 to 65535: Spare
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
"0" is the control method applicable to in-house PCLs, and by setting the item to "1", the same control method as used
with PCLs made by sources outside the company is exercised.
PRJOB-CP Setting for selecting whether to output the count pulses during reception printing and report printing
This selects whether to output the count pulse notice for each page during reception printing and report printing to the
charge management system when a charge management system (coin vendor or control card made by another company)
is used.
2
Settings
0: The count pulses are not output.
1: The count pulses are output.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
DPT-ID-7 Registering a department ID and inputting a 7-digit code for authentication.
Setting Values
0: As before [Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
1: Inputting a 7-digit code
Reference Infomation Support for Siemens
RUI-RJT Disconnecting the HTTP port when three authentication failures from RUI are recognized.
Setting Values
0: Invalid [Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
1: Valid
Reference Information Support for Siemens
SND-RATE Sets compression rate when compression rate in SEND is selected 'High'.
Setting values
0: Compression rate 1/16
2
1: Compression rate 1/20
2: Compression rate 1/24
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
CTM-S06 Setting for deleting password from export file of file transmission address
Settings
0: The password is not deleted.
1: The password is deleted. 2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
When this item is set to "1," the password of the file transmission destination is deleted from the export file when the
address book data has been exported from the remote UI. (This is to prevent information leaks.)
FREG-SW Selection of whether to display the free register area of the MEAP counter (for SEND)
Settings
0: The free register area is not displayed.
1: The free register area is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0] 2
Memo:
- This is not used with normal servicing. (It is used for analyzing trouble causes).
- To use it, the instructions given by the quality support division must be followed.
17-62
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
IFAX-SZL Selection of whether to restrict the transmission data size during IFAX transmission
This selects whether to restrict the transmission data size during IFAX transmission (but only when the transmissions do
not go through the server).
Settings
0: The transmission data size is restricted (whether or not the transmissions go through the server).
1: The transmission data size is not restricted (only when the transmissions do not go through the server). 2
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 1]
Memo: When the item has been set to "0"
- The upper limit is set by user mode > system control settings > communication control settings > email/I-FAX settings
> upper limit of transmission data size.
- The #830 error results when an attempt is made to send data whose size exceeds the upper limit.
IFAX-PGD Permitting the divided transmission per page (only when the upper limit of the transmission data size is exceeded).
Settings
0: Not permit the divided transmission per page upon transmission in the IFAX Simple mode.
[Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
1: Permits the divided transmission per page upon transmission in the IFAX Simple mode.
When setting '1', in the case of exporting the address book data from remote UI, the password of file server is hidden
from the exported file (to avoid leakage of information).
MEAPSAFE Switching to MEAP safe mode
Settings
0: Normal mode
1: Safe mode
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
2
The safe mode refers to the mode in which the system is started up safely by stopping the added MEAP applications and
starting only the system application which is to be started in the initial status. Set the item to "1" to start the system in
the safe mode when system recovery is to be initiated in cases where the MEAP platform does not start up normally due
to contention for resources between MEAP applications or to service registration/utilization sequence, for example.
When the safe mode is established, "MPS" is displayed on the control unit screen.
TRAY-FLL Setting the timing to issue an output-tray-full warning.
Settings
0: Issues an output-tray-full warning when all the delivery trays become full. 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: Issues an output-tray-full warning when all the specified trays become full.
PRNT-POS Switch for selecting whether to temporarily stop the printing of all subsequent jobs when a job is canceled because an
error has occurred
This temporarily stops the PDL printing of all the jobs when job cancel (such as #037) has occurred due to an error inside
the equipment at any time other than a service call.
2
Settings
0: The printing of all jobs is not temporarily stopped.
1: The printing of all jobs is temporarily stopped.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
AFN-PSWD Limiting access to the User Mode.
Settings
0: Normal mode (Enters the User Mode without asking a password) 2
[Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: Enters the User Mode after a password matches.
PTJAM-RC PDL jam recovery switch
Sets whether to perform recovery print when there is a jam in a PDL job.
Setting values
2
0: OFF (No recovery)
1: ON (Recovery)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 1]
SLP-SLCT Switch for selecting use of network-based application
The machine must receive a specific packet in order for it to recover from sleep mode 3 via the network. The existing
network-based application (NetSpot Accountant or imageWARE) that supports BW2/CL1 does not send this packet so
if the machine has been transferred to sleep mode 3 (2w sleep), it cannot recover via the network. When this item is set
to "1," the machine is not transferred to sleep mode 3 (2w sleep), and recovery from the sleep mode via the network is
enabled, but there is a tradeoff in that the power consumption is increased.
Settings 2
0: The network-based application is not used (the machine is set to the 2w sleep mode).
1: The network-based application is used (the machine is not set to the 2w sleep mode).
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Memo This is not used with normal servicing.
PS-MODE Selection of compatible mode when PS is used (image processing, print specifications)
This selects the machine control when backward compatibility is required by PS. It is a mode which maintains
compatibility in the image processing and print specifications in the face of possible replacement.
Settings 2
0: The PS-compatible mode is not used.
1: Backward compatibility with PS Type3 Halftone command (dithering increase sequence reversed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-63
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
CNCT-RLZ Connection serializing function ON/OFF
This selects whether to use the connection serializing function.
Settings
0: Connection serializing function OFF
1: Connection serializing function ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Reference:
- Connection serializing function
This function serves to guarantee the job grouping function of imageWARE Output Manager Select Edition V1.0. Since 2
iR machines and other MFP machines support multiple connections, the job grouping function is guaranteed by
establishing in the machine a setting which will not accept multiple connections. When this item is set to "1," until the
reception of the job data of a particular connection is completed, the job data of another connection will not be received,
thereby preventing the rearranging of jobs.
- Connection
This refers to a connection which is established through the network between a multiple number of hosts (such as PCs).
- Job grouping function
This is a function of imageWARE Output Manager Select Edition V1.0. It
2C-CT-SW Colour counter (restricted to two colour mode) switch
In 2 colour mode, switches the incremental counter between full colour and mono-colour.
Setting values
2
0: Mono-colour counter
1: Full colour counter
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 1]
JA-FUNC Job archive function ON/OFF
0: OFF
2
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
JA-JOB Specification of jobs targeted for job archive
0: None
3: Limited to FAX/IFAX 2
0xFFFFFFFF: All jobs
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
JA-RESTR Job archive restriction item setting
Bit 0: Image file capture function (0: OFF, 1: ON)
Bit 1: Form registration combination function (0: OFF, 1: ON) 2
Bit 2: Document editing function (0: OFF, 1: ON)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
DOM-ADD Sets domain complement for transmission destination when sending email.
Sets whether to complement the domain (e.g. @canon.co.jp) programmed in the user mode to the entered account when
transmitting email.
Setting values 2
0: Do not complement Tx destination domain.
1: Complement Tx destination domain.
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
JA-DPI Specifies job archive record resolution.
For jobs other than PC-FAX, FAX Rx, IFAX Rx, etc., the resolution is converted to the programmed resolution and an
archive image is recorded.
*The settings cannot be changed in service mode, but only referenced. Settings can only be made from a job archive-
enabled MEAP programme.
Setting values 2
0 : No not convert resolution.
1: 100 x 100 dpi
2: 200 x 200 dpi
3: 300 x 300 dpi
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 3]
JA-COMPR Specifies job archive record compression rate.
For jobs other than PC-FAX, FAX Rx, IFAX Rx, etc., the compression rate is converted to the programmed compression
rate and an archive image is recorded.
Setting values
0: Do not convert compression rate (use same compression table as original image).
1: 1/4 compression 2
2: 1/8 compression
3: 1/16 compression
4: 1/32 compression
5: 1/64 compression
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 3]
PDL-NCSW Print job card control mode setting
This targets the PDL print jobs to be controlled using NewCard.
Settings
0: PDL print jobs are accepted and output by the machine regardless of whether NewCard has been inserted. 2
1: PDL jobs are not printed if NewCard is not inserted and the division ID does not match. PDL jobs are printed if
NewCard is inserted and the division ID of the jobs matches the card ID.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-64
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>USER
Specification selection related to user mode
Sub item Description level.
FREE-DSP Charge cancel screen display switching
If the unit is operated using a charging system, a mode (store manager mode) is provided for releasing the charging status
temporarily and enabling all the services to be used free of charge.
This mode can be switched under a hardware switch of the vendor. However, since some vendors do not have a hardware
switch, this service mode makes it possible to display a switching screen at initial settings/registration.
Reference:
The service technician uses this item to display the charged/not charged mode switching screen in the user mode if a 2
vendor without a hardware switch for selecting the charged/not charged mode has been connected when the charging
system is installed.
Settings
0: Screen is not displayed.
1: Screen is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
CLR-TM All processing data erase timing
This selects the timing at which all the data is to be erased in the security kit. When erasing all the data, the job processing
performance may deteriorate depending on the data erased. The reason for this is as follows: since the already processed
page data is erased in parallel while jobs are being processed, an extra burden is placed on the CPU and hard disk access
process. The job processing capability can be improved by delaying this process until after the job has been completed.
Settings 2
0: The data is erased while the job is being processed.
1: The data is erased after the job has been completed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
T-17-56
17-65
Chapter 17
17-66
Chapter 17
17-67
Chapter 17
17-68
Chapter 17
17-69
Chapter 17
17-70
Chapter 17
3. CST
T-17-57
COPIER>OPTION>CST
Sub item Description level.
ENV1 Envelope cassette ENV1 registration
This specifies the size of the envelope cassette.
Settings
21: ISO-C5
22: COM10
23: MONARCH
24: DL
25: ISO-B5
26: Western standard No.4
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 21]
ENV2 Envelope cassette ENV2 registration
This specifies the size of the envelope cassette.
Settings
21: ISO-C5
22: COM10
23: MONARCH
24: DL
25: ISO-B5
26: Western standard No.4
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 21]
U1-NAME Used to turn paper name display when U1 paper size group is detected ON/OFF.
0: Display "U1" on touch panel (default). 2
1: Display paper name set by "CST-U1" service mode item.
U2-NAME Used to turn paper name display when U2 paper size group is detected ON/OFF.
0: Display "U2" on touch panel (default). 2
1: Display paper name set by "CST-U2" service mode item.
CST-U1/U2 Used to specify paper name used by U1/U2 paper size group.
24: FOOLSCAP
25: Australian FOOLSCAP
26: OFFICIO
27: Ecuador OFFICIO
28: Bolivia OFFICIO
29: Argentine LETTER
30: Argentine LETTER-R
31: Government LETTER
32: Government LETTER-R
34: Government LEGAL
35: FOLIO
36: Argentine OFFICIO
37: Mexico OFFICIO
38: EXECTIVE
[CST-U1 Factory default/After RAM clear: 31]
[CST-U2 Factory default/After RAM clear: 24]
U3-NAME ON/OFF of paper name display when paper size group (U3) has been detected
This selects whether to display the paper name of the U3 size cassette on the LCD control unit.
Settings
0: "U3" is displayed on the touch panel (default setting).
1: The name of the paper set by service mode "CST-U3" is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
U4-NAME ON/OFF of paper name display when paper size group (U4) has been detected
This selects whether to display the paper name of the U4 size cassette on the LCD control unit.
Settings
0: "U4" is displayed on the touch panel (default setting).
1: The name of the paper set by service mode "CST-U4" is displayed.
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
CST-U3/U4 Specification of paper name used by paper size group
By setting the following special sheet sizes in U1 and U2, the U1 and U2 sheet sizes can be handled as special sheet sizes
by the universal cassettes.
Settings
24: Foolscap
25: Australian foolscap
26: Officio
27: Ecuador officio
28: Bolivia officio
29: Argentina letter
2
30: Argentina letter-R
31: Government letter
32: Government letter-R
34: Government legal
35: Folio
36: Argentina officio
37: Mexico officio
38: Executive
[U3 factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 34]
[U4 factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 29]
17-71
Chapter 17
4. ACC
T-17-58
COPIER>OPTION>ACC
Sub item Description level.
COIN Coin vendor switching
This selects whether to establish the coin vendor control mode.
Settings
0: Coin vendor not used (control cards can be used; not charged)
1: Coin vendor (charged)
2: Remote area counter (charged)
3: Charged by DA
4: Charged by iR
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
Note:
When the setting has been changed to "3" (DA charges), the values of the following items will also be changed.
[Service mode]
- COPIER>OPTION>USER>CONTROL:1
- COPIER>OPTION>USER>AFN-PSWD:1 1
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>UI-BOX:0
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>UI-SEND:0
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>UI-FAX:0
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>UI-EXT:0
- COPIER>OPTION>BODY>DA-CNCT:1
[User mode > system control settings]
- Expansion unit settings > expansion unit function priority: ON
- Network settings > email > I fax > SMTP reception: OFF
- Network settings > email > I fax > POP3 reception: OFF
- Network settings > SMB settings > use of SMB printing: 0
- Network settings > TCP/IP settings > use of IPP printing: 0
- Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP address range setting > printing enable address ON/OFF: ON
Network settings > TCP/IP settings > use of FTP printing: OFF
DK-P Used to set paper size used by paper deck (option).
Setting values
0: A4 [Factory default/After RAM clear] 1
1: B5
2: LTR
CARD-SW Used to select UI screen when coin vendor is supported.
Setting values
0: Coin [Factory default/After RAM clear] 1
1: Card
2: Coin + card
USB-MSK Limiting the number of USB-HOST channels on the models with the USB-HOST installed.
Setting values 0 to 2
The relevant channels of the USB-HOST are masked (deactivated).
(e.g.)
1
When there are two channels of CH0 and CH1,
0: Not mask any channel.
1: Masks CH1.
2: Reserved
OUT-TRAY No.3 delivery tray availability
This is mainly used when the No.2 or No.3 delivery unit is installed. It is set to "1" when the No.3 delivery unit is
installed.
Settings 1
0: Not available
1: Available
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
IN-TRAY Inner delivery tray availability
This sets the availability of the No.2 delivery tray. It is set to "1" when the No.2 delivery tray is available.
Settings
1
0: Not available
1: Available
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
MIN-PRC Coin manager minimum value setting
This determines the minimum value handled by the coin manager which is connected. For instance, the service
technician inputs "10" if the minimum value supported by the Japanese yen coin manager is 10 yen.
This item takes effect only when 4 is set for ACC>COIN.
Additional note 1
When a number from 1 to 4 (Euros, pounds, Swiss francs, dollars) is set for COPIER>OPTION>ACC>UNIT-PRC, a
fractional monetary unit can be input. For instance, an input of "50" signifies 50 cents ($0.50).
Setting range: 0 to 9999
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 10]
MAX-PRC Coin manager maximum value setting
This determines the maximum value handled by the coin manager which is connected. An error screen is displayed if a
value lower than the smallest unit is input when inputting the charge amount using initial settings/registration. For
instance, the service technician inputs "8900" if the maximum value supported by the Japanese yen coin manager is 8900
yen.
This item takes effect only when 4 is set for ACC>COIN. 1
Additional note
When a number from 1 to 4 (Euros, pounds, Swiss francs, dollars) is set for COPIER>OPTION>ACC>UNIT-PRC, a
fractional monetary unit can be input. For instance, an input of "50" signifies 50 cents ($0.50).
Setting range: 0 to 9999
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-72
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>ACC
Sub item Description level.
MIC-TUN Manual tuning of microphone used for voice recognition
This allows the audio intake level sensitivity to be adjusted manually for the input device connected by the user. This
item is operated and the adjustment made if the sensitivity of the microphone is not increased enough with automatic
tuning.
Reference: 1
See below for automatic tuning.
Initial settings/registration > system control > voice control settings > microphone tuning
Setting range: 0 to 255
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 128]
STPL-LMT *1 Used to restrict number of sheets for saddle binding.
0: 5 sheets (no white band)
1: 10 sheets (no white band) 2
2: 10 sheets (white band)
3: 15 sheets (no white band) [Factory default/After RAM clear]
SC-TYPE Used to switch type of coin vendor-compatible model
2
Whenever possible, avoid using this setting during normal operation.
CC-SPSW use it to enable/disable support of the switch in relation to the support level of the control guard I/F
0: do not support [Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: support (priority on speed)
2: support (priority on upper limit on number of prints)
Reference: 2
negative effects of '1'
- the machine may fail to use an accurate stop based on the upper limit
negative effects of '2'
- some source of power (pickup assembly) may suffer a drop in productivity
UNIT-PRC Setting of unit prices handled by coin vendor
Settings
0: Japanese yen
1: Euros
2: Pounds
2
3: Swiss francs
4: Dollars
5: No unit, no fractional monetary unit provided
6: No unit, fractional monetary unit provided
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
DA-PUCT Sheet feed/delivery communication setting with DA charges
This mode prevents the kind of trouble where iR continues to output the sheet feed notification and prints continue to be
made free of charge even when there is something wrong with the sheet feed/delivery notification because of trouble in
the network.
No sheets are fed if the difference between the number of times iR has given sheet feed notification and the number of
2
sheets for which sheet feed acknowledge is returned from DA during sheet feed/delivery communication between iR and
DA is higher than this item's setting. If this item is set too low, a poor engine performance results which is a
disadvantage.
Setting range: 2 to 10
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 6]
17-73
Chapter 17
5. INT-FACE
T-17-59
COPIER>OPTION>INT-FACE
Sub item Description level.
IMG-CONT Used to set connection to PS print server unit.
Setting values
0: Normal mode (no PS print server unit) [Factory default]
1: Not used
2: Not used
3: PS print server unit
4: Not used
5: Not used
Attention:
When 1 is selected as the setting value, the following user mode items are restored to their initial values:
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP
address settings > IP address
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP
address settings > Sub-net mask
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP
address settings > Gateway address
- System management settings > Network settings > Ethernet driver settings
> Communication method
- System management settings > Network settings > Ethernet driver settings
> Ethernet type
- System management settings > Network settings > Startup time
1
- Common specifications settings
The following user mode settings are turned OFF:
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP address setting > DHCP use
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP
address settings > RARP use
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IP
address settings > BOOTP use
- System management settings > Network settings > Ethernet driver settings
> Automatic detection
- System management settings > Network settings > Spool function use
When 3 or 4 is selected as the setting value, the following settings are
turned OFF in addition to the items above.
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings >
RAW setting
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > LPD
setting
- System management settings > Network settings > TCP/IP settings > IPP
printing
- System management settings > Network settings > SMB setting
The items above are not restored when the setting value is returned to "0:
Normal mode", so must be set again as needed.
AP-OPT Used to set whether printing from application PrintMe in PS print server unit is possible.
0: Printing permitted for all department IDs [Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
1: Printing refused (printing is only possible for specified department ID).
AP-ACCNT Used to set (CPCA) department ID for printing (print jobs) from application PrintMe in PS print server unit.
2
0 to 9999999 [Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
AP-CODE Use it to set a path for printing from an external controller (CPCA).
Setting: 0 [Factory default/After RAM clear] 2
Setting range: 0 to 9999
NWCT-TM Sets the time limit for maintaining the network connection ('KeepAlive' setting).
Sets the length of time that the PC application and the iR device can be kept connected (KeepAlive) via the network.
Main PC applications (envisaged): network printing application, email function, remote copy printer function, MEAP
network applications, etc. 2
6. LCNS-TR
T-17-60
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
Sub item Description level.
ST-SEND Use it to select whether to display the installation status of the SEND function when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: SEND function not available (not installed) 2
1: SEND function available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear]
TR-SEND Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the SEND function when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the SEND function in other MFP machine.
OF-SEND Use it to select whether to use the SEND function when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use SEND function. 2
1: Use SEND function.
[Factory default/After RAM clear]
ST-ENPDF Use it to display the installation status of the SEND encryption PDF transmission function when the transfer function is
set invalid.
Setting value
2
0: SEND encryption PDF transmission function not available (not installed)
1: SEND encryption PDF transmission function available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
17-74
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
Sub item Description level.
TR-ENPDF Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the SEND encryption PDF transmission function when the transfer function
is set invalid. 2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the SEND encryption PDF transmission function in other MFP machine.
OF-ENPDF Use it to select whether to use the SEND encryption PDF transmission function when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use SEND encryption PDF transmission function. 2
1: Use SEND encryption PDF transmission function.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-SPDF Use it to select whether to display the installation status of the SEND searchable PDF transmission function when the
transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
2
0: SEND searchable PDF transmission function not available (not installed)
1: SEND searchable PDF transmission function available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-SPDF Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the SEND searchable PDF transmission function when the transfer function
is set invalid. 2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the SEND searchable PDF transmission function in other MFP machine.
OF-SPDF Use it to select whether to use the SEND searchable PDF transmission function when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use SEND searchable PDF transmission function. 2
1: Use SEND searchable PDF transmission function.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-EXPDF Use it to display the installation status of the PDF expansion kit (encryption PDF + searchable PDF) when the transfer
function is set invalid.
Setting value
2
0: PDF expansion kit not available (not installed)
1: PDF expansion kit available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-EXPDF Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the PDF expansion kit (encryption PDF + searchable PDF) when the transfer
function is set invalid. 2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the PDF expansion kit (encryption PDF + searchable PDF) in other MFP machine.
OF-EXPDF Use it to select whether to use the PDF expansion kit (encryption PDF + searchable PDF) when the transfer function is
set invalid.
Setting value
2
0: Do not use PDF expansion kit.
1: Use PDF expansion kit.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-PDFDR Use it to display the installation status of the PDF Direct when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: PDF Direct not available (not installed) 2
1: PDF Direct available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-PDFDR Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the PDF Direct when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the PDF Direct in other MFP machine.
OF-PDFDR Use it to select whether to use the PDF Direct when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use PDF Direct. 2
1: Use PDF Direct.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-SCR Use it to display the installation status of the encryption secure print when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Encryption secure print not available (not installed) 2
1: Encryption secure print available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-SCR Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the encryption secure print when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the encryption secure print in other MFP machine.
OF-SCR Use it to select whether to use the encryption secure print when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use encryption secure print. 2
1: Use encryption secure print.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-HDCLR Use it to display the installation status of the HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion when the transfer function is set
invalid.
Setting value
2
0: HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion not available (not installed)
1: HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-HDCLR Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion when the transfer function is
set invalid. 2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion in other MFP machine.
OF-HDCLR Use it to select whether to use the HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion. 2
1: Use HDD encryption / HDD complete deletion.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-BRDIM [Factory default/After RAM clear:
Setting value
0: BarDIMM not available (not installed) 2
1: BarDIMM available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-BRDIM Use it to obtain the transfer license key for BarDIMM when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use BarDIMM in other MFP machine.
17-75
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
Sub item Description level.
OF-BRDIM Use it to select whether to use BarDIMM when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use BarDIMM. 2
1: Use BarDIMM.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-VNC Use it to display the VNC installation status when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: VNC not available (not installed) 2
1: VNC available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-VNC Use it to obtain the transfer license key for VNC when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use VNC in other MFP machine.
OF-VNC Use it to select whether to use VNC when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use VNC. 2
1: Use VNC.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-WEB Use it to display the installation status of the WEB browser when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: WEB browser not available (not installed) 2
1: WEB browser available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-WEB Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the WEB browser when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the WEB browser in other MFP machine.
OF-WEB Use it to select whether to use the WEB browser when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use WEB browser. 2
1: Use WEB browser.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-HRPDF Use it to display the installation status of the high-compression PDF when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: High-compression PDF not available (not installed) 2
1: High-compression PDF available (installed)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TR-HRPDF Use it to obtain the transfer license key for the high-compression PDF when the transfer function is set invalid.
2
Obtains the transfer license key to use the high-compression PDF in other MFP machine.
OF-HRPDF Use it to select whether to use the high-compression PDF when the transfer function is set invalid.
Setting value
0: Do not use high-compression PDF. 2
1: Use high-compression PDF.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
ST-TRSND Display of installation status of test SEND function in transfer invalidation
Displays installation status of test SEND function.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-TRSND Test SEND function transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow test SEND function to be used with another MFP.
OF-TRSND Test SEND function ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches test SEND function ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-WTMRK Display of installation status of main unit watermark function in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of main unit watermark function.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-WTMRK Main unit watermark function transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow main unit watermark function to be used with another MFP.
OF-WTMRK Main unit watermark function ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches main unit watermark function ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-TSPDF Display of installation status of time stamped PDF transmission function in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of time stamped PDF transmission function.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-TSPDF Time stamped PDF transmission function transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow time stamped PDF transmission function to be used with another MFP.
17-76
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
Sub item Description level.
OF-TSPDF Time stamped PDF transmission function ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches time stamped PDF transmission function ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-USPDF Display of installation status of user signature attached PDF transmission function in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of user signature attached PDF transmission function.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-USPDF User signature attached PDF transmission function transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow user signature attached PDF transmission function to be used with another MFP.
OF-USPDF User signature attached PDF transmission function ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches user signature attached PDF transmission function ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-DVPDF Display of installation status of device signature attached PDF transmission function in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of device signature attached PDF transmission function.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-DVPDF Device signature attached PDF transmission function transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow device signature attached PDF transmission function to be used with another MFP.
OF-DVPDF Device signature attached PDF transmission function ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches device signature attached PDF transmission function ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-SCPDF Display of installation status of scalable PDF transmission function in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of scalable PDF transmission function.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-SCPDF Scalable PDF transmission function transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow scalable PDF transmission function to be used with another MFP.
OF-SCPDF Scalable PDF transmission function ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches scalable PDF transmission function ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-AMS Display of installation status of ACQ in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of ACQ.
Setting values
2
0: No (not installed)
1: Yes (installed)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-AMS ACQ transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow ACQ to be used with another MFP.
OF-AMS ACQ ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches ACQ ON/ OFF.
Setting values
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
ST-ERDS Display of installation status of 3rd party expansion functions for ERDS subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays whether any the 3rd party expansion functions (functions for sending the charge counters to the 3rd party
charge server) have been installed for ERDS.
Settings 2
0: OFF (functions not installed)
1: ON (functions installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-ERDS Acquisition of license key for transmitting 3rd party expansion functions for ERDS subsequent to disabling transmission
This acquires the transmission license key in order for the 3rd party expansion functions (functions for sending the charge 2
counters to the 3rd party charge server) for ERDS to be used by another MFP.
OF-ERDS ON/OFF of 3rd party expansion functions for ERDS subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for the 3rd party expansion functions (functions for sending the charge counters to the 3rd party
charge server) for ERDS.
Settings 2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-77
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
Sub item Description level.
ST-PS Display of installation status of PS in transfer invalidation.
Displays installation status of PS.
Setting values
0: No (not installed) 2
1: Yes (installed)
Reference value
0
TR-PS PS transfer licence key acquisition in transfer invalidation
2
Acquires transfer licence key to allow PS to be used with another MFP.
OF-PS PS ON/ OFF in transfer invalidation.
Switches PS ON/ OFF.
Setting values
0: OFF 2
1: ON
Reference value
0
ST-PCL Display of PCL installation status subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the PCL installation status.
Settings
2
0: OFF (PCL not installed)
1: ON (PCL installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-PCL Acquisition of PCL transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for PCL to be used by another MFP.
OF-PCL ON/OFF of PCL subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for PCL.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-PSLI5 Display of installation status of PS, LIPS4 and LIPS LX subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of PS, LIPS4 and LIPS LX (known as "UFR II"
overseas).
Settings 2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-PSLI5 Acquisition of PS, LIPS4 and LIPS LX transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for PS, LIPS4 and LIPS LX to be used by another MFP.
OF-PSLI5 ON/OFF of PS, LIPS4 and LIPS LX subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for PS, LIPS4 and LIPS LX.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-LIPS5 Display of installation status of LIPS4 and LIPS LX subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of LIPS4 and LIPS LX (known as "UFR II"
overseas).
Settings 2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-LIPS5 Acquisition of LIPS4 and LIPS LX transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for LIPS4 and LIPS LX to be used by another MFP.
OF-LIPS5 ON/OFF of LIPS4 and LIPS LX subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for LIPS4 and LIPS LX.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-LIPS4 Display of installation status of LIPS4 subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of LIPS4.
Settings
2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-LIPS4 Acquisition of LIPS4 transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for LIPS4 to be used by another MFP.
OF-LIPS4 ON/OFF of LIPS4 subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for LIPS4.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-PSPCL Display of installation status of PS and PCL subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of PS and PCL.
Settings
2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-PSPCL Acquisition of PS and PCL transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for PS and PCL to be used by another MFP.
17-78
Chapter 17
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
Sub item Description level.
OF-PSPCL ON/OFF of PS and PCL subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for PS and PCL.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-PCLUF Display of installation status of PCL and UFR subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of PCL and UFR.
Settings
2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-PCLUF Acquisition of PCL and UFR transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for PCL and UFR to be used by another MFP.
OF-PCLUF ON/OFF of PCL and UFR subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for PCL and UFR.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-PSLIP Display of installation status of PS and LIPS subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of PS and LIPS.
Settings
2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-PSLIP Acquisition of PS and LIPS transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for PS and LIPS to be used by another MFP.
OF-PSLIP ON/OFF of PS and LIPS subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for PS and LIPS.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-PSPCU Display of installation status of PS, PCL and UFR subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of PS, PCL and UFR.
Settings
2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-PSPCU Acquisition of PS, PCL and UFR transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
2
This acquires the transmission license key in order for PS, PCL and UFR to be used by another MFP.
OF-PSPCU ON/OFF of PS, PCL and UFR subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for PS, PCL and UFR.
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-LXUFR Display of installation status of LIPS LX (known as "UFR II" overseas) subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of the combined options consisting of LIPS LX (known as "UFR II" overseas).
Settings
2
0: OFF (options not installed)
1: ON (options installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-LXUFR Acquisition of LIPS LX (known as "UFR II" overseas) transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
This acquires the transmission license key in order for LIPS LX (known as "UFR II" overseas) to be used by another
MFP.
OF-LXUFR ON/OFF of LIPS LX (known as "UFR II" overseas) subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for LIPS LX (known as "UFR II" overseas).
Settings
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
ST-HDCR2 Display of installation status of all hard disk data erasure subsequent to disabling transmission
This displays the installation status of all hard disk data erasure.
Settings
0: OFF (not installed)
1: ON (installed)
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
TR-HDCR2 Acquisition of all hard disk data erasure transmission license key subsequent to disabling transmission
This acquires the transmission license key in order for all hard disk data erasure to be used by another MFP.
OF-HDCR2 ON/OFF of all hard disk data erasure subsequent to disabling transmission
This selects ON or OFF for all hard disk data erasure.
Settings
2
0: OFF
1: ON
[Factory setting/value after clearing RAM: 0]
17-79
Chapter 17
17.6.2 SORTER
T-17-61
SORTER>OPTION
Sub item Description level.
BLNK-SW Fold position margin width (W) settings when saddle stitcher is used
Setting values
0: Normal width (5 mm) 1
1: Extra width (10 mm)
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
MD-SPRTN Finisher function restriction setting
Setting values
0: Normal 1
1: Reduced operation
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
F-17-21
F-17-22
17.6.3 BOARD
T-17-62
BOARD>OPTION
Sub item Description level.
SURF-OFF UFR Board function release
Setting values
1
0: Even with no UFR board, device operates as copy model, without E code display.
1: UFR board identification check performed. With no UFR board, E code is displayed.
MENU-1 to 4 Displays printer setting menu levels 1 to 4.
Setting values
0: No display 2
1: Display
[Factory settings and after RAM clear: 0]
TR-DSP Toggles between display/ non display of toner reduction function switch.
2
Should be avoided where possible during normal operation.
17-80
Chapter 17
17.7.1 COPIER
1. PG
T-17-63
COPIER>TEST>PG
Sub item Description level.
TYPE Performs test print when test print type number is entered and start key is turned ON. (This setting must always be
restored to 0 after making test print.)
Setting values 1
0: Normal print, 0 to 100
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
TXPH Used to set image mode during test print output.
Setting value
0: Error diffusion
1: Screen with small line number [133 to 190 lines]
2: Screen with large line number [200 to 268 lines]
3: Screen for COPY [around 220 lines] 1
4: Screen for REOS [no screen structure]
5:Error diffusion[w/ end correction ]
6:Screen with large line number[w/ end correction]
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
THRU Used to select whether to use image compensation table during test print output.
Setting values
0: ON (Use) 1
1: OFF (Don't use)
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
DENS-Y/M/C/K Used to adjust density of each color for test prints (TYPE = 5).
Setting values
1
0 to 255: Increasing the value increases the density.
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 128]
COLOR-Y/M/C/K Used to set output of each color for each TYPE.
For example, to set single-color M output, set "COLOR-M = 1", and make the other settings 0 (only single colors can be
output).
Setting values 1
0: Don't output
1: Output
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
F/M-SW Set it to switch over full color and mono color during PG output.
Settings
0: full color output 1
1: mono color output
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
PG-PICK Used to select output level during test print output.
Setting values
1: Cassette 1
2: Cassette 2
3: Cassette 3
1
4: Cassette 4
5 to 6: Not used
7: Side deck
8: Manual feed
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
2-SIDE Use it to set the output mode for test printing.
Settings
0: single-sided (at time of shipment/upon RAM initialization) 1
1: double-sided
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 0]
PG-QTY Use it to set the output mode for test printing.
Use it to set the copy count of test printing.
1
1 to 999
[Factory default/After RAM clear: 1]
Type of test print for each number entered for PG > TYPE
T-17-64
17-81
Chapter 17
2. NETWORK
T-17-65
COPIER>TEST>NETWORK
Sub item Description level.
PING Checks connection between copier and network (during TCP/IP connection only). 1
Use this item when checking the connection to the network at time of installation or when there is a network connection
problem.
BML-DISP Switching display of the screen in response to support for BMlinks 2
Settings
0: Normal system status screen [Factory default/After RAM clear]
1: Screen of device display only
+/- OK
F-17-23
17-82
Chapter 17
17.8.1 COPIER
The COPIER/COUNTER screen is shown below. The items are described starting on the next page.
F-17-24
Clearing counter values
1) Select the item to clear, displaying it in reverse.
2) Press the clear key on the operation panel.
- The counter is cleared, resetting it to "00000000".
Small size and large size in this mode
- TOTAL/PICKUP/FEEDER/JAM
Large (L) size: Paper larger than A4, LTR size
Small (S) size: A4, LTR size and smaller paper
- DRBL-1/DRBL-2 (PD-PU-RL)
Large (L) size: Paper longer than 324 mm in the feed direction
Small (S) size: Paper 324 mm or shorter in the feed direction
<Example>
TR-BELT / 00000201 / 00240000 / 0% !! 000082
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
[1]: Displays the part name. In this example, the intermediate transfer belt unit.
[2]: Displays the counter value (actual number of sheets used). The value is cleared by pressing the clear key when the part is replaced.
[3]: Displays the limit value (number of sheets as guideline for replacement). You can select the item and change the value with the numeric keypad. After
changing the value, press the OK key.
[4]: Displays the ratio of the counter value to the limit value.
[5]: When the ratio is between 90% and 100%, a single exclamation mark (!) is displayed.
When the ratio is over 100%, two exclamation marks (!!) appear. In the example above, no exclamation marks would appear.
[6]: Displays the predicted number of days until replacement. The example above shows 82 days.
1. TOTAL
T-17-66
COPIER>COUNTER>TOTAL
Sub item Description level.
SERVICE1 Service total counter 1
Incremented when paper is delivered outside the printer.
1
(Incremented for both large and small size sheets.)
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
SERVICE2 Service total counter 2
Incremented when paper is delivered outside the printer.
1
(Incremented by 2 for large size sheets, and by 1 for small size sheets.)
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
COPY Total copies counter
Incremented when a copy operation is performed and paper is delivered outside the printer. 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
17-83
Chapter 17
COPIER>COUNTER>TOTAL
Sub item Description level.
PDL-PRT PDL print counter
Incremented along with the billing counter during PDL printing, when paper is delivered outside the copier and two-sided
paper is loaded. 1
Blank sheets are not counted. Incremented by 1 for both large and small size sheets.
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
FAX-PRT Fax received print counter
Incremented along with the billing counter when a fax is received, when a print is delivered outside the copier and two-
sided paper is loaded. 1
Blank sheets are not counted. Incremented by 1 for both large and small size sheets. Can be cleared.
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
BOX-PRT Box print counter
Incremented along with the billing counter when a box print is made, when paper is delivered outside the copier and two-
sided paper is loaded. 1
Blank sheets are not counted. Incremented by 1 for both large and small size sheets. Can be cleared.
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
RPT-PRT Report print counter
Incremented along with the billing counter when a report print is made, when paper is delivered outside the copier and
two-sided paper is loaded. 1
Blank sheets are not counted. Incremented by 1 for both large and small size sheets. Can be cleared.
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
2-SIDE Two-sided copy/print counter
Incremented along with the billing counter when a two-sided copy/print is made, when paper is delivered outside the
copier and two-sided paper is loaded. 1
Blank sheets are not counted. Incremented by 1 for both large and small size sheets. Can be cleared.
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
SCAN Scan counter
Incremented along with the billing counter when a scan is made, when reading finishes.
1
Incremented by 1 for both large and small size sheets. Can be cleared.
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
2. PICK-UP
T-17-67
COPIER>COUNTER>PICK-UP
Sub item Description level.
C1 Cassette 1 paper feed total counter
Displays number of sheets fed from cassette 1. 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
C2 Cassette 2 paper feed total counter
Displays number of sheets fed from cassette 2. 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
C3 Cassette 3 paper feed total counter
Displays number of sheets fed from cassette 3 (top level of cassette pedestal). 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
C4 Cassette 4 paper feed total counter
Displays number of sheets fed from cassette 4 (bottom level of cassette pedestal). 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
MF Manual paper feed total counter
Displays number of sheets fed from manual paper feed unit. 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
DK Deck paper feed total counter
Displays number of sheets fed from deck paper feed unit. 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
2-SIDE Two-sided paper feed total counter
Displays number of two-sided sheets fed. 1
Returns to "00000000" after reaching "99999999".
3. FEEDER
T-17-68
COPIER>COUNTER>FEEDER
Sub item Description level.
FEED ADF document feed total counter 1
DFOP-CNT ADF hinge open/close count display
1
Counts how many times ADF is opened/closed.
4. JAM
T-17-69
COPIER>COUNTER>JAM
Sub item Description level.
TOTAL Total jam counter for copier 1
FEEDER Total jam counter for feeder 1
SORTER Total jam counter for finisher 1
2-SIDE Jam counter for two-sided unit 1
MF Jam counter for multi-feeder 1
C1 Jam counter for cassette 1 1
C2 Jam counter for cassette 2 1
17-84
Chapter 17
COPIER>COUNTER>JAM
Sub item Description level.
C3 Jam counter for cassette 3 1
C4 Jam counter for cassette 4 1
DK Jam counter for side paper deck 1
5. MISC
T-17-70
COPIER>COUNTER>MISC
Sub item Description level.
T-SPLY-Y Toner supply counter (Y)
This indicates the number of times the toner in the Y color developer has been supplied.
1
The counter is cleared by executing CLEAR>Y-TN-CLR when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner
runs out after the low remaining Y color toner warning has been given.
T-SPLY-M Toner supply counter (M)
This indicates the number of times the toner in the M color developer has been supplied.
1
The counter is cleared by executing CLEAR>M-TN-CLR when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner
runs out after the low remaining M color toner warning has been given.
T-SPLY-C Toner supply counter (C)
This indicates the number of times the toner in the C color developer has been supplied.
1
The counter is cleared by executing CLEAR>C-TN-CLR when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner
runs out after the low remaining C color toner warning has been given.
T-SPLY-K Toner supply counter (K)
This indicates the number of times the toner in the K color developer has been supplied.
1
The counter is cleared by executing CLEAR>K-TN-CLR when the toner cartridge has been replaced before the toner
runs out after the low remaining K color toner warning has been given.
6. DRBL-1
T-17-71
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1
Sub item Description level.
LSR-DRV Laser drive sheet count 1
T/S-UNIT Transfer/detach charger high voltage ON sheet count 1
T-CLN-BD Number of sheets that have passed through transfer cleaning unit (count value is stored in controller). 1
TR-BLT Number of sheets that have passed through intermediate transfer belt unit (count value is stored in controller). 1
TR-ROLL Number of sheets that have passed through secondary transfer roller (count value is stored in controller). 1
PT-DRM Bk photosensitive drum rotation sheet count
This indicates the cumulative total number of sheets which have passed over the drum. It is cleared when the Bk 1
photosensitive drum has been replaced.
PT-DR-Y Y photosensitive drum rotation sheet count
This indicates the cumulative total number of sheets which have passed over the drum. It is cleared when the Y 1
photosensitive drum has been replaced.
PT-DR-M M photosensitive drum rotation sheet count
This indicates the cumulative total number of sheets which have passed over the drum. It is cleared when the M 1
photosensitive drum has been replaced.
PT-DR-C C photosensitive drum rotation sheet count
This indicates the cumulative total number of sheets which have passed over the drum. It is cleared when the C 1
photosensitive drum has been replaced.
C1-PU-RL Cassette 1 sheet feed roller pass-over sheet count (count held at controller side) 1
C1-SP-RL Cassette 1 separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
C1-FD-RL Cassette 1 separation roller no. of sheets fedCassette 1 separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
C2-PU-RL Cassette 2 sheet feed roller pass-over sheet count (count held at controller side) 1
C2-SP-RL Cassette 1 separation roller no. of sheets fedCassette 2 separation roller no. of sheets fedCassette 1 separation roller no.
1
of sheets fed
C2-FD-RL Cassette 1 separation roller no. of sheets fedCassette 2 separation roller no. of sheets fedCassette 2 separation roller no.
1
of sheets fedCassette 1 separation roller no. of sheets fed
M-PU-RL Manual feed roller pass-over sheet count (count held at controller side) 1
M-SP-RL Manual feed tray separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
FX-LW-RL Pressure roller pass-over sheet count (count held at controller side) 1
FX-UNIT Fixing unit pass-through sheet count (count held at controller side) 1
FX-UP-FR Fixing unit upper frame unit pass-through sheet count (count held at controller side) 1
FX-LW-BR Pressure roller bearing counter 1
WST-TNR 2 Waste toner counter
1
When waste toner is removed, this counter is cleared.
TN-FIL1 Toner filter (FM1) fan drive sheet count 1
7. DRBL-2
T-17-72
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
Sub item Description level.
DF-PU-RL Number of sheets that have passed through ADF paper feed roller.
1
(count retained by controller PCB)
17-85
Chapter 17
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
Sub item Description level.
DF-SP-PD Number of sheets that have passed through ADF separation pad.
1
(count retained by controller PCB)
LNT-TAPE ADF lint tape pass-through sheet count 1
STAMP Stamp operation count 1
PD-PU-RL for the paper deck pickup roller, indicates the number of sheets that have passed.
1
(count retained by controller PCB)
PD-SP-RL for the paper deck separation roller, indicates the number of sets that have passed.
1
(count retained by controller PCB)
PD-FD-RL for the paper deck feed roller, indicates the number of sheets that have passed.
1
(count retained by controller PCB)
C3-SP-RL Count 3 separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
C3-FD-RL Count 3 separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
C4-SP-RL Count 4 separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
C4-FD-RL Count 4 separation roller no. of sheets fed 1
SORT Sort path pass-through sheet count
1
Each L size sheet is also counted as one sheet.
FIN-STPR Number of staple operations. 1
SADDLE Saddle operation sheet count
1
Each L size sheet is also counted as one sheet.
SDL-STPL Number of saddle staple operations.
1
Incremented by 1 even for L-size sheets.
17-86
Chapter 18 Upgrading
Contents
Contents
18.1 Outline........................................................................................................................................................................18-1
18.1.1 System Software Type ............................................................................................................................................................. 18-1
18.1.2 Upgrading Overview................................................................................................................................................................ 18-2
18.1.3 Function/Operation Overview ................................................................................................................................................ 18-3
18.1.4 Points to Note at Time of Downloading .................................................................................................................................. 18-5
18.2 Making Preparations ..................................................................................................................................................18-5
18.2.1 Installing the System Software (System CD -> SST).............................................................................................................. 18-5
18.2.2 Installing the System Software (SST -> USB) ........................................................................................................................ 18-7
18.2.3 Making Connections (SST in use) ........................................................................................................................................... 18-9
18.2.4 Making Connections (USB device in use)............................................................................................................................. 18-10
18.3 Formatting the HDD ................................................................................................................................................18-10
18.3.1 Formatting All Partitions ....................................................................................................................................................... 18-10
18.3.2 Formatting Selected Partitions ............................................................................................................................................... 18-11
18.3.3 Formatting the Partitions........................................................................................................................................................ 18-12
18.4 Downloading System Software................................................................................................................................18-13
18.4.1 Batch Downloading ............................................................................................................................................................... 18-13
18.4.1.1 Outline.......................................................................................................................................................................................................18-13
18.4.1.2 Downloading Procedure............................................................................................................................................................................18-13
18.4.2 Downloading the System Software (Single).......................................................................................................................... 18-16
18.4.2.1 Downloading Procedure............................................................................................................................................................................18-16
18.5 Uploading and Downloading Backup Data .............................................................................................................18-19
18.5.1 Outline.................................................................................................................................................................................... 18-19
18.5.2 Uploading Procedure ............................................................................................................................................................. 18-19
18.5.3 Downloading Procedure......................................................................................................................................................... 18-21
18.6 Version Upgrade using USB....................................................................................................................................18-22
18.6.1 Overview of Menus and Functions ........................................................................................................................................ 18-22
18.6.2 Points to Note......................................................................................................................................................................... 18-23
18.6.3 Downloading/Writing the System Software (auto)................................................................................................................ 18-24
18.6.4 Downloading the System Software (Confirmation execution when version is downed the same version) .......................... 18-24
18.6.5 Downloading the System Software (all overwriting) ............................................................................................................ 18-25
18.6.6 Formatting the HDD .............................................................................................................................................................. 18-26
18.6.7 Other Functions...................................................................................................................................................................... 18-27
Chapter 18
18.1 Outline
T-18-1
18-1
Chapter 18
The software for the copier and the accessories can be upgraded by the following procedures.
- By download from the personal computer (hereafter PC) in which the service support tool (hereafter SST) is installed.
- By download from the USB memory.
- By changing ROM-DIMM (Boot, G3FAX, G4FAX* only).
T-18-2
18-2
Chapter 18
When connected to a PC (to which the SST and system software have been installed) and USB device (to which system software has been copied), the machine
provides the following functions:
iR C - - - -
USB device
HDD
Downloading
system software
System software
Flash ROM
Uploading backup data *1
Back up RAM
F-18-1
*1: *1: Not when USB is in use.
In case of using these functions, it is necessary to set the copier in the download mode.
There are two types of download:
18-3
Chapter 18
HDD
SYSTEM program
In service mode
COPIER > FUNCTION >
SYSTEM > DOWNLOAD
Normal mode
program
F-18-2
Download Mode
Function Normal Mode Safe Mode
(Download Mode B) (Download Mode A)
HDD Format - ALL
- BOOTDEV
18-4
Chapter 18
System area
Boot
ROM
4) The main motor switch
is turned off and then on.
FLASH
ROM
Here, you will be copying the system software found on the System CD to the SST.
[Preparatory Work]
Requirements
- PC installed with SST version 3.22 or later
- System CD for this machine
18-5
Chapter 18
CONNECT
MFP
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c: START
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-4
5) Select the drive in which the System CD has been set, and click [SEARCH].
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
CONNECT
e:
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e
e:
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e iRC3380-XXxx-BOOT
iRC3380-JPja
iRC3380-XXen-TTS
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a iRC3380-XXjaXXXX-RUI
iRC3380-XXja-LANG
iRC3380-XXxxXXXX-BROWS
System Management
REGISTER SEARCH
EXIT
F-18-5
MEMO:
'XXXX' on the screen indicates the system software version (Same in the subsequent figures).
6) A list of system software found on the System CD appears. Remove the check marks from the folders and software files you do not need, and click [REGISTER].
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
iRC3380
CONNECT BOOT
XXxxvXXXX
iRC3380
SYSTEM
BOOT R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e JPjavXXXX
XXxxvXXXX TTS
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e XXenvXXXX
RUI
XXjavXXXX
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a LANGUAGE
XXjavXXXX
BROWSER
System Management XXxxvXXXX
DCON
XXxxvXXXX
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-6
7) When a message has appeared to indicate that the system software has been installed, click [OK].
18-6
Chapter 18
iRC3380
CONNECT BOOT
XXenvXXXX XXxxvXXXX >>> Regist
iRC3380 SYSTEM
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e USenvXXXX >>> Regist
RCON
TTS
XXxxvXXXX
iRCXXXX D e l e t e F i r m wa r e XXenvXXXX >>> Regist
HDFormat RUI
XXenvXXXX >>> Regist
XXxxvXXXX
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a LANGUAGE
KEY
XXenvXXXX >>> Regist
XXxcvXXXX
BROWSER
System Management XXxxvXXXX >>> Regist
DCON
XXxxvXXXX >>> Regist
MEAPCONT
Model Configuration Info : Update O K XXxxvXXXX >>> Regist
OK
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-7
Here, you will be copying the system software from the SST to a USB device.
[Preparatory Work]
Requirements
- PC installed with SST version 3.22 or later
- USB device (*)
*: USB Requirements
Interface USB 1.1 or higher (USB 2.0 or recommended)
Capacity 1 GB or more recommended
(A set of system software is in excess of 512 MB.)
Format FAT (FAT16), FAT32 (It must not be NTFS or HFS.)
single partition (There must not be multiple partitions.)
You will not be able to use a security-protected USB device. Be sure to remove the protection before use.
Series
E x p o r t F i r m wa r e
Version
MFP
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Firmware registration status
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c: START
Select the destinate drive.
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-8
5) Select the drive to which the USB device has been connected.
18-7
Chapter 18
Series
E x p o r t F i r m wa r e
Version
MFP
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Firmware registration status
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
d: START
Valid drive
DriveType:1
FileSystem:FAT
TotalSize:1,001MB CANCEL
FreeSpace:1,001MB
EXIT
F-18-9
6) Select the appropriate 'Series' and 'Version' of the system software you want to copy.
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
Series iRC3380
E x p o r t F i r m wa r e
Version USenXXXX(US)
MFP
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Firmware registration status
USB iRC3380
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e BOOT
Y XXxxvXXXX
BROWSER
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a Y XXxxvXXXX
DCON
Y XXxxvXXXX
USB System Management LANGUAGE
Y XXenvXXXX
N XXjavXXXX
MEAPCONT
d: START Y XXxxvXXXX
Valid drive RUI
DriveType:1 Y XXenvXXXX
FileSystem:FAT N XXjavXXXX
TotalSize:1,001MB CANCEL
FreeSpace:1,001MB SDICT
N XXxxvXXXX
SYSTEM
EXIT N USenvXXXX
F-18-10
MEMO:
The notations that appear in the column under "Firmware registration status" mean the following:
Y: exists in the SST.
N: does not exist in the SST.
Series iRC3380
E x p o r t F ir mwa re
Version USenXXXX(US)
MFP
R e g is te r F ir mwa re Firmware registration status
USB iRC3380
D e le te F ir mwa re BOOT
Y XXxxvXXXX
BROWSER
D e le te B a ck u p D a ta Y XXxxvXXXX
DCON
Y XXxxvXXXX
USB S y s te m Ma n a g e me n t LANGUAGE
Y XXenvXXXX
N XXjavXXXX
MEAPCONT
d: START Y XXxxvXXXX
Valid drive RUI
DriveType:1 Y XXenvXXXX
FileSystem:FAT N XXjavXXXX
TotalSize:1,001MB CANCEL
FreeSpace:1,001MB SDICT
N XXxxvXXXX
SYSTEM
EXIT N USenvXXXX
F-18-11
8) When done, click [OK].
18-8
Chapter 18
Series iRC3380
E x p o r t F i r m wa r e
Version USenXXXX(US)
MFP
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Firmware registration status
USB iRC3380
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e BOOT
Y XXxxvXXXX
BROWSER
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a Y XXxxvXXXX
DCON
Y XXxxvXXXX
USB System Management LANGUAGE
Y XXenvXXXX
N XXjavXXXX
MEAPCONT
d: O K Y XXxxvXXXX
Valid drive RUI
DriveType:1 Y XXenvXXXX
FileSystem:FAT N XXjavXXXX
TotalSize:1,001MB CANCEL
FreeSpace:1,001MB SDICT
N XXxxvXXXX
SYSTEM
EXIT N USenvXXXX
F-18-12
[Requirements]
- PC to which the SST (version 3.22 or later) has been installed and the system software has been copied
- twisted-pair cross cable
10Base-T: Category 3 or 5
100Base-TX: Category 5
[Procedure]
1) Start up the PC.
2) Connect the PC to the machine with a cross cable.
3) Check the network settings of the PC.
3-1) Start the command prompt, and type in "IPCONFIG," and press the Return key.
3-2) Check to be sure that the network settings appearing on the screen are as follows; if not, change the PC network settings:
IP address: 172.16.1.160
Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0
Default gateway: any
4) Check to make sure that the Execute/Memory lamp on the control panel is off; then, turn off the main power switch.
4-1) Hold down the power switch on the control panel for 3 sec or more.
4-2) Go through the shut-down instructions appearing on the control panel screen so that the main power switch may be turned off.
4-3) Turn off the main power switch.
IP sddress: 172.16.1.160
Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0
Cross cable
IP address: 172.16.1.100 10Base-T: category 3, 5 or later
Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0 100Base-TX: category 5 or later
F-18-13
5) Set the machine to the appropriate mode:
- Normal Mode
Turn on the main power switch while holding down the keys 1 and 7.
When the machine has started, make the following selections in service mode:
COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DOWNLOAD; then, click [OK].
- Safe Mode
Turn on the main power switch while holding down the keys 2 and 8. In response, the machine will start up in safe mode.
18-9
Chapter 18
[Requirements]
- USB device to which the system software has been copied.
[Procedure]
1) Check to make sure that the Execute/Memory on the control panel is off; then, turn off the main power switch as follows:
1-1) Hold down the control panel power switch for 3 sec or more.
1-2) Go through the shut-down instructions.
1-3) Turn off the main power switch.
2) Connect the USB device [2] to the USB port [1].
[1] [2]
F-18-14
3) If a network cable is connected to the machine, disconnect it.
4) Set the machine to the appropriate download mode:
- Normal Mode
Turn on the main power switch while holding down the keys 1 and 7.
When the machine has started up, make the following selections in service mode, and press [OK]:
COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DOWNLOAD.
- Safe Mode
Turn on the main power switch while holding down the keys 2 and 8 so that the machine will start up in safe mode.
5) See the following menu appearing on the control panel screen, indicating that the machine has recognized the presence of a USB device.
F-18-15
The machine may not recognize certain types of USB device or USB device from certain manufacturers. The machine looks for a USB deivce for a maximum of
60 sec after its main power is turned on, not indicating the menu if it fails to detect one. (If such is the case, obtain an appropriate USB device.)
The SST cannot be run while the USB device is in use. (The machine will not communicate with the SST when it detects the presence of a USB device.)
When formatting the HDD for all partition, there will be partitions on the HDD and all these partitions will be formatted (initialized) and the main controller will
be made ready for use.
All the information needed to set up the partition is found in the partition settings file (on the SST, 'HDFormat' in the folder 'iRCXXXX').
18-10
Chapter 18
HDD
[4]
iRCXXXX
HDFormat FSTDEV
TMP_GEN
TMP_PSS
TMP_FAX
APL_SEND
[2] APL_MEAP
APL_GEN
APL_KEEP
APL_LOG
IMG_MNG
PDLDEV
FSTCDEV
THUMDEV
[1] BOOTDEV
[3]
F-18-16
[1] HDD (service part; without partitions)
[2] Formatting for full partition (only in safe mode)
[3] HDD after formatting
[4] Partition settings information file
When formatting the HDD for selected partitions, only those selected partitions will be initialized.
FSTDEV
TMP_GEN
TMP_PSS
TMP_FAX
HDD APL_SEND
[1]
APL_MEAP
APL_GEN
APL_KEEP
APL_LOG
IMG_MNG
PDLDEV
FSTCDEV
THUMDEV
[2]
BOOTDEV
F-18-17
[1] Formatting not possible
[2] Formatting possible in safe mode
18-11
Chapter 18
MEMO:
Partition-based formatting is possible in service mode (COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > HD-CLEAR), with the exception of BOOTDEV.
Interface
Network
IP Address
172.16.1.100 REGISTER REMOVE
iRC3380 [1]
CONNECT iRC3380
ALL
MFP ALL_HDF
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Single [2]
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c:
START
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-18
3) Click [Format HDD].
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
S e l e c t t h e f i r m wa r e t o b e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
d ow n l o a d e d . t h e n c l i ck t h e [ S t a r t ] exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
bu t t o n . Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
USenXXXXi
iRC3380
Download Firmware RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE Download Data XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM Restore Backup System LANGUAGE
TSTMP XXjaXXXX
TTS XXenXXXX
WebDAV Format HDD
BOOTROM
iRCXXXX XXxxXXXXC
HDFormat
KEY
SDICT Start
Shutdown
F-18-19
4) Specify BOOTDEV partition or full partition (ALL), and click [Start].
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
Control HDDFormat
Click the button of the task to be S e l e c t t h e p a r t i t i o n . t h e n c l i ck
exe c u t e d . [ S t a r t ] bu t t o n .
Download Firmware
Format HDD
ALL:
Start
Cansel
F-18-20
5) Click [Execute Formatting].
18-12
Chapter 18
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
Control HDDFormat
Click the button of the task to be E xe c u t e fo r m a t t i n g ?
exe c u t e d .
Download Firmware
Format HDD
ALL:
Start
Confirmation
E xe c u t e Fo r m a t t i n g
Cancel
F-18-21
6) When formatting has ended, click [OK] to return to the Menu screen.
7) Move on to download the system software.
Whenever you have executed HDD formatting, be sure to download the system software; otherwise, an error (E602) will occur when the main power is turned on.
18.4.1.1 Outline
0014-4497
iRC3380 [1]
iRC3380
CONNECT
MFP
ALL
ALL_HDF [2]
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Single
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c:
START
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-22
3) Make sure of the network settings, and click [Start Batch Download].
18-13
Chapter 18
Interface
Network
IP Address
172.16.1.100 REGISTER REMOVE
F-18-23
4) Click [Resume].
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
Interface
Network
IP Address
172.16.1.100 REGISTER REMOVE
Resume
Confirm firmware versions
Same Ver:Skip/ Ver down:Comfirm Pause
Confirm
Overwrite Finish
F-18-24
MEMO:
Refer to the Batch download results screen [1] for the progress of downloading.
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
Resume
Confirm firmware versions
Same Ver:Skip/ Ver down:Comfirm Pause
Confirm
Overwrite Finish
F-18-25
5) The Download End screen appears for the system software files to be stored on the HDD. To stop downloading, click [Finish]; if you want to download BOOT,
DCON, and RCON, on the other hand, click [Resume], and go to the next step.
18-14
Chapter 18
Resume
Confirm firmware versions
Same Ver:Skip/ Ver down:Comfirm Pause
Confirm
Overwrite Finish
F-18-26
6) Turn off the machine's main power switch, and start it up in normal mode (turn on the main power switch while holding down the 1 and 7 keys; then, start
download mode in service mode).
Click [Resume].
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
Resume
Confirm firmware versions
Same Ver:Skip/ Ver down:Comfirm Pause
Confirm
Overwrite Finish
F-18-27
7) Click [Resume] to start downloading BOOT, DCON, and RCON.
Service Support Tool DLM0 (Ver.3.22E)
Resume
Confirm firmware versions
Same Ver:Skip/ Ver down:Comfirm Pause
Confirm
Overwrite Finish
F-18-28
8) Click [OK].
18-15
Chapter 18
OK
Confirm firmware versions
Same Ver:Skip/ Ver down:Comfirm Pause
Confirm
Overwrite Finish
F-18-29
Here is the downloading procedure of the SYSTEM as a sample. (Same for other system software)
Interface
Network
IP Address
172.16.1.100 REGISTER REMOVE
iRC3380 [1]
CONNECT iRC3380
ALL
MFP ALL_HDF
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Single [2]
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c:
START
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-30
3) Select the version of the System software you want to download, and click [Start].
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
NORMAL
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
S e l e c t t h e f i r m wa r e t o b e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
d ow n l o a d e d . t h e n c l i ck t h e [ S t a r t ] exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
bu t t o n . Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
iRC3380 JPjaXXXXi
BOOT Download Firmware RCON
BROWSER XXxxXXXX
DCON DCON
G3FAX Upload Data XXxxXXXX
HELP RUI
LANGUAGE XXjaXXXX
MEAPCONT Download Data XXenXXXX
RUI MEAPCONT
SYSTEM XXxxXXXX
Restore Backup System
USenvXXXX LANGUAGE
TTS XXjaXXXX
iRCXXXX Format HDD XXenXXXX
HDFormat BOOTROM
KEY XXxxXXXXC
SDICT G3FAX
XXxxXXXX
Start
Cancel
F-18-31
4) When downloading has ended, click [OK] to go back to the previous screen.
18-16
Chapter 18
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
NORMAL
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
D ow n l o a d i n g c o m p l e t e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
USenXXXXi
iRC3380
Download Firmware RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE Download Data XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM Restore Backup System LANGUAGE
USenvXXXX XXjaXXXX
TSTMP XXenXXXX
TTS Format HDD
BOOTROM
WebDAV XXxxXXXXC
iRCXXXX
G3FAX
HDFormat
XXxxXXXX
KEY O K
SDICT
Shutdown
F-18-32
5) Start up the machine. The subsequent procedure differs depending on the download mode.
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
NORMAL
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
S e l e c t t h e f i r m wa r e t o b e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
d ow n l o a d e d . t h e n c l i ck t h e [ S t a r t ] exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
bu t t o n . Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
USenXXXXi
iRC3380
Download Firmware RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE Download Data XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI
XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM Restore Backup System LANGUAGE
TSTMP XXjaXXXX
TTS XXenXXXX
WebDAV Format HDD
BOOTROM
iRCXXXX
XXxxXXXXC
HDFormat
G3FAX
KEY
XXxxXXXX
SDICT Start
Shutdown
F-18-33
5-2) Click [Start Shutdown] so that the machine starts the shut-down sequence.
Message
Start Shutdown
Cancel
F-18-34
5-3) Click [OK], and turn off and then back on the machine's main power switch.
Message
O K
F-18-35
If the machine is in safe mode,
5-1) Turn off and then back on the machine's main power switch.
6) When the machine starts up, it will write the system software to its HDD and flash ROM while showing the progress of writing on the control panel screen. When
done, it will indicate a message asking you to turn off and then back on the power. In response, turn off and then back on the main power.
MEMO:
18-17
Chapter 18
You can remove the downloaded system software before it is written to the HDD or flash ROM. To do so, go through the following before restarting the machine:
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
NORMAL
Clear [1]
SelectableFirmware Control
D ow n l o a d i n g c o m p l e t e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
USenXXXXi
iRC3380
Download Firmware RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE Download Data XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI
XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM Restore Backup System LANGUAGE
TSTMP
XXjaXXXX
TTS XXenXXXX
WebDAV Format HDD
BOOTROM
iRCXXXX XXxxXXXXC
HDFormat
KEY
SDICT O K
Shutdown
F-18-36
2) Click [Execute Clear] so that the system software that has been stored in the temporary storage area of the HDD will be removed.
Message
Execute Clear
Cancel
F-18-37
3) Click [OK]. Return to the previous page.
Message
O K
F-18-38
MEMO:
After connecting, the following device information [1] is displayed on the right upper area of the SST screen.
- IP address
- Product name
- Download mode
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
NORMAL
[1]
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
Select the fir mware to be Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
downloaded. then click the [Star t] exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
button. Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFirmware Hold
USenXXXXi
iRC3380
D ow n l o a d F i r m wa r e RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE D ow n l o a d D a t a XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM R e s t o r e B a ck u p S y s t e m
LANGUAGE
TSTMP XXjaXXXX
TTS XXenXXXX
WebDAV Fo r m a t H D D
BOOTROM
iRCXXXX XXxxXXXXC
HDFormat
KEY
SDICT Star t
Shutdown
F-18-39
18-18
Chapter 18
18.5.1 Outline
0014-4500
The file MeapBack is a MEAP application and its data stored on the HDD.
The file SramDCON is data stored in the SRAM of the DC controller PCB.
The file SramRCON is data stored in the EEPROM of the reader controller PCB.
T-18-4
MEMO:
- If you are planning to replace the HDD or execute ALL or APL_MEAP formatting, it will be a good idea to upload the MeapBack file in advance and then
download after the work by way of temporarily keeping away the MEAP application.
- If you are planning to replace the Reader controller PCB, you can upload the SramRCON file in advance, and download it after replacement so that the service
mode and other settings may be inherited.
- If you are planning to replace the DC controller PCB, you can upload the SramDCON file in advance, and download it after replacement so that the service mode
and other settings may be inherited.
Interface
Network
IP Address
172.16.1.100 REGISTER REMOVE
iRC3380 [1]
CONNECT iRC3380
ALL
MFP ALL_HDF
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Single [2]
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c:
START
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-40
3) Click [Upload Data].
18-19
Chapter 18
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
S e l e c t t h e f i r m wa r e t o b e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
d ow n l o a d e d . t h e n c l i ck t h e [ S t a r t ] exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
bu t t o n . Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
iRC3380 USenXXXXi
Download Firmware RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE Download Data XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI
XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM Restore Backup System LANGUAGE
TSTMP
XXjaXXXX
TTS
XXenXXXX
WebDAV Format HDD
BOOTROM
iRCXXXX XXxxXXXXC
HDFormat
KEY
SDICT Start
Shutdown
F-18-41
4) Select 'MeapBack.bin', and click [Start].
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
File Name
SramImg.bin
Download Firmware MeapBack.bin
Memo Sublog.txt
Upload Data
Format HDD
c:
Start
Cansel
F-18-42
5) Type in the name of the file to store and, as necessary, a brief description; then, click [Save].
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
File Name
SramImg.bin
MeapBack.bin Download Firmware MeapBack.bin
Memo Sublog.txt
Memo Upload Data
Format HDD
c:
Save
Discard
F-18-43
6) Click [OK].
The file SramRCON, SramDCON, or MeapBack may only be downloaded to their source machine.
18-20
Chapter 18
SST
iRC ----
Printer unit
Uploading/Downloading
System Main controller PCB
Meapback (safe mode only)
SramRCON (normal mode only)
SramDCON (normal mode only)
DC controller PCB
HDD
SRAM Meapback.bin
F-18-44
- The machine must be in normal mode for uploading/downloading the file SramDCON or SramRCON.
- The machine must be in safe mode for uploading/downloading the file MeapBack.
Interface
Network
IP Address
172.16.1.100 REGISTER REMOVE
iRC3380 [1]
CONNECT iRC3380
ALL
MFP ALL_HDF
R e g i s t e r F i r m wa r e Single [2]
USB
D e l e t e F i r m wa r e
D e l e t e B a ck u p D a t a
c:
START
CANCEL
EXIT
F-18-45
3) Click [Download Data].
18-21
Chapter 18
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
SelectableFirmware Control
S e l e c t t h e f i r m wa r e t o b e Click the button of the task to be Firmware Version
d ow n l o a d e d . t h e n c l i ck t h e [ S t a r t ] exe c u t e d . SYSTEM
bu t t o n . Active
USenXXXXn
SelectableFir mware Hold
iRC3380 USenXXXXi
Download Firmware RCON
BOOT
XXxxXXXX
BROWSER
DCON
DCON Upload Data XXxxXXXX
G3FAX
RUI
HELP
XXjaXXXX
LANGUAGE Download Data XXenXXXX
MEAPCONT
MEAPCONT
RUI
XXxxXXXX
SYSTEM Restore Backup System LANGUAGE
TSTMP
XXjaXXXX
TTS
XXenXXXX
WebDAV Format HDD
BOOTROM
iRCXXXX
XXxxXXXXC
HDFormat G3FAX
KEY XXxxXXXX
SDICT Start
Shutdown
F-18-46
4) Select the data to download, and click [Start].
ServiceSupportTool DLM10 (Ver.3.22E)
172.16.1.100
iRC3380
SAFE
Clear
c: Download Firmware
Upload Data
MeapBack.bin.upd
Download Data
Format HDD
Series:iRC3380
iRC3380 Start
Serial No:F2310130
F2310130
DataType:backup of meap
Date:2006/ 04/ 16 17:14:33 Cansel
Memo:Memo
Return to Main Menu
F-18-47
5) When downloading has ended, click [OK] to return to the previous screen.
F-18-48
Downloading the System Software
[1]: Upgrade (AUTO)
Use it to download/write the system software. (auto)
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
Use it to download the system software. (Confirmation execution when version is downed the same version)
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
Use it to download the system software. (all overwrite)
Other Functions
[5]: Backup
18-22
Chapter 18
Downgrading
Be sure that the system software in the USB device is of the latest version.
The following files of the system software do not permit collection of version information. As such, they necessarily overwrite the system software on the HDD:
- KEY (in both normal and safe mode)
- TTS (in both normal and safe mode)
- BROWSER (in both normal and safe mode)
- WebDAV (in both normal and safe mode)
- TSTAMP (in both normal and safe mode)
- HELP (in both normal and safe mode)
- DCON (in safe mode only)
- RCON (in safe mode only)
- G3FAX (in safe mode only)
The following is recommended for normal downloading (i.e., downloading of the system software, not after HDD replacement or formatting):
download mode: normal
download menu: [1]: Upgrade (Auto)
F-18-49
18-23
Chapter 18
<Procedure>
1) If the machine is on, go through the HDD shut-down instructions, and turn off the main power.
2) Connect the USB device to the sub port.
3) Put the machine in download mode (normal or safe).
4) Go through the instructions on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[1] -> [0]: execute download / other than [0]: go back to Menu screen
F-18-50
5) While downloading is under way, the control panel screen shows its progress. At the end of the downloading, the machine restarts on its own to start writing to
the system area of the HDD or the flash ROM.
- Screen Showing the Progress of Downloading
F-18-51
6) At the end of writing to the HDD, a message will appear asking you to turn off and then back on the power. Turn off the power, remove the USB device, and
turn the power back on.
F-18-52
18.6.4 Downloading the System Software (Confirmation execution when version is downed the same version)
0014-4506
<Procedure>
18-24
Chapter 18
1) If the machine is on, go through the HDD shut-down instructions, and turn off the main power.
2) Connect the USB device to the USB port.
3) Put the machine in download mode (normal or safe).
4) Go through the instructions indicated on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[2] -> [0]: execute download / other than [0]: go back to Menu screen
F-18-53
MEMO:
If the system software in the USB device is found to be of the same or older version, a message will appear asking you if you want to overwrite. Go though the
instructions on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[0]: overwrite / other than [0]: do not overwrite
F-18-54
5) While downloading is under way, the control panel screen shows its progress. At the end of downloading, a message will appear asking you to press a key. Press
the appropriate key. If the machine is in normal mode, it starts the shut-down instructions.
F-18-55
6) When a message appears asking you to turn off the power, turn off the main power switch, remove the USB device, and turn on the main power switch.
7) Upon start-up, the machine starts to write the system software to the system area of the HDD or the flash ROM. At the end of writing to the HDD, a message
will appear asking you to turn off and then back on the power. Turn off and then back on the main power switch.
F-18-56
18-25
Chapter 18
<Procedure>
1) If the machine is on, go through the HDD shut-down instructions, and turn off the main power.
2) Connect the USB device to the USB port.
3) Put the machine in download mode (normal or safe).
4) Go through the instructions on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[3] -> [0]: execute download / other that [0]: go back to Menu screen
F-18-57
5) While downloading is under way, the control panel screen shows its progress. At the end of downloading, a message will appear asking you to press a key. Press
the appropriate key. If the machine is in normal mode, the shut-down sequence will start.
F-18-58
6) When a message appears asking you to turn off the power, turn off the main power, remove the USB device, and turn the main power switch back on.
7) Upon start-up, the machine starts writing the system software to the system area of the HDD or the flash ROM. At the end of writing, a message will appear
asking you to turn off and then back on the power. Turn off and then on the main switch.
F-18-59
<Procedure>
Go through the following to format the HDD for BOOTDEV partition:
1) If the machine is on, go through the HDD shut-down instructions, and turn off the main power.
2) Connect the USB device to the USB port.
3) Start up the machine in safe mode.
4) Follow the instructions on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[4] -> [0]: go to Partition Selection screen / other that [0]: go back to Menu screen
18-26
Chapter 18
F-18-60
5) Go through the instructions on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[1] -> [0]: execute BOOTDEV formatting / other than [0]: go back to Menu screen
[C]: go back to Menu screen
F-18-61
6) At the end of formatting, a message will appear asking you to press a key. Press any key to go back to the Men screen.
F-18-62
7) Start downloading the system software. For instructions, see "Downloading the System Software."
[5]: Backup
[6]: Restore former version (in the presence of backup of system software)
Use it to restore the backup of the system software while saving the system software that is current as a backup.
<Procedure>
1) If the machine is on, go through the HDD shut-down instructions, and turn off the main power.
2) Connect the USB device to the USB port.
3) Put the machine in download mode (normal or safe).
4) Go through the instructions on the control panel, and press the appropriate key.
[6] -> [0]: initialize / other than [0]: go back to Menu screen
After execution, a message will appear asking you to turn off and then on the power.
18-27
Chapter 18
F-18-63
5) Turn off the main power switch, remove the USB memory, and turn on the main power switch.
<Procedure>
1) The power supply is turned off after the download of the system software by menu [2] or [3] is completed, and it starts in a safe mode with the USB memory
connected.
2) Go through the instructions on the control panel, and press an appropriate key.
[7] -> [0]: execute / other than [0]: go back to Menu screen
Upon execution, the Menu screen will return.
F-18-64
[Stop]: Shutdown (in normal mode only)
Use it to start up the shut-down sequence.
<Procedure>
1) Go through the instructions on the control panel, and press an appropriate key.
[Stop] -> [0]: execute / other than [0]: go to Menu screen
The shut-down sequence will be executed, and a message will appear asking you to turn off the power.
F-18-65
2) Turn off the main power switch, and remove the USB device.
18-28
Chapter 19 Service Tools
Contents
Contents
In addition to the standard tooles set, the following special tools are required when servicing the machine:
T-19-1
Tester extension pin FY9-3038 A Used as a probe extension when making electrical checks.
Tester extension pin (L- FY9-3039 A Used as a probe extension when making electrical checks.
shaped)
[Ctgr]
A: Must be kept by each service engineer.
B: Must be kept by each group of about five engineers.
C: Must be kept by each warkshop.
19-1
Chapter 19
T-19-2
19-2
Aug 29 2006